Skip to main content

Full text of "Gospel glory : for singing schools, singing conventions, etc."

See other formats


GOSPEL 
GLORY 

1% 


James  D  Vau^han 

â–     MUSIC  PUBLISHER 

Lawrenceburg  ,    Tenn. 


Come,  My  Friends  and  Go  With  Me 

J.  L  M.  J.  L.  Morgan 


31 

â– *-         ...    _ 

1.  1     shall  ne'er  for-get   tfee   day.Jg  -  sas  took  my   sins    a  -  way, That  is 

2.  Whan    I  need  Him  He    is    near,  bring-ing  coH»-fort,b©pe  and  ebew.Gw  •  kg 

3.  So   witir  Him     I    press  a  -long,  mid  tfois  bos  -  y    wiek-  ed  Stems/Iett  -rng 

rEM^=£=El U— If— E=fcb=fr— 1£ 


»    bfc. 


why  I  sing  a  song  as  I  go  my  way  a~k>Hg;He  is  new  my  all  in  all 
me  a  hap-  py  fife, free  frsffl  m  -*»•»  a»d  &wa  sbife; And  He  lead*  me  mgfet  and  day 
of      Hrslo^e  for  roe, how  He  sets  the  cap-tive  iree;  Sinew-rag-  how  He  died  for  tkem 

«i_«_k_  ^_*    ^^ g—fi- r&—m — k-r^-Bk— »Mfcr 

SdtrrH  S-8J.g-g-git=i5E^" 


-v— y— v- 


and    I     fol-low  at  His  call, For  I  know  tfeat  He  will  tap  me  from  the  wrong, 
in     tbe  straight  aednai-rmv  wayrB*Sp-i»g  me  to  live  it  berewhm  sm    is   rife. 
pray-ing  tkey  wiil  f»»e  toHimjW  be  samd  and  blest  for  all    e  -  te?  -ni-tty. 

a     ft       x — ^ 

" "~  -fL'T^Lgpt    *  bfc.  rar-*—  *-r»f-^-'*— «-  fe*-fc — * — j*-rf2--_r|2L 
rs-3 1 1— f§? — be — u  \mm    W     i^lPM-y-i — h 


V— y— y 


=5— 5=£ 


t!=p=:^rte- 


q=q=p 


we  will  ban  a    jn 
Cborus. 


-lee  In  that  bte-d  Ho  -  fry  eft  -  y    in  tbe  skf. 


Come,  my  friends^and  go   with  me,    let    Hha    make  jot     glad    aad     free,    * 


1 1 rfc2 fc k< k —  r j 

%^E*e£eEJEEBEEBe£ 


-k- 


:£=^ 


tat- 


fel 


Bt 


-±=at=l 


£-- -h-, 


D.S. 


£=*: 


r*  â–  /-h  i 


$=f3 


Â¥*t 


i?=E^! 


He   will   give  to    yoo     a    man-sion  where  tbe  soul  shall    ne?  •  ear 


â– #- r^-- 


^~ 


Capyriab.*.,  19.48.,  Viv  .lames  D.  Vaug,h.an,  Music  Publisher,  iu  "Gospel  Glory..' 


|  GOSPEL  GLORY 

FOR 

[  Singing  Schools,  Singing  Conventions,  Etc. 

AUTHORS 

J   G.   Kieffer  Vaughai 

i 

Jam 

Adger  M.  Pace               W.  B.  Walbert 

j    Chas.  W.  Vaughan 

es  D.  Walbert          Rev.  Rupert  Cravens 

J   Jesse  B.  Hardin 

Byron  G.  Faust 

Luther  Dvummond 

I  J.  E.  Marsh 

L.  O.  Brock 

Will  L.  Matthews 

1   B.  F.  White 

J.  C.  Cooper 

Mrs.  Jesse  B.  Hardin 

1    John  M.  Dve 

W.  S.  Tidwell 

J.  Monroe  Mobbs 

j  E.  F.  Purvis 

Woodrow  Sides 

Houston  L.  Thomas 

I   Earl  Conway 

Harvey  A.  Lewis          Herbert  E.  Pace 

f   L.  C.  Higdon 

J.  L.  Morgan 

Roy  L.  Johnson 

f  A.  O.  Hargett 

R.  G.  Wilkins 

W.    C.   Woodward 

I  E.R.Ward 

Curtis  Taylor 

M.  D.  McWhorter 

|  Perkin  Meador 

Lawrence  Ropel 

c            J.  O.  Townsend 

f   G.  D.  McNair 

Ranee  Barkley 

James  W.  Poole 

J.  F.  Durden 

Gaskell  Warren 

William  R.  Wallace 

I   L.  E.  Teal 

John  E.  Hull  • 

W.  Howard  Johnson 

j   Yale  E.  Payne 

Theo  Powell 

A.  J.  Burchfield 

g   J.  L.  Freeman 

Edgar  W.  O'Dell            Robert  L.  Johnson 

i  Mrs.  L.  W.  Carr 

Bryant  Johnson 

J.  Porter  Thomason 

|   T.  L.  Gilley 

Lee  M.  York 

Rev.  Virgil  S.  Rushing 

f   David  Huntley 

Mrs.  Shirlene  Walker 

!   Walter  C.  Carter 

Paul  W.   Cochran 

|   Willie  Willmurth 

Robert  McWhirter 

f   W.  K.  Brown 

s: 

THE  BESTJ 

Bill  Edd  Dodson 

I   Fred  Rich 

Fay  Jennings 

|   Jimmye  Boyd 

Dr.  H.  H.  Martin 

f   Grady  L.  Baker 

^se^watr^ 

Ross  F.  Chambers 

I  Clyde  W.  Cox 

W.  D.  Rowland 

1   Jesse  Cook 

Doyle  Hawkins 

!  M.  H.  Hodges 

C  AMERICA. 

Lon  Craddock 

{  J.  C.  West 

\/ 

Rev.  G.  C.  Morris 

1  Oren  Adams 

L.   P.  Thigpen 

j  W.  E.  Hinton 

Hollis  Taylor 

f  Darius  Green 

, 

Eloise  Carper 

1  W.  H.  Nelson 

PRICES: 

Cecil  Fisher 

35c  a  Copy;  $3.60  a 

Dozen;  $13.00  foi 

:  50;  $25.00  a  100,  postpaid 

!     anywhere  in  the  U.S.A.    Shaped  No1 

tes  Only.    Manila  Binding. 

JAMES    D.Vi 

\UGHAN 

MUSIC  PUBL 

ISHER 

f                          LAWRENCEBURG,  _ 

rENNESSEE 

»           Copyright,  1948, 

by  J 

ames  D.  Va 

ughan,  Music  Publisher 

1  Want  to  Live  There 


Mrs.  Novella  Black 


Perkin  Meacior 


1   s 

1.  I'm  planning  some  day, 

2.  I'm  send- ing  each  day, 

3.  That  man-  sioa  they  say, 


V    v    P 
to  leave  this  old  world, 

ma-ter-  i  -  al  there, 

is  great  to   he  -hold, 


0      P 


'$-$- 


And  go  to  that  place 
Of  which  He  will  build 
Andstand-eth  with-in 


I 


my  man-sion  to    fair; 
the   Cit-  v    of    gold: 


3-=:— pan  ^=t-  i»=K 

1 p__J_^_p 

D.S. Where  man-sion  of  light 


F--K  — ® — »— H ■ -i 1 1 1 -| 

—■—p.  -^— g—  y-fjg— 9— « g— ■— -6-\ 


willnev-er   de-cay; 


h— W— U— h— n  — * L  h — h — P — P n — h— * 


For  Je-sus  has  gone 
And  when  He  shall  call 
Come,qaick-ly    oh, Lord, 


6Vt^— S M— *— n— ^— 


With  Je  -bus my  Lord, 


p  p -a  p       "       p    P" 

that  place  to  pre-pare, 
how  hap-py  I'll   be, 
and  take  me   up  there, 

-A-  -A-     -A-     -A-     -A- 

«_«_£_« e_:t:_«_±:i-"t"— ti_ t- 


tf— p— p- 


g£fc 


P 


^ m — w 


the  good  and  the  true, 

^~;cz"tz5zf 


f^FlNE. 


'-^-^1 


And  soon  He  will  come 
To  go  to  that  home 
To   live  in  that  home 


_?_£__£_ 


p  P    P 

and  take  me  up  there 
for-  ev  -  er  to  be. 
Thyglo-ry  to  share. 


0  » 


â– Frtr 


g^^Tx — "p^^-^=g=g=gp-t-bzz^fA==-g-^^-^^-^=^j 
^ffi==^E^==E=5p3:^~lz^=z====^=g=^tt=^=^===^pr=:i 


I  want  to  live  there, 
Chorus.  k    s     \<*~ 


iFFi 


z=EE 


say  how  a-bout  vou? 

h  h  -  „*   - 


:«=■$ 


D.S. 


I  want  to  live  there 


tnrr 


pp        p    p         P    P    p1    ^    p    u 

some  won-der-fnl  day, 
I  want  to  live  there  some  won-der-  fnl  day. some  won-der-ful  day, 

ft    .pt    A 


7-r; . -«  — M.  -fi « * ^_5— ClZt-ptl— -t— | ±—h "I-— n 


Copyright, 1948, by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher  in  "Gospel  Glory." 


PTT 


No.  1. 

Fay  Wallington 


Gospel  Glory 


Adger  M,  Pace 


1.  There's  a  grand 
2.'Tis  the  sto 
3.  Let    us     go 


and  bless  -  ed  sto-  ry,  bless  -  ed  sto-  ry, 
ry  of  sal  -va-tion,  of  sal  -  va-  tion, 
with  joy   and    tell     it,      go    and    tell     it, 

|s — a — A^j^zzri 


3J=zi|=Ezs!= =z=— a|=Jt=rJ=:j|zzfe= =— : 


from  heav'n  a  -  bove,  from  heav'n  a  -  bove; 
ones  here  be  -  low,  down  here  be  -  low: 
wide  world    a  -  round,  the  world      a  -  round; 


Sent  to  us 
For  the  lost 
To     the  whole 

-A- -A- -A- -A- -â„¢- -A 

D.S.Sing  it     out  to      all     the    race,     to 


:zU: 


:f==l= 


11      the 


m 


j -A- -A- -A- -A- -ft- :A-_jA^_ 

P P * £ Pk k k fc k k 1 


And  'tis    filled 
We   should  then 
With    a     song 


with  gos  -  pel    glo  -    ry,    gos  -  pel   glo  -  ry, 

with  ju  -  bi  -    la  -     tion,    ju  -  bi  -  la  -  tion, 

of  vie  -  t'ry  swell    it,    glad  -  ly    swell    it, 

4.  -*-              -ft-     .ft-      -A-      -A-    -ft. 

— t? — J D— 5 — 5— tc 

Sing  with  pow'r  and      gos- pel      glo-  ry,     gos -pel    glo  -  ry, 

v  k  i  Fine- 

■*-« — j — f-i ■ Jr     — * — *" 

P#* — 3— tf - — '     :::::  :  "  :;i 

Tell  -  ing  of 
Tell  it  out 
Where-so  -  ev 


our      Sav-iour's  love,    our    Sav-  iour's    love, 
wher  -  e'er   we      go,     wher  -e'er    we       go. 
er    man      is      found, where  man    is    found. 


-A-        -f-        -W-         -A- 

:t3J-b=t3=t3=E,s 


r\ 


h 


m 


ev  -  'ry    place,     in      ev  -  'ry    place. 


Sing 


song  and    tell     the    sto  -  ry, 

Sing    a      song   and    tell    the    sto  -  ry,  bless  -  ed    sto  -  ry, 


-A- 


m 


» — p. 
!*— a: 

Copyright.  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory." 


zi±fe±fc=# 


V- 


-&— — »— r!~ 


-JS— 


No.  2. 

Y,  E.  P. 


The  City  Four-Square 


Yale  E.  Payne 


t>— fs— 0- 


1.0"    ver  by  the  crys-tal    riv  -  er,   far     a  -bove  the  blue  sky,  Where  the 

2.  Streets  of  gold  and  walls  of    jas  >  per, gems  of  spark-'ling  bright  hue,  Where  will 

3.  There'll  be   no  more  pafn  nor   dy  -  ing  when  we  reach  that  good  place, No  more 

y-fi-r* — r* — r»— Bk * = P- <r— .-It fc k ^ s—  xc&- 


— f-S^i 


i/     ^     y 


njj     v  -■-  ■•      *  $ 

saints  shall  live  for  -  ev  -  er    and  shall  nev-er-more  die, Where  the  birds  are   ev  -  er 
come  no  moredis- as-ter  and  nomorework  to    do ; Fruits  of  rich  and  gleaming 
heart-aehes,no  more  sigh-ing  in    the  light  of  God's  face,Love.-ly  flow-ers  send-  ing 


_JL 


-'=&— *" 


%=fe=fe: 


M 


*— *-^— p— P — | 0' 


â– #  U1       *      '         '  v         v         V  ' "  g) 

sing  -  ing  sweet-e3t  rnel  -  o  -  dies  rare,  With  its  foun-tains  ev  -  er 
splend-dor  will  a  -  dorn  the  green  trees, E  -  vil  fore  -  es  will  not 
sweet-ness  thru  theheav-en  -  ly     air,  'Tis        a      home    of      sure    com  - 

_E  m  ,*_g_J^-_g__g-_-g:_  » — if — ft — &,_ 

:p— pz=g=b=:Ep— 6i=g z=z=bp=pzz=g=b=: 


Chorus. 


^ijis|f=piiii^pi^i^ 


j.  .a.  .^.  -j.  .a-  .^.  .^_ 

spring-ing  stands  the  Cit  -  y  four-square. Cit  -  y  four-square, love-ly    and  fair, 
hin  -   der    in    its  heav  -  en  -  ly  breeze. 

plete-ness,   in    that  Cit  -  y  four-square. Cit  -  y      of   light,where  comes  no  night, 
■«-  _. . . k — ^r-* — ^__^_g^_r^ p. m-ft* 


^ffipz=p=S=^=t5=J=Jz=:t:tzpz=p— p=^Ep=p=pz^=3 


| i T 2 1 


Build-  ed    for  you  and  me; 


Oh,     how    we     long     for    Thee. 


gE5Ep=p— p=£=^-E»=*±?.Ep=^P g Ezzfc^l=B 


twr— ^ — * — ' — 55 — P" 

Copyright,  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory. 


No.  3. 

L.  0.  B 


L.  0.  Brock 


On  the  Hills  of  Glory  Land 

P-4-A-11  M— \-A A  — ft" A A A— 4* j |-A A « j A 1 

ry  ■    -    »    J 

1.  Won't      we  bave    a     hap-  py    time, when       we  reach  that  sun-  ny  clime, 

2.  Flow    -    ers  sweet  are  bloom-ing  there,  send   -   ing   per  -fume    ev-'ry  where, 

3.  Praise      the  Lord, the  Cit  -    y    fair,  we  are    told,  is    built  four-square, 

Jr.1—        -»-  jfL  sk- 
sj^HH^— fas— Errfc 

&H=yzz-— p=fa— P=p: 


3=E 


_fc — E a £_Oa__£ — (!_  f?  __  a . 

it2=3=p==p-S—  t2=^t=-: 


SB —  ^~~ A— f-A A A A A A ~ M-\-m  m       ~A y A—11 A J 

u  ~*  y    y    y    p"   p         •        k'  r    D  ;i.    .P 

On  the  hills  of    glo-  ry  land;  >  With      the 

O'er*    those 
0  -ver   on   the  hills  of    glo-  ry  land,  glo  -  ry  land;  And        'tis 


S& 


WEE 


5>-.  -£     -(*-   5* 


L§*: 


D.  S.  To        that 


'    =:^=i-^— S—h-^-^-^-^--, 


ffl — A A ft^ A A A— Eg A' — |-A A g j A 


=i=:~5=: 


Sav    -  iour    on     His  throne, reign    -  ing  o'er  His  loved  and  own, On  the 

fields   we'll  glad  -  ly  roam    in  that  hap-  py  home,sweet  home, 

there    we'll  shout  and  sing   hal      -      le    â–   lu  -jab"?    to     the  King, 


:az 

V- 


A A IA A A |S_  C.%. |A. 


-us — e — f 

:g — »  —I 5 : 


hap  -  py    dwell- ing  place  where    weMl  praise  Him  for    His  grace, 
^  Kink  Chorus. 


fa 


— ♦— I — #j— d 

^ A A A A A A— A  -  ! 

v'  y    V~ P    D~~y 


site* 


*    r 


y  â– ' 


hills  of  glo-ry    land. 

0  -  ver  on  the  hills  of  glo-ry  land, glo-ry  land.Let    us   live  for  Je-sus  herewith  no 

f\ â– â–   i    h  J  v 


.«.  :=:  j*. 


.».     JL     «-    -k. 


* — P— h — P — n — P— » — n — i — H rEs-w — -p-r^ b — n — ' — ♦hi 

P P b^P—  f-L *£S> — L u— P *~Ts 


♦— ♦ e ^-t-r-T-  ' 


y        '    -   i/    i .   y 

an    en-trance  grand 


*= 


doubt-ing  and  no  fear,And  we'll  have 

And  we'll  have  with  Him    an  en-trance  grand,en-trance  grand 

.«-  2:    .a.    It    .«.    j*.    .*.  flti    .|8.    .«-  gk.    ^. 


^:=£-;=== 


A A ^ 

=y=y= 


^: 


,  • — •- 


Copyright.  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan.  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory." 


No.  4. 

Fay  Wallington 


Tell  it  Out 


3zfc=ft=H=: 


^=•15=^=:^=^=:^=^=^ 


â– t 


^=^^^=i~^=l=i=§j^=g3 


W.  S,  Tidwell 


If 


1.  Oh,    my    broth  -  er,  there's   a       mes  -  sage  that    the    world  should  know, 

2.  When  the  world   was      all       in      dark-  ness, Christ,  the      Sav-  iour    came, 

3.  He        is      now      at    home    in      heav-    en,  reign-   ing      on      His  throne, 


azft: 


k-^ 


V — P- 


-* & — 


_-t_--- 


sLlj , jJ bs_* t  .    ?  m _  . I   f — [  »  


:j5=: 


x        â–   I      '      i      ~         \      \      \      b  '  'j 

Tell    it    out,  tell    it    out;  'Tis    the   mes-sage  of       sal- 

And     He  died   to  save      the 
Tell    it   out,  tell      it    out;.  With  the   Fa-ther    He       is 

■»-  jg#- -■-  •• ■ "*L_bk. ■*■      bk. '•: "•: 9z -"•: 

rrj 1 1—  a — A--r~j 

-[1—5—1 — ^ p^ 


|ee|e 


==n3^: 


=g$ 


M^z^nifc-— 


■  A — p- 


zzf 2ir  s&k z : 


oh.  tell    it   out. 


va  -  tion.sin   to     o  -  ver-throw,Tell  it  out, 

sin  -  nerfrom  a    life  of  shame, 

plead-ing  for  His  loved  and  own,  Tei!  it    out, oh,  tell    it,  tell     it     out. 

■&•  hv      ■&■    -e-    ->--    ---    -(-"  -•*  &•-    -p-  fi»-    "•-     k..    J       ^ 

s%ip — X)~~0 — Q\\ — I — ! — ~ r! — i — B — ■' — g~7^~-|z~-      '■  — 

4tb — M— as— 1-sb — b — h — m — a— 
fjrp—x — ^— H 1 1 1 


r-= 


Tell  it    out  to    ev-  'ry    na-tion, that  the  Lord  is  King, Tell  it    out, 

Tell    it 

_A.     .&,.     -A. 


out, 


i 1 1*— i 

!4 A ' 


-a 


fc. *_fs. 


CT~P~ 


p>- — 1-  — r 


£=0=&=»=t 


•H-      -H- _  -*-_$»l •"" 


-A- 


jfe^sfe 


-WV 


— I P— J—  h" — b — ■ — b — ci — a| P H-hal — H 9 — n  , 


teli    it   out;  Un-till  all  the  world  may  hear  it,   let    the   mes-sage  ring, 

tell    it    out; 


ft»S — ^ H i 1 * & 1 1 1 1 1 1 bfc A — HA \A * — 


Copyright,  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory, 


No.  5. 

W.  B.  W. 


Lord,  is  it  I? 


W.  B.  Walbert 


:=T3— 3fc=3==pq±te= _* — k— h— " 


1.  Some   one    is      griev-ing    the    Sav- iour**to  -  day, 

2.  Some   one    is      wan- iler  -  ing     out     in      the    cold, Lord,  is       it       I? 

3.  Some   one    is      turn- ing      a-  way^from  His    face, 

.ft.       -A-       -A  .      -*-       Ht*    i+_        -*- 

jW-* ft— — * * nft * — h* * ft A 


III 


i_y y- 


-W- 


:tz±Ji=-:itezziz-zi:« 
P       U       0       I 


lit 


-h- 


Some  one    is  care  -  less  -  ly    drift  -  ing  a  •    way. 

Lord,  i3      it      I?  Lost  from  the  Saep-herd    and   far    from  the   foid, 

Some  one     is  spurn-ing    His       of  -  fer  of    grace, 

-A-     -A-  -ft-      -A-  -*â– -  "       >â–  


£4wf-ft ft-  — ft ft—--* ft ft ft--  —'ft ft Mft ft 

grtt-n-.z=B=i=E=±5z=iGzz=D-zzp — n      n=to=:=5: 


^rp~pz-p=f~tg 


P— p: 


-y- 


:t- 


-v- 


ClIORUS. 


Lord,  is     it       I? 


Lord, 

Lord,   is       it 


I? 


it       I? 

Lord,  is 


I? 


-•  — 


-ft- 

:pz_0: 


- — v  -»-^ 

A 1- 1 1£ fti — a ft-J 


Lord, 

Lord,  is      It      I? 


#— • p — 5- 0  - 

I 


=±6 


I? 

Lord,  is      it 

-ft-i 


ft* ft ft sf- 


:p=p: 


*£? 


^: 


i=*G=i 


=^=F^=^: 


drift  -  ing     a   -    way  from   the    fold,    Lord,  is 

-A- 


.ftTT      38. 


I? 


fc?=% 


-A. 


»-^ — &- 


Copyright,  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Masic  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory.' 


No.  6. 

L.  0.  B. 


Let  Us  Keep  on  Praying 


-*-    *-    -»- 

1.  What  we're  need-ing   here     be-  low,    as    thru 

2.  There   is    much  that   we  should   do     if      to 

3.  When  the  world  seems  go  -  ing  wrong  and  we've. 


L.  0.  Brock 

E-   aj "I j — 

"" "* — 1*7" 

life     we      on-  ward   go, 

God    we  woald   be  true, 

al  -  most  lost    our  song, 


V       v 


* 


I — 


&Hi:=b=±=i£zs!=zi|zi*— 

ii? a — 9 — 1_ — i — 1_  -j 

v       -♦-  -♦-  -*-  •«■-  -♦-  ip 


.  _l_A 


6 


%gg 


y  > 
Is  to  kneel  and  pray  ev-'ry  day;  It  will 
And  we  need  to  pray  ev-'ry  day;  It  will 
Brother,  let    U3  then  kneel  and  pray; It    will 

D.S.  It    will  help 


F^=^5±^= 


*=: 


4 ri 


-jfc 


^3 


help 
help 
help 


us      in    the  fight  'gainst  the 
to  keep    ns  straight.till  we 
us  press    a  -  long, fill  our 


-A- 


llS 


-^ 


i— 


:if5 


to  God,    in  the 

FlNE. 

a 

wrongandfor  theright. Keep  the  light  of  heav  -  en. shin-  ing  a  -  long  the  way. 
reach  the  glo-  ry  gate,  So  then  let  us  keep  on  pray-ing  a -long  the  way. 
lives  with  hap-py  song,  Till   we  reach  our  home  up    yon-der  some  glo  -ry  day. 


-# — 3—  9 — ^ — *  r~A~ 


1 J A A- 


— ^ — 
>—  h — ■*- 


zq-t — ~ 


-*- 


way  the  saints  have  trod,  So  then  let 
Chorus     , 


IB 


1 


us  Keep    on  pray-ing  from  day   to  day. 


■ — p — t, ^ — *— «:  J 

long    the    glo  -   ry    way, 
-*-      -k- 

ra * A A * A H 1 A A A — T| 


and  pray, 
us  knetl  and  pray, each  day, 


Copyright  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory. 


No.  7. 

C.  W.  Naylor 


When  Christ  Shall  Come 


W.  C.  Woodward 


gE_«_L# 1 1 ta g — &•— Le 5 Or- — •— L-H 1 C 

-*-      U-— ■  •"■"—I  w  ~  -♦-      -♦•       ■•■      -♦-     -♦- 


1.  All  hail         the 

2.  His  won   -    drous 

3.  The  rec    -    ords 


day  for  which 
ma  -jes  -  ty 
will   be      o 


we  yearn, The  hap-py    day 

di  -      vine  From  east    to  west 

pened  wide  And    by  them  we 

i  i        r\ 

Ji a A-— A — rA A- A* 

■ — p — | — n~T  " — 5 — "pinr 


==t5rzt=d=:-===d==^z=zz=:^=:±ru1— =z=z 


of  Christ's  re  -turn;He'll  sure 
will  bright-ly  shine; Vast  mul 
will     all    be  tried; The    high, 

— * — i * •  ; — • — r* 

r^H* — H» © 1 H ^r 


ly         come  to    earth 
ti     -    tudesfrom  sea 
the         low,  the  great 


Chorus. 


a  -  gain, 
and  land 
and         small 

i 


p__r£z 


t=t 


— N-3— i— iir-*i-F*— ■ 


*L 

And   nations  all  will  see  Him  then.  We  shall  see 
Shall  come  and  in  the  judgment  stand. 
If     saved  will   be  re-ward-ed,  all.  We  shall  see, 

IS 


J    D     r  -p- 

Him  in   His  glo    *    ry, 

glo-  ry  see, 


-m *~r£  —* — *f-£~r* — *" r r* — ,* — * - 


B — EE 

LA A 


gg 


n=4=i 


:± 


:â–  fat 


3=E=Ei5^==i= 


af 


= L^ 


-L; 


tr-pr 


And  shall  stand  among  His  own;  Then  we'll   go  with  Him  to 

And  shall  stand        a    -    mongHisown;  Then  we'll  go         with 

fcte-5 t«_p__» a H:_!!z=*  —^ , p=X — . 


._&__&--&—& 


:^z=s__t3= 


M*- 


1  r  U      1/ 

heav    -     en,    Wh:.:e  we'll  know  as    we    are  known,as    we    are  known. 

Him    to  heav-en,  Where  we'll  know  as    we    are  known. 


ft -m â–  pa m a m m f , 

t2— tCZZtt^E 


_5 u 


-fL 


:-=P=n— - 


Copyright,  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory." 


No.  8.    Why  Don't  You  Let  Jesus  Come  in? 

Rev.  V.  S.  R.  Rev.  Virgil  S.  Rushing 


i 


1.  If      you  are  wear-  y  and  lad  -  ened  with   care,  Why  don't  you  let 

2.  Are  you  down- heart  -  ed,  by    sin    -  ningmade    sad?  Why  don't  you  let 

3.  Yoursins  the   mas-  ter  will  par  -  don     to    -  day,  Why  don't  you  let 

.*.    _a.     _#..    £:  m.     a.      _t.                 .k.  _p 


__?: 


» » IB — Y-9- — e 


*=6=te=k 


Je  -  su3  come  in? 

Je  -  sus  comein? 

Je  -  sus  come  in? 

M- 


â– P~   4 


•S±Z=|:Z=|rzdKII=fc=zt=Ll5ZZZi5Z=iS===ff 

'^f~  -  T — P~  fr-~l — tr—H 


If  you  will  let  Him. your  bur  -  dens  He'll  bear, 
He'll  Hit  your  load  and  your  heart  will  make  glad, 
Then  you  can   sing      ol     His    love     all     the    way, 

.fit-         -0.         _|__         -ff-  fit-         -fc-  -^. 

p-T-tJ— IP"  fc*—  --        -         »- 


Ly 


it: 


E— 3==B 


FineChorus. 


Why  don't  you  let    Je  -  sus     come   in? 


;;  .?.    -p.    :5:    .«.     -k. 

0 0- 0 0 0- 

P=tn=gzz:p=zrp=5=p: 


iH 


Why    don't  you     let 


szzzctz: 


■ —  tn — p»- — »— —  0 


Je  •  sus  come  in  •   to    your    heart?He'll  par  •  don     and   cleanse  you  from 


A. 


=t: 


-0- 


-«-    -P-     3k- 

■±=|s=S- 


-•-. 


=|tz^_iz:=;^zz=pL-D.-»: 
_=p=p=^=pzip: 


IN        IS 

EC 


i— |*    a     P — «— F* — * — * — j — * — 2 — F* — y— ^a — * — R 


the    Sav  •  iour, 

A.        A. 


to 


^3E 


day    makes  the   start, 

-p-      -k-       •       **- 

rr— i r — r= 


: 


Copyright,  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory." 


No.  9. 

R.F.C. 


Look  to  the  Saviour  and  Live 


Ross  F.  Chambers 


and    Sav  -  iour   came   from  heav  -  en    one  day, 


1.  Our      Re  -deem  -  er 

2.  I'm      so     glad     for    that    mo  -  merit  when     to 

3.  Put   your      all      on       the       al    -  tar    and       be 

:£zzz*zzz£zzzf: 

•I 1— — te fc 


me     Je  -  sub  came, 
lieve   on     His  word, 


_H _&- 


ZZZpZZiZlJ 


0 m-  4m M 4 * — J 


Came  to  save  poor  lost  sin  -  ners  who  are  go  -  ing  a  -  stray: 
I  was  lost  and  for  -  sak  -  en,  yet,  He  took  all  my  blame; 
Keep  on     talk  -  ing      to       Je    -  sus,    till    from    Hira   you    have  heard; 


zW 


— zz£zzz £zzz^zzzt:zzjZzzzfezzz?zzzzzzzPzz j 


==^£^=4—^ 


f — r>*k— ^      -1 — ! — 1 — 5= 0 <D #— L0 0 — 50- 


fczzsjz:  3zzEzz:^zz: 
_^_c= — 1 .. — 

And  He  suf-fered  and  died    to  take  the  sin  clouds  a  -  way, 

And  I'm  hap- py    to    tell  you, He  will  do     you   the  same,Oh, look  to    the 

Then  He'll  fill  you  with  glo-  ry,  and  your  soul  will    be  stired, 

m                                                                              I*        I    '  '  m    -  -*•       "I*"      +--      -*"      '^_ 
— FP 1 h h 1— 

zzpzzds 


:p — « — 1 — 1 — l_.  p._i 
lizzfEZzfezzSEZz^zzpzf 


:pz=t 


-t—    -#-    -p- 


P— 


D.S.  All  your  sins  He  will  par-don  and  true  cleans-ing   will   give, 
j.      ,  Fine  Chorus. 

ffd&zjzzlzziftzczjzzz:  zzzzzzzzzigzlzzczzz iEzzg — ^ 

^rlzz:izz.54z^^=5=^=^==E^=EEs=:fe=I 


feu 


:szz| 


£z:l 


r  ir  r  -  y  •*  1  »■  »■ 

Sav-iour  and  live,    e  -  ter  -  nal-  ly    live.  Oh,  look   to    the   Sav-iour  and 

iz_t_-r_v- 

:czzzz=g=rp- 


jr "P    f" 


SfcHrP-F F ' 


:M*-j?-— —  --^-j-t-rT— t— -r— v— r 


f 


J. 


i^==^=PB^=^^ 


ZXS. 


Fl? 


H=£ 


— tr— i? — p— b — I — *-l\?—\ — \p— 

live,for- ev  -  er   live,Yes,look  to    the  Sav-icurandlive,in    glo  -  ry  land  live; 

—X—t—w—w   *"  "*■  :^  *  ■*" Drk'  'fe    fe   ^  ^  ^  ^  ^  £ 

zitozzQzz) 


_szznz=Lz:5z 

Copyright,i94S,by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher  in  "Gospel  Glory." 


E^z^lfmzlEizli 


No.  10. 

W,  B.  Walbert 


What  Wonderful  Glory 


T.  L.  Gilley  Jr. 


1.  How 

2.  All 

3.  How 


e-   -o 

my  heart  o'er-flows  with    rap-ture    and   glo  -  ry, When  I    think     of 

the  blood-washed  saints, the  pure  and    the     Ho-ly,We    shall  meet  that 

I    long      to     see    my    won-  der-ful  Saviour,  And      fa.e  -  hold  His 

— »-■ — H* & A * h* A 4 & 4 & 


— -p>— ri * — 

A — r4 14 


■— ^=JrB=zz=z: 
lid^iLi*— - 


M-r^^--h-K- 


zFitnaizr 


^-^ 


W— 3d— ii-^i— l-g-  -a— y--il— w^l-Sv .  5».i— !-■— ai->  si—*— 1<  -  *> 

f  i i       i 

heav-en,.  my  home, my  home;That  fair  land  of    joy  and  won-der-  ful  glo  -  ry, 
glo  -  ri  -  ous  day,  glad  day;     In  that  land    of  bliss  and  won-der-ful    sto  -  ry, 
beau-  ti  -  ful  face,Hi3  face;   .  Share  the  blessings  of  His  sweet  lov  -ing  fa-  vor, 


4 A — , 1 A A — r-A -A 


:p=p: 


p& — tfc — a- 


-K — * — -| 
-ik- — 4 — I 

:_S3E3 


Chorus 

-A FV 


P 


Sip 


r 


Where  we'll  nev- er   wor  -  ry    nor  roam, nor  roam. What  a  day, 

And   live     on   for  -  ev  -  er    and  aye,  and  aye. 

And  His  great  and   mar-vel  -ous  grace, His  grace.  What  a     day, 


— ♦ fr- — pi H » j- h — p4»  .     3         »- 


-I— t>-C 


-14— --14- 


what 


:£-: 


Hfe±=* 


si— j — te_i-^ — -.—45 — K-ri — 3 — =&— - — i — isr- 


:=t: 


£-fc 


won-der-ful    glo  -  ry,When  we  meet    on  heav-en's  fair  shore, fair sliore;Tliere  we'll 


-A-    -A- 

-Hi * 14- 


-bk £ 4 14- 


-14 A U 1 1 1 cj 


redemption's'oldsto-  ry,And  our  lov-  ing  Sav-iour  a-dore,a-dore. 


sing 

There  we'll  sing 

.A.     .A.     .4. 

-g-   -F-  -•-  'jjr_  -\z~_'~' 

-14 i 14— bk— P* £" 


rt=t=t--t--te=t=p=p=zp: 


:^fcc£zfc?z^tefefe| 


=P=p: 


~r:t:~t=?— pzzpzcT-zrrz.T 
_C| — p— p— f — tp-tjar 


Copyright  1948  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher,  in  "gospel  glory.  " 


No.  11.       We  Are  Going  Home  to  Heaven 

Rev,  R.  C.                                                                                  .            Rev.  Rupert  Cravens 
?5^ -jj — L5 >£> * ♦ — L- " — -1-*- -J 


1.  We  are    trav -'ling.dai  -    ly    trav-'ling,  Toward  the  set  -    ting      of  the 

2.  Joy-ous   morn-  ing,  glo  -  rious  dawn-  ing, When  we    gath    -  er       on  that 

3.  Won  the   bat  -  ties,  gone  the      tri  -  als,    And    re  -  demp  -  tion   won  at 

4.  Let   me  meet    you     in    the    morn-ing,  In     that    Cit   -  y     bright  and 

-A-        -■&:-       -A-        -A-        -A*        -A-       -A-        -A-          -A-          -h—          -P-  -A- 


ctr 


:A--tr=t 


~r 


£: 


Pllili^^ii^ 


Soon     our      jour    -    ney   will  be  o    -    ver, 

Man  -    ny      loved    ones  there  will  greet       us, 

Joy        un  -    end  -     ing,    bliss  of  heav  -  en, 

Twill      be      glo    -    ry    there  to  meet    you. 


-a 


â–  p. 


=-P==P= 


a-  t=s-  rr  •b-  -m-  -p- 

1 i- 1 jg Fk Es- 4 


r 


I — =!- 


And  our    toil  -  ing    will  be    done. 

'Twill    be    glo  -  ry      ev  -  er  -more. 

Trib  -  u    -  la  â–   tions  will  be   past. 

Ev  -   er  -  last  -  ing    joys  to    share. 


-t k 


A-        -A- 


:t 


it: 


_A-- 


r- 


Je  -  sus    calls    us, friends  are 

h   r>  ... 


l-r- 

-<£>— 


wait  •  ing,  Soon  we'll  meet  them  o  -    ver  there, 

fe  J__r« &_$- i— ;f^ 

-P — F* (2 — C P — Ft- 


o  -    ver   there;We'll    be 


m=£^p 


-.ft <?— : 

:ez=|s=: 
-p tT7 


^Ulilllll 


7d H j — pSE 


L» — 7*r 


faith-  ful,  press-  ing      on  -  ward, Till  that  morn- ing  bright  and    fair. 


.p.     -p. 


Z~N 


P P 1 1 R be k k FB ^2 P « 


r— 


Copyright,  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory,' 


:szz 


No.  12. 

Chas.  W,  V. 


Oh,  Don't  Go  Away 


—fc- 


__fv 


r> 


Chas.  W.  Vaughan 


-afr— -*j — *j — H 1 — *j — » — aj — m — 

tJ  -«-        -«"        -♦"       -*"         ■♦-        /*  ^        -♦-        ^ 

1.  Oh, don't  go    a  -  way  with-out     Je-sus,  You  need  Him  so  much  in  your 

2.  Oh, don't  go    a  -  way  with-out     Je-sns,  He   loves  you    so  dear-ly,    so 

3.  Oh, don't  go    a  -  way  with-out     Je-sus,  He'll  take  you  to  beav-en    a- 


_  Br&j£z:^=zjfc=r^=:^iz:£Z=:ptziE=z^zz:l^zErr=g— jtzzp— frzfrz:: 


P    P    P    u    p    p    ^ 


ft — fc^-  ^-J— -P->-P- 


life;  No    oth  -  er   will    do    like   Je-  sus    for   you, When  trouble  and 

true;  His   life    He  once  gave  the  wholeworldto  sa?e,In  -    clud-ed   are 

bove;         His  grace  is      so  real,  the   kind  you  can  feel, Oh,     don't  go    a- 

D    ft    r>  -t- 


tf     P     I       P 
Chorus. 


:p=P=P^=t= 


"J—  p—p      P' 


-^ — q — ^ — La — 0 — 10 — l« e — .9 & e — 1#_ 


â– m 


*t 


-&* 


^ 


I 


sor  -  row  are  rife, 
sin  -  nera  like  you. 
way  from  His  love. 


Oh, don't  go     a  -  way    from   Je  -sus     to  -  day, 
P   -#-      -        P 


He'll  lead  when  the    path-way  grows  dim;        When  tronb-les      be  -  fall, 


§SH: 


_przia: 
P 


:£=£ 


£=P=P=»: 


£BB 


^=6=*=* 


-♦-    -♦-      is 

-5 £ a m- 


m 


_^_r_h — h — h- 


2 


-»a 


fe==$=J>_ 


He'll  an-swer  your  call, 

■= * — r* — 


Oh, don't    go    a  -    way  with-out    Him. 


-W-7F- 


-=g=7i=tiz=Epz=^=p=pi: 


-6- 


V 


zfctpzdrfczzlid 


Copyright,  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory." 


No.  13.  Have  You  Been  Faithful  to  Jesus? 

J.  C.  Jesse  Cook 


:^=zf3=:t5: 


ffit=F=i=gFj 


±>=i=^±j±zi. 


irift: 


.^-£— I 


i£=3EE 


13"  3= 


ifcfcizjc: 


1.  Have  you  been  faith-ful    to      Je- sus,  my  friend?Have  you  been  r.ry-ing  some 

2.  Friend,has  your  life  been    a    bless-ing    to  man?    Are  you  now    do- ing    tbe 

3.  When  you  have  come  to  the    end    of  life's  way,    And  when  no  long  -  er    on 


fc- 


-A A -14- 


rpzzt.-rfc: 


_u : 


lost 
best 
earth 


one  •  to  /win?  Have  you  been  tell  -  ing  the  sto  -  ry  of 
that  you  can?  Walk-ing  each  day  in  the  way  Je  -  sus 
you   can     stay,  Will  you  hear     Je  -  sus    say, "Come, faith-ful 


love? 
trod, 

one? 


m^~- 


-B»—         -&-  -ff- 

~-\ t— Ha-~^A 


e^._>_- 


g=gj=EEEEE= 


Chorus. 

r-J\ &e— - P K 

bove 


45— -45z=^5: 


y    -#-    -ip-    .«.  ■ 

Point-ing  lost    sin-ners    to    heav-en      a 

Try- ing     to      be      a    true  ser-vant   of    God. Have  you  been  faith-ful      to 

Come  and   re-ceive  the  bright  crown  you  have  won. 

.A-      -A.       .A. 

'ff — A A A A 1 1 M 1 1 A--1-A — -A -A A A A 

[p— 5,— Ljp £— Jj l ■ . 


O: 


^ — h r^^ 


-4- 


i-  F-^ — =P— ? — h — h — h-P1^ — h — h — 

3? BB BSI IB KIJ IB CD L_3S B I 


=ta : 


:g. — g ♦-- 

Je  -  sus   each   day?  Have  you  been  walk  -ing  the  straight nar-  row    way? 


-A-         -A-         -A. 


a a-= — Ff 


â– t-     -tr 


'-£ 


Have  you  been  willing  His  will  to  o  -  bey?Have  you  been  faith-ful  to     Je-sus     al-  way? 


^P=^g=5=£=£ 


-K-ri 

-A- -A 


Copyright,  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher,  in  "Majestic  Melodies." 


No.  14. 

Millard  A.  Glenn 


Wonderful  Story 


L.  P.  Thigpen 


W==fr=i 


1.  What  won-der-ful    joy  I'm  hav -ing    to -day, Since  Je-sus  has  rolled  the 

2.  The  sun-light  is    shin- ing     o>  ver  my  soul,  Joy    bil-lows  of  love  now 

3.  I    want    all     to  know  this  won-  der-ful  Friend,Just  how  He  can  save  and 


-_ -j— ± — , A 4 — p4 A ± A — . A-—A 


I     b    I     I;    i 


t 


f 


:(s — 1& — |s — |s: 


£r^ 


j 0 0 — <-  -i 1 1 a « — \-0 —  0 « 0 — j 


S5=5±E 


sin  -  clouds  a  -  way;  No  long  -  er  in  doubt  I  trav  -  el  a  -  long, 
o  -  ver  me  roll;  I'm  hap  -  py  to  tell  wher  -  ev  -  er  I  go, 
keep    to    the    end;    I     want  all     to    share  His    won-der  •  ful    love, 


a 


9-£ 


b     '     b 


e ft — r4 * j — _ 


f 


Fine.  Chorus. 


l h 0 ■ — I <5>-l0- 


s±at 


*= 


3=§: 


For    Je-  sus  has  saved  and  filled  me  with  song.. 

That  I've  been  redeemed, made  whit-  er  than  snow.  Wonderful  sto  »ry,  full   of 

And  meet  me    at  home  in  heav-  en     a  -bove. 

■I   £--Jt:- :fc_J_ t-£— Z-t-  •*■ 


mm 


0=t=5=t 


:p_ra 

:Bzfe 


4 4-  -* A- — I i 


ij£=tote 


D.  S.  And  live  with  Him  there  so    hap-  py  and  free. 


Tr-? 


£^ 


rsfP-44 — i ^ — hs — v — >-- 


*=d=* 


1 — -3  —  -» a ■ 


-*— . r 


a|=j|==5: 
•» •— &•- 


-d- 


$* 


B* 


sun-shine  and  glo  -  ry, Keeps  me  tell  -  ing    what  He     is       do  -ing    for 


B 


-I A * A g — 


y    l  â–   U    I8" 


,^ 


-t 


:t3=t 


-I F H 1— 

±— ft— r~  E 


I 


^: 


-• — 

D.6*. 


^ 


*=^ 


rftzjzz^z^s: 


I 


s 


^=^=ts=S=fe=§ 


--*=£ 


at 


-b   b   b- 

me,  hal  â–   Ie  -  lu  -  jah;And  when  I  meet  Himjyon-derjSweetlyl'll  greet  Him, 


S=SEE 


P:=3i3396 


%=2=g=£ 


V=& 


:p= 


t=t: 


Copyright,i948,by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher  in  "Gospel  Glory," 


No.  15.       When  Jesus  Abides  With  Me 

Rev.  Dr,  Alfred  Barratt 


1UZ3 — -_  M — 1_  -1 — 5— M-3R — FS — ad  —  I jd — F* — * — 


^=t 


Dr.  H.  H.  Martin 


1.  I       am  sail  -  ing  life's  troub-le-some   sea, 

2.  When  the  storm  bil-lowsrum-ble    and    roar, 

3.  I       am  trust-  ing  my   life     in    His    hand, 


And  the  Sav  -iour  my 
In  His  keep-ing  I'm 
For    the     bil  -  lows   o- 


fe 


mx?   *-H— i— -\  —\~t^r-r~r*~ ' '     r '  i  tw=t= 

S^Wa-* A — r-A A 1* A A A kii-2- 14 A r-F p B 


:iK-r-s;j— zt5===hzc^z=jzz:£z=?i=i!==zib=r=t^ 


-tt-j j M- — ai *j J — \-m ■ 1 1— 1 b — V-ri -d — I 

i--|— |— g-F^— g— 3 — I— h — g — 3 — ; — "— ^— FPI— ^— 1 

Pi-  lot  will    be;  But  the  storms  can  -  not    ter  -   ri   â–   fy     me, 

Bafe    ev  â–   er-  more;        I        can    steer    to      e    -   ter-  ni  -ty's  shore, 
bey   His  com-mand;      I        shall  reach  yon  -der    beau  -ti  -  ful    strand, 

■      -A-     ^ w.  JB.     .A-      -A-      -A-      -A-       „ 

s|-:t=t=t=r:^==:-t=t-ri:=tz=?=P==P: 


_£!_• 


i=Ezbt- 


:p=^: 


s=a 


t> 


,                Chorus.  , 
c--j 1-,-k r^-r:^-^ *H — 


When  Je-sus   a-bides  with  me.  When  Je-sus    a-bideswith  me, 

a-bideswithme.  a-bideswith  me. 


-A- 


J 


PE  BE*E^Et_Z feE- 


t3 


iti 


lp=^= 


I;;     ,1— -j—  r-!. -fr— ts-r-k— 1— tP— : !--  - 


r-— I        I  p     - 

When  Je-sus     a-  bides  with   me,  There   is    peace  in     my  soul 

a  -  bides  with    me; 


_A_  -A-      -A-     -A- 


%*-EEF=p=E 


-»-         -9-        -»-        -»- 

■+—  +-  -I—  "h~ 

-I r0 a ». 


=0= 


-A- 

:t~ 

-A- 


— tP=t=P= 


t_-JT-^-^=j: 


*=f: 


when  the  storm  bil  -lows  roll, When  Je-sus    a  -  bides  with  me. 

a  -  bides  with 


a 


i 


£-     -A-    -A-     -A.     A.     ^J-jJL.    -A-    -A-     -A-    -A-    '-f- 


#i        J 


me. 


Copyright.1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory." 


No.  16. 

W.  K.  B, 


That  Far  Away  Clime 


W.  K.  Brown 


1.  A    bean-ti-  ful  tree   is  stand-ing  to  -day,Onhea?Vsev-  er  flow-  ing  stream; 

2.  Far  out  and  be-yond  the  sun -set  of  time,  A    home  waits  me    in   the  skies; 

3.  How  glad   I    will    be    to   live   in  that  home,  And  rest  by   the  tree  of   life; 


^q^-cc^__£zzs_jfcuCj — p— p— | — |_cp_5_p_p=p=t_^i_i 


b    I     U 


Lord, give  me  a  place  in  its  cool-  ing  shade, And  'twill  be  the  end  of  my  dream. 
And  treasures  are  there  that  fades  not  a -way  ,Blest  home  where  the  soul  nev-er  dies. 
I'll    bask  in    its  shadebe  -neath  heaven's  dome, A  -  way  from  all  sor  -row  and  strife. 


f-t—\Z- 


"t?— I !"- 


* 


:t=t 
-» — » 


.-t-_-e-__- 


#-—  » 0 •- 


=£=£±==1 


,,  Chorus. 


#-# » F« P F 1" * P F» * • • ^ IP— 3 

— it & r-l* 1* & Ik * A H* *— * 1* * * 1 

~P~T~ t— u—  D~""~^"  — u~  i  — p — d — r -^ 

or 

i 


May     I    feast,  bless-  ed   Lord,    on     the   fruit 
-k-     -k-     -*• 


this    tree   stand  -  ing 
^       -*- 

I li fe: 


fa 


dh* 


there  in     its  gran-deur  sub-lime; 

.F.  #.  #.  .«.  .«.         y*- 

:t— t=L=£=:s=F-:= 

■® — # — 9 — n f — hfS'-- 


is 


r — u~ p — r- 

I     drink     at      the  fount 


•k- -k- :t; :k- 


-v— 


1  ^ 


of  the  wa -ters  so  free  Flow-ing  there  in    that  won-der  -  fnl  clime? 


§gi^§§ 


r*-N  i 


-t?-p- 

Copyright,  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory, ' 


No.  17.     When  The  Saviour  Calls  Me  Home 

Rev.  G.  C.  M.  Rev.  G.  C.  Morris 

_L_ 1 1 L 1 

—\-0 m — -, — h — •  — 


* — 
4= 


If— n-.%— ■-t3— i— i~  t— •— • 

1.  There's  a    beau-ti  -  ful  build-ing,    in      a    bean  -  ti  -  ful  land, Where  the 

2.  Ev'  -  ry   soul    of    the  saved  ones, thru  His  won-  der-  ful  grace,  Will  be 

3.  Man-y  friends  are    in    glo-ry,  who  have  gone  on     be-fore,Tbo  I 


0     0     P     P     P     P     P 
— p-p~ p— tr- p— •— ^-c2— J-^— •— •-H-Cj— jt  .«, 

saved  shall  as -sem-ble  in  a  glo  -  ri  -  fied  band;I  shall  be  with  that 
sing  -  ing  glad  prais-  es  in  that  won- der-  ful  plaee;And  I  know  I'll  be 
wait  here  and  pon- der,  they  will  sor -row    no  more, They  will  wel-come  my 

A-    -A-       fi 


— S— "£" — a" — -S~ —  j 


!== t: 


-A— 


=t=t3=ti=E^z=:is=|K= 


:S:  K       K       h,  FlNE' 

^ — fl--»—  "-1— i— •— • — • — * — E— L* — c — m 1 — ^— ' * — g- — — J 


number  on  the  bright  gold -en  strand, When  the  Sav-iour  shall  call  me  home. 

hap-py   as    I    look  on  His  face, 

coming  to  thatheav-en-ly  shore,  shall  call 


-  -A — A A — *-, A = A A A—  rA -A A A =— rA 9 r2 — -» 

zk=k=k=k=bi=£=:b==g— ^zEpzzip— b~ Bizp=±^ aH 


P    P    ^    P    P    P 
Chorus. 


■I=SlZ=?=B£=SK=|lZZiS=K=tS 

— • — ^— ctp — t? — p — i — u-rf- 


When  the  Saviour  shall  call  me  home.  When  the  Saviour  shall  call 

shall  call  me  home, 

L-JLJ&jfc  #-  -ft-  *  -.*■"-  -♦-  .  -*-   .R 


me 
shall 


e^^Pfp? 


•* A A A— | -A- 

P=|:-£-Er: 


D.S. 


3=5 


-?-$— f-b*F-^-C-i— Vl—  ^—.  ?— •— •-tt?—- p p 1— a 


P     '         V 

home;  Ev'  -  ry  care  will    be  passed,'TwilI  be  heav  en 

call      me  home; 

.  r\    -•-     R  -•-    ■#- 

> s b r — r* ■ A^—r* «— 


J. I 

at     last, 

-f—n 


22 ~m ~ m s r — r* ■ A — r* « * ■ n 

^^^rgz=p=^z=t^E^|iz-p^zz±Efci£^ _. 0 

Copyright,  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughaa,  Music  Publisher  in  "Gospel  Clory" 


No.  18.      Lean  On  the  Everlasting  Arms 


Rev.  Dr.  Alfred  Barratt.  Suggested  by  W,  B.  W. 


W.B.  Walbert 


1.  When  the  path  is 

2.  Would  you  know  the 

3.  You    will  find  the 

4.  He     can  still  the 


lone  -   ly 
full  -  ness 
prom  -  is 
tern  -  pest 
*.        -k- 


and       the  clouds    hang     low, 

of        His  love        di    -  vine, 

es         of  God     are        true, 

till        the  tu   -  mults   cease; 

M. 


z£=t*=cts=~i==Ss~=f:==£==:t— fczzfc^: 


D.S.When  your    heart        is        heav  -    y 


cross     you     bear, 


,-£- 


Fine  Chorus. 

^=|:=D=fcl5=±ii^^-^=Bzzzz=zz:=z:[^=E^=d=^= 


) — a — pS — * — ff** — & — a 

— P    -  -      -      7f~ 

Just  lean  on    the   Ev  -  er  -last  -ing  arms 

SH4— P4 — ^-s — P — t — F — t— Fa-- F4— r-* fc — Is — 

pff-| hp 1 P 9 9 9- 0— H- h hp 1 p — - 


p 


Just    lean     on     the 


£-*» 


J A «  —  £— ?f — pAgj- 

Ev  -er  -last-ing    arms, 


s- 


I    V       J    V       J 


Just  lean  on  the   Ev-  er  -last-ing  arms; 


— h- h— h — h — h — h—h» P •— 


zptzft. 
t2=t2=t2=t3=t3=P?=F=!?= 


Copyright,  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory. 


No.  19. 

G.  D.  McN. 


I'm  So  Happy 


gj— g_  j  ■  f '  ■  j  — i— :^.-l:i— '— I— 3—ijr— I  —  $— 1*~ 

1.  I'm  so  hap -py  since  1  have  found  the  Saviour,  And    He 

2.  I'll  keep  singing  the  grand  old  gos-pel   sto  -  ry,  Of    how 

3.  Soon  I'm  20-ing,  I  can't  stav  here  much  lons-er, To     live 

. A A A A A A A :_A A  A_ 

^^^-4:-* * * A-^-A— 1  A A A A A A A — H 


G.  D,  McNair 

-^ 1 * A 


is  lead  -  ing   me 
He  keeps  me  from 
in    heav-en  with 
-i*  — a a_ 

±=t=Z 


* — 


-I A A 1 

P— h— P— 


F= 


_g — 5"_  »  _g_i 

a 
bless-  ed   fa-vor, 
on     to    glo-  ry, 
Him  grows  stronger, 

-A A A 

—  A A A A 

~~p     D    t>    ' 

D.S.  Hal  -le  -  lu  -  jah,  I    feel  Hi3  pres-'ence  near  me, 

Fine 


all  of  the  way,  to  a;lo  -rv;Now  I'mliv-ing  with  -in  His 
go  -ing  a-stray,oh,praiseHim;He  is  with  me  to  help  me 
Je-  sus   for  aye,  oh,  elo  -  rv;  Ev  -'ry  mo-ment  my  faith  in 

_. —    a "m 3 —  ----- , A — A — a 1_a — a_ 

ffS-b--— ■ — >- — ■ — 2  — ~ — F* — i — f- — t— •-B — t- 


fe-^=:fc:==:d=:=d: 


day. 


That's  why    I'm  hap  -  py,  hap  -  py,    ev    -     'ry 

ev    •    'ry    pass 

1       J  h       * 


ing       day. 


il| 


:g: 


Z=£z 


-ft— g- 


r- 


^ 


Chorus 


IP     M' 


zzr^zr: 


==£=£ 


CT# 


<*     i? 
v      y 
I'm 


*=t 


*3 s» 


:i — i 


u     ^     P 

so    hap-  py      in      this,  gos    -        pe!    way, 
am    oh,  so    hap  -  py     in     this   old     gos  •  pel    way     to    glo  -  ry, 

A A A rA A A - At if" A -^ 

â– i 1 9 ft (-,â–  

ft ft K h ** 


1 


M.  w  • — 1» — « — » — i 1 ' \~ 1 « ft 


— <p- 


2^=: 


ft et 1 


W         1/ 

Serv 


:fi- 


-d — ah 


£-- £- 


-3z 


D.S. 


=3=*=te 


1/  V        9 

-     ing    Je-  sus,   from  Him    I'll 


/     -y      V      y      V      V 
not    stray; 

Serv-ing  bless  -  ed    Je- sun,   from  Him   I       will  not    stray,  no,  nev  •  er; 


§-\t-> £=£ — l f — •— c — F" B i- 1 * ? ^ — ~ :\ 

-       — D: — p — p — D — f- — ^— tt>— p— t?— P — " — p— P— p^ 


u    u .  -  u     p    y    ' 

Copyright.  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory," 


No.  20. 

c.  w.  c. 


A  Heaven  to  Gain 


Clyde  W.  Cox 


i-fH-^-  F* — * — ^ — * — j) — *— F* — S — 9 — 8— F* ^ — » 

1.  I      bave  heard  of      a    beau- ti  -  ful    Cit  -  y,    Far     a  -  way    o'er     the 

2.  Man-  y   times  in    this  world  Pro  dis  -cour-aged,And    it  seems  that     my 

3.  The    re  •  deemed  ones  of    God  soon  will  gath  -  er,  Up      in    heav  -  en     with 


;S=pizz:tzzizz|i=z|s: 


:t=t=t=L»: 

-1© 0 0 }-0- 


S 


•j  ^^ i — a- » * 


dark   roll-  ing  sea; 

work    is      in  vain; 

Je   -  sus    to  stay; 

.9..      ft.    .eOi, 

5#-# 0  — =H0 r~ 

-=F=0— fcn=E 


'Tis  a  place  of  sweet  rest  for  the  wea  -  ry, 
But  there's  al  -ways  one  tho't  that  still  cheers  me, 
And   will  praise  Him  with  sing  -  ing    and   shout  -  ing, 


zfc=I=n=fc 


=^:=:tfc:b=^=t2=t2: 


â– *-     -k- 


H 


-es~ 


Chorus. 


• ,  a>9      a»^ ,9      9 

Who  from  sor-row  and  sin  aremadefree.     Tberethe  Lamb  is    the  light    of   that 
There's  a  beau- ti  â–   ful  heav-en   to    gain.    When  my  life  here  is    o'er,    I    will 
On     the  hills   of  bright  glo- ry    for    ave.      i         will  join  with  that  throng  glad- lv 

.k.     .k.  .0-     .«.     _k.       ",*rs  -•-     -•-     -*-    -*«-«<        -(»- 

pl=t==t==F?=P,=?=t===t=t=r:?i=2=fl==s--r±:=±:ri=i:~-==t==j 
f#h0 — »—)-» — * — 0 — » — 9 — •— h~^=^! — lu — H— !-• — • — » — • — » — •  - 1 


-&--*>- 


i> 


-H r-0f ♦ K- 


=%=: 


-y      so  bright,And  He  smiles  as    He    sits   on  His  throne;     What    a 

ev  -  er  -more  With  the   Sav-iour  who    died  on  the   tree;       That   will 

'-  ing   our  song,  How  we     o  -  ver-came  sin    and  the  grave;      And   we'll 

.ft    .p.    .«.   .«.    .ft.    :B"    :S:     ■:    .t     e.  f:    .*r^e. 

y- 


y — y — y — ?—y       


9       9 9        9        *vw^* 

of     re  -joic-ing  and  sing- ing, When  at    last  He  shall  call  for  His  own. 

a  glad  day  for  Hischril-  dren,  And  a    hap-  py  home- corn-  ing  for   me. 
)  our  dear  Sav-iour  for-  ev  -  er,  For  His  won-der-ful  pow-  er     to  save. 

--*--*--*-    -it-    «     -'-   -6s-   -v-   -it-     __  -*r  ,-•"  -k- 


£— fcz=ti- 


— i — ra — «  _ 

0— h0 9 


p-|-z=±=±=:t=qji-|- 


.0 & g, 0—V-0 0 9 9 0 0- 

p=c--efc=£=Fp=p=p=D=p: 


Copyright,  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory. 


No.  21.       Wonderful  Joy  is  in  My  Soul 

Fay  WaJlington  Roy  L.  Johnson  and  Herbert  E.  Pace 

v—  ^-fr«— •-*—?— 3--.5L— ^— 1~ -i.~5— •- ^—*— ♦-—  •-•--3 

1.  Since  the  dear  Saviourcamc  and  saved  me  from  the  old  life  of  sin  and  shame 
2.1  was  a  sin  -  ner  lost  and  straying  far  from  the  shel- ter  of  His  fold, 
3,  When  1  get  home  I  want  to  tell  Him  what  His  sweet  love  has  done  for    me, 

■=W — ft — f 


j g »■  — = — r  — - 

0  p-  p  .p  p  vp. 'â–   u  p  .p  a.  *â–   p 


:=:=*=.-pz=t_t*_p:=" — i 


-fc- 


W==^ 


:=t5:FH' 


i-r^-^zrtod? 


? — * — 0 — 0 — 0 — 0 — • — 1 0 — ,# — K^ 1 


D.  S.  Won-der-ful  joy 


is     in     my  aoui; 


eas 


Won-der-ful  peace  and  joy    is    in      my  soul,    is     in    my  soul; 

j~A — -A—  * & A £ A s| £ r= =- A A m — 

B — #-^— •-cii.— 1~. *-- ♦•.— 3— •_- -*.— ^— *-n— «— h— *— --^ 

Now  I    can   go  my  way  re-  joic  ing, spreading    a-broad  His    wondrousfame, 
Now  I    am    on  my  way    to  heav-en    and  the  bright  Cit  -  y   made  of    gold, 
And  with  the  saints  of  all    the    a-  ges  praise  Him  for    all     e  -  ter  -   ni  â–   ty, 

_ ± A A— j it & ! * r-» • *. * *— T 

^bP^PP^uP^Pp  I 


Then  a  -gain  yon-der  I'll   re-peat  it,  sing-  ing   with  heaven's  hap-  py  throng, 

fr    Ej  js^C    '  '     """"i  & & J^ 


c^: 


-  v     v     v     v    v     v     v  v     9     V     tf     r 

Won-der-ful   joy  is     in    my   soul. 

Won-der-ful  peace  and  joy    is     in    my  soul,   is     in    my  soul. 

0.     .       h     P    ^    J     i 

;jiEE|EEEEeEi^[EEEEE 


Chorus. 


D.S. 


ii=j 


— s- 


Glo-  ry  to  God,the  whole  day  long, the  sto -ry    of    love  will    be    my  song, 


Erfrfr 


«- 


:p= 


P=E=£ 


:£=*: 


— p: 


gl^SlSjsa 


Copyright,  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher  in  "Gospel  Clory' 


No.  22. 

w.  w. 


Where  the  Flowers  Bloom  Forever 

Willie  Willmurth 


tj:.:-ir    »~  ^w*    — w    i     r"  „ 

1.  There's  a  bright  and  sbin  •  ing   riv  -  er  where  flow-  ers  bloom  for-  ev  -  er,    Just 

2.  Down  be  -  side  the    riv  -  er   flow- ing,  the  tree    of    life    is    grow- ing,  In 

3.  On  some  bright   e  -  ter -nal  morn-ing,  with  shin -ing  crowns   a -dorn- ing,  We're 

-A-     -A-         A-  -A-         ~        -A-       -A-       -         -A-  -A- 

?^Z=|i=^|i=fc=!i=pgZ=gZ=?!=pu=^=zrj=n=p:— £==.— Z 


::&: 


-& 


j — I 1 

3 — • — -d 


& 


out  a-cross  the  great  dark  di -vide;  There  we  all  shall  live  to-geth- er,where 
E  -den,madefor  all  ofGodsrace:  'Tis  a  joy  to  singandtell  it,  with 
go  -  ing  where  the.sweet  flow- crs  bloom,  4nd    I    hope  to  meet  you  broth-er,    a    - 

-A-1       A-     -A-     -A-     -A-  /■—>  'A-     -A-     -A-  -A-       „         -A- 

-=■  h: :szpt=— =A=z£={:Air_-pK=i— ■<    :     -^ *"-■—  - 


w_Ai_Js — % — fc_pcr3i- 

— i — p— p— p-Lt— r 


â– K 


-p-p-Lh— p-p— p- 


"5 *" 


t- 


!~1^z=^> 


M— n— fs— £-- 
r        i> 

comes  no  storm-y  weath-er,  With  Je  -  sus  we    shall  be     sat  -  is  -  fied. 

glad-  ness  we    will  swell  it,  This  Gar-  den  Is       a    won-der  -  ful   place, 

gain,  and  know  each  oth-  er,  Where  fiow-  ers  shed  their  sweet-  est     per-fume. 

-A-       m        -A-                                            -A-      -A-       A  A         -A-         - 

£— v — l — it — k — hk — k — k — Yj  —  —  — ™ — r 


Chorus. 


Ijlzzz 


-fri 


1/;  .v..  â– â– :  i  P     i      i 

Hal  -  le  -  lu  -jahswill  be  ring-  ing, and  the  saints  will  all    be  sing-  ing,  Free  from 

Will  you  meet  me    by  the  riv  -  er,wherothe  flow-  ers  bloom  for-  ev  -  er,  I     Will 


_. >, _. -A-      -A- 

zrzzAZz^r-JkZzEzzzzzzzzz.'s.—tizzz 

-F — ! P h— c" P h h 


^2 


z^i=izz:iz:Ej?z=»=i:?=Ep-Ep=zEiz=^=i|?==E^zzi==5=E5zzE^: 


sor  -row  and  free  from  all   care; 


:^_« — pzzzazz 

■t— P l- 


-I — Lh- 


gtEfeit1 


.miss  you  if      you  are  not  there. 


Copyright,  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory," 


No.  23.  Sing  Hallelujah 

Charles  H.  Huff  M.  D,  McWhorter 

y \2 p \J 3 — tA A A &  —  — | 1 1— 

j m J ■ J — \-i 1 1 1 — h^ 9 s— 


z$ * *— L  *J — it- 
am    so      hap  -  py      as        I    trav  -  el  a  -  long,  Je  -  sua     has 

2.  He's     my  com  -  pan -ion  where- so    -  ev  -  er  I  go,    Giv- ing    me 

3.  When  I'm    dis  -  cour-aged,  and    so     lone  -  ly  and  sad,    He  comes  to 

**p-ii-4 A !A— — A A *— — 14 l*— — IA— — ft- i£.; h'A A A 

B  j_  |  p  ^  _  _  ^_    p  |  p  |  y  r  v 

J — - — * — * — — ^ — ^— * — a— tj— i— 3— * 1 * * — d 

saved  me    and  has  filled   me  with  song;Broth-er,  comejoin     me      ia      this 
peace  and  joy  the  world  can-  not  know;That's  why    1     want     to       tell      it 
cheer  me    and  His  love  makes  me  glad;  Glo  -  ry    for-  ev  -    er,      I       will 


m * * 


F=£ 


-A »- 


-P — P — i tg — \-» — m — 9 — j-- 

'-A — F- ^ 1* 1 — V-A—A— A A A1 1ft' A : 

-h-Lh— h— h CD — I — P — P — P — P — P" 


-tr-tr 


--£— p- 


— ?=>-,-  -D — i p- 


first* — A A ™ 1 — \-A A A A S A 3 — h 


Fine. 


-rir 


cho  -  rns  of  love,Sing  hal  -  le  -  lu  -  jah,  un  -  to  Je  -  sus  a  -  bove. 
wher-e'er  I  go,  Sing"  hal  -  le  -  lu  -  jah,  and  His  true  love  to  show, 
tell     of    Hisfame,Sing  hal  -  le  -  lu  -  jah,  to    His  won  -  der  -   ful  name. 


42. 

-t: 


Chorus. 


D.  S.  Sing   hal  -  le  -  lu  -  jah, 'twas  for    you    and     for     me. 


f-f" 


r=z==— tj=jz^=g=} 


ir-tr 


f— PC 


V      I       "      U     !/      W  •  V  1/ 

Sing  hal-  le  •  lu  -jah, He's  a    won-der-ful  King, Sing 


-a 


-■ — = — 
-p— J- 


le  -  lu  -jah,  let   His 


e 


■» — ,*~tti — P'F" — —  —  ^ 

■It IA A— gsr-fc — — j 


--P— |. 


4> 4 

-■Frr«i 


D.S. 


-7d 


gladprais-es    ring;Tell    of   His    dy  -  ing    on  mount  Cal  -  va  â–   ry's  tree, 


-A—  R-- 


P— ^— P rp-r-5~t-v— p— p-^ * 

Copyright,  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory." 


No.  24. 

James  Rowe 


He  Will  Meet  Me  at  the  Gate 


Jesse  B.  Hardin 


-Trt — x, P — h+-d — il — «—■ ii ! ^ 


*_$ — a — « — 4 — a— #— h — i — 9 — •--*-# — # — « 

_^M_     _aL       _h&L      _AI_  ^         _A_      -A_      .A).  ™         „A..  ~ 


Ti—  i— ,a 


0    b^  1/    u 

1.  With  the  great  Com-mand-er  home-ward  go-ing   to  -that  world  a- bove,hap-py  heav-en; 

2.  When  I    feel  His  might-y  arms  a -round  me,    I    can  sing  and  smile, on   myjour-ney; 

3.  Soon  will  dawn  the  great  e  -ter-nalmorn-ing,then  His  face  I'll  see,  my   Re-  deem  -  er; 

-j — £ A— A — A — A A ■ A 4--r4 A » « ^ s? 1 

^#=rz:tzztzztz:t^ 


P    P 

Tru-  est  faith  in  Him  each  day  I'm  show-ing, trusting  in  His  love, to  me  giv  -  en; 
Knowing  that  His  love  that  sought  and  found  me,  keeps  me  all  the  while,  hal- le  -  lu  -  jah: 
With  a  shin-ing  crown  my  soul  a-dorn-ing, praise  His  love  for  me,  in    the  glo-ry; 


m 


$    $    $    $    P    P 


fi- 

_ji_ 

-a— 
ztz 

—4 — 

=E 

-p- 

&_ 

ZAZ 

ZkZ 

p 

P 

p 

rtzztizz^ 


P     P     P 


f* 


p  p 


All  the  way  by  Him  I'll  be  at-tend-ed,  for  His  kindness  great,  will  be  with  me, 
Dai-ly  He  will  guide  and  keep  from  sor-row,  in  the  path  called  strait,till  I  see  Him, 
1      will  fol-low  on  and  doubt  Him  nev-  er,  to  that  blest  es  -tate,Hal-le  -  la  -oah, 


-  IV  *i  X 

— & A — A A — A A &— r& -A A ~ A — «~  1 

zztzztzztzili-rziszzpzzrtzz^ziEtzztzztzzilzzpzzr^j^zz^zij 
=^z=te=iszik=szi^kzz:^zz^=F£zzgzzgzz:pzz:zzz:tiz=dzzP— E3 


tf^tfPPPPPPppp 

.  S.  And  when  I  shall  en-ter  they  will  greet  me,  and  with  rapture  great,  I 


shall  see  them, 

Fine. 


e j — 3 — a—o ■_  C s> — ,*. — *-+!■- — •— ? 


p  b  b  t  "5" 

And  when  marching  here  for  me  is  end- ed  meet  me  at  the  gate, in  the  morning. 
In  the  glo-ry  world  some  bright  to-mor  -  row  at  the  pearl-y  gate,in  His  glo-ry. 
He    will  then,that  I  may  praise  Him  ev- er, meet  me  at    the  gate,  in   the  morning. 

p  ft  ft  r>  h 


ft  ft  ft£ 


PS     W     PS  Jr1!*-   ■*•  +~  +--    -^-    -♦-    -1—    -r-    1—   -r^-    ■*■    ■♦'-'   •*'■'  h*     -*- 

--A — A'—* — yA-A — A — A— A . 1 r 1 1 1 Vs- 


m^ 


â– ^=p=p=p=p=^--r-FN 


pzzfctpzzpzzpzzpzzA: 


But  the  best  of  all,  I  know  my  Lord  will 
Chorus.  , 

!ffizzzzzzz==— ^-— — — — 


„_SJ_. 


-=j — e — »- 


me   at    the  gate,  in   the  morning. 


.-P.--P--P 

:szz^zz5jz 

â– H- 


£- 


-<s- 


_qr_A 


tilJDij     y  ^  p  p 

He  .      will  meet  me  at 

Will  be  with  me        in  the  morning 

a  ft  ft  n  na  ft  ft  p  p 

=| — a— A — A — A — =!■ 


thegate,hal-  le  -  lu-jah, 


—A— A — A — A — =| — A — A— A A— pA A A g ; g ■■ 


Copyright, 1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory." 


He  Will  Meet  Me  at  the  Gate 


D.S. 


--»—#—•—(■—  •— ^— »— 0 — P — •-Jq^ — <, — ^ — ^—^i 


V      V 


b  b  u  d  â–   b  b  y  u w'   '   '  '      b  b 

Where  my  loved  ones  for  me  wait,with  a     wcl-come; 

In  the  glo-ry        hap-py  sto  -ry, 

fj  fifi  p       ft  ft    p    |S 


No.  25. 

Yale  E.  Payne 


-g — A — A — A *— r~ 

i  V     V     V     V 

The  Sweetest  Music 


y 


John  E.  Hull 


Z±Z^tr 


1.  Glo-ry  with-in   is  well-ing,that's  why  I'm  glad- ly    tell-  ing.Je  -  sus  to  -day   is 

2.  No  moro  my  heart  is  pin-ing,  love-light  with-  iu     is   shin-in  g,Bak  -  ing  my  path-way 

3.  When  I    gethonie  to  glo-ry, glad- ly    I'll  sing  the  sto  -  r>,Walk-  ing  the  streets  of 

V     i       V      V      V      V      V 

-si — 9 — =\— S • — •  — • — - — « M — P- 

— I 1 ! — £i 1 1 1 1 !— r« 

-<H— « LA — A A A A— fr* 


c^=1zz^r. 


:=h: 


d- 


trirsrl 


PiP 


mine;  He  free-ly  gives  me  a  song  of  glad-ness,driv- ing  a  -  way  all  sad-ness, 
bright;  With-in,the  joy-bells  are  9weet-ly  ring-ing,  glo-  ry  to  me  'tis  bring-iug, 
gold;     And  with  the  mil-lions   of  earth   a -wak-ing,  glo- ry,  we'll  all  bemak-ing 

^^z^z^z^=^~hzEp=t==p=p=p=p— p=b^— tzzt— kzzs— ^=tzJ 


Twp  -p    t? 


fc= 


â–        p*  h    Chorus. 


,h  1 


/foH7  J      *! — »— ?S— rH— r— ' — '— V\ — 5 r* — 


F=t= 


-9— p- 


^« 


Mu  -sic  of  love  di  -vine. 
Mu  -sic  of  love  and  light. 
Mu  -sic  that  ne'er  grows  old. 
-*-   -*- 


P A- 


The  sweet-est  mu  -  sic  with- in     >s    ring   -   ingf 
Each  day   it  fills  me  with  joy  ^ndglad  -  ness, 

h 


itf^zti: 


» — • — *-ftr — »-l- \—i — j— • — =4t^ha — *-H* — «— «-h-! 


and  I  am  glad-ly  sing  -    ing,Won-der- ful  songs  of  love;       Mu-sic  from heav'n a-b  ore. 
driving  a- way  all  sad    -  ness, 

Copyright,  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory." 


No.  26. 

A.  M.  P. 


We'll  Still  Sing  On 


Adger  M.  Pace 


!=^& 


1.  When  we  get  home 

2.  Oh,  won't  that  be 

3.  No  grief  nor   pain 


some  morn-ing  bright, 
a    hap  -  py   day, 
no  tear-dimmed  eyes, 


ST h 1 1 '- P-  P- 1 Ck k k k k 1 


) — = — g— q-rgi 


To  that  good  land 
When  we  get  there 
No     dy  -ing  there, 


Iz-ig-ri 


3 js Is. 'a: 

P — f — t?" 


where  comes  no  nig 

with  Him    to    stay; 

no  sad  good  -byes; 

â– A-      -A- -A- 


\-  O 0 * SP «?- 


-b— t3— ^— b-1 


b_^b.: 


JbzfcdL 

:t3=bz=bz: 


-I- 


With  all  the    mil 
To 


-Sizzsz: 


o1- 


=??E=3=z^ 


geth-er    with 
While  a  -  ges  there 


Hons  gone  be-  foregone  on  be-  fore, 
our  loved  and  owu,onr  loved  and  own, 
have  come  and  gone, have  come  and  gone, 


-as-      -m-      -»-        -as-       -«-       -sr 

3zzfr- ^i— fcfe g=^fe=S--E:=E— g 


.5. We'll  all    be  there 


"b— b— b— t?~P— £ 


with  those  now  gone,with  those  now  gone, 

Fine. 

-A- 


4* 


4^4 


We'll  praise  the  Lord 
We'll  sing  and  shout 
In  praise  to  Christ 


1 


3— g- 


y  v 

for  -  ev  -  er-more. 
a-  round  the  throne, 
we'll  still  sing    on. 


bL 


■—  Pa — 


ib.— p—  pzzit: 


For  -  ev  -  er- 

Chorus.    k 

â– A N P 


we'll  still  sing    on. 


Ten  mil-  lion  years,  ten 

Ten  mil-  lion  years, ten  mil-  lion  years,ten 


mil- 
mil- 


lion more, 

lion  more, ten   mil-lion  more, 


I — «* — * — 1_ — 
!£ph^-rP 


-k k k 


Copyright,  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory.' 


b— b; 


-b~ 


— i 


♦ — #• 


o1 


We'll  Still  Sing  On 


D.S 

-A- 


p-B 


And  then  ten  mil 


p    U    i>  â– "â– â–   b---> 

lion  o'er  and  o'er,  yes, o'er  and  o'er, 


-2i— S- 


^=£^=E=M=?=8=?=?=i 


i&z=£=pr^=£ 


tL—  ^=»=z»iztaz=p=:tP=t3=t2= 


P=P=P=! 


No.  27. 

A.  M.  P. 


In  Glory 


Adger  M.  Pace 


1.  What  a    joy 'twill  be    in     glo   -  ry,    For  the    ran-somed  of    the    Lord, 

2.  On    that  morn-ing  when  they  meet  Him  In      His    maj  -  es   -  ty     on   high, 

3.  Oh,     I    want  to   join  them  sing  -  ing    In     that   cho-rus,  loud    and  long, 


-A-       -A-  -A-  -A- 

^J=kz=ti=Ei=z:^=^— (c=  its: 

—  — t? — t? — i — i — I — I — *- 


-A- -A- -A- -A- -A- -A- -A4 

:t. — t — pt — L — k — k — Ft — 1 
-p — tP— c crr-3 


_Q , I I | K ._. I I I „_)_, 

Jfo M u-\-\ \~ 1 1 — — i "I — <* -g — I— 1 *l *l 1 — j-^f-J 

■9 — « — m — \-» — # 0— W \-m 1 H " \-0 1 <q vi — — -~t 

m — ♦ — ♦— c, 1 1 5 — cs — &—p — B_c» — «, — 3 — j«=r^_3 

When  they  sing  the  grand  old  sto  -  ry, Sweet -est  sto  -  ry  ev  -  er  heard. 
Shoutsof  joy  will  rise  to  greet  Him, Fill  -  ing  all  the  earth  and  sky* 
While  the  bells  of  heav'nare  ring  -ing, That      e  -    ter  -  nal    glo  -  ry    song. 


Chorus. 


m 


That  will  be     a    day    of     glo  -  ry,    Io    the    Cit  -  y  bright  and    fair; 


g£ 4 ^_i_p p p 3 L2 ^— ^ 4 C* * C<S—0 

Sing-ing  out   the  grand  old    sto   -  ry,    Of    the    Sav-  iour     o  •    ver  there. 

.       ,A.       .a.       Mi 


^pSSJ  f:Mpl 


Copyright.  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory,' 


No.  28.       I'll  Reach  My  Long  Sought  Home 


Rev.  Rupert  Cravens       Theme  by  J.  C.  W, 


J.  C.  West 


=:±=E±=::E> 


zS: 


IE 


:^5: 


:±==1,: 


1 


1.  Here  my    stay      is  tran  -sient,     I 

2.  Through  the  years   I've  la  -bored,    go    â–  

3.  With  the   jour  -  ney  end  *  ed,     IU1 

4.  Those  who  left     me  lone  -  ly        in 


VTaH*- 


-â– V=V- 


am    on 
ing     at 
be   hap 
this 'World 

-> — ri — 

—  ifc Hfc— 

EgzEE 


ly    pass  -  ing  through, 

the  Lord's  com  -mand, 

py,  glad,  and      free, 

of    death  and      pain, 


? — h — ^ — Pi — P — t^-zb— =s- 

g~i~— il — ^ — ^ — ^    s     * 

I've   a  home  much  bet-ter  wait- 
He   has   led  me  gent-ly    o,- 
In    the  home  of  glo  -  ry    Je 
Now  a  -bide  with  Je  -sus,and 


^zz^±±-±-±~ 


ing 
ver 

'  sus 

I'll 


-1a — * — 1a 


out 
hills 

has 
meet 


be  -yond  the 
and  des  -ert 
pre-pared  for 
them  once  a 


-gj — a — ii — 


fe=5zz5^=g=g-^=^=:^-l3=:p==l2--p=tez|P--_i 


biue;Ev'-  ry    day   I'm 
sand; I      have  passed  the 

me;Tliere  with  all     ro- 
-gain;We  shall  live     in 

-£=£♦—£—£-=:£= 


— * — - — ^ — -?— —     , —      rr  ^^  -«-    ••-    -s>- 


sought 


Fine. 

homo, 


•J  -»-    -«-  y  !/ 

near-er,   as   the  jour-ney    I     pur-sue, 

mile  -stones  on  the  road  to    glo-  ry-land,  Soon  I'll  reach      my  lon§ 
deemed  ones    I  shall  shout  the  vie-  to  -  ry , 
glo -ry    as     in  peace  with  Him  we  reign, 

*       _*P|     -A-       !' 

£*— £zz£ Jzt2_Pa— I — -— zl~zz*z: :*zz*nK— zzziL u    11 


.;,;:;— g==^=p-[ig=°=P-p—E=j=JE^=:— 


Chorus 


k— :&— P— IN" ^ 


mmMimMmm? 


At 

-•- 


set  â–   ting    sun       I 


shall 
â– o- 


be 


go 


1/  '     V:  :    V 
ing,    shall     be 


go 


S£ 


-y y 


ing, 


&- 


h -fc -b 


l^=m=i='=i=i= 


--45: 


To        my    sweet    home 
.*-.        .A-         A 

.._-£ Jt it it 


a 

-A- 

_±*_ 

-5- 


p       7      1/       y       y 

cross    the    foam,    a  -cross  the    foam; 


_t 


-  -— H*~:='*:=i==*— — -=— -=~*: 


^^zzzfc 


it 


J=tP 


Copyright,  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory." 


I'll  Reach  My  Long  Sought  Home 


J> — 4^-ti- — p 

ft       i LS^ *, 5 4 J J3 


-H h«|-— -gl 


My   heart    with    joy       is 


•a- 


-2 — &- 


ver  -  flow  -  ing,     o 

ffcq 


D.5. 


1/      V 
ver  -  ilow  -ing, 


$=£ 


P P- 

p=fi: 


y 1/- 


t       g 


No.  29. 


Goodby 


James  D.  Vaughan'. 


it 


j=J=j=N 


se 


=t 


* 


--«" 


3 


■-Jr— ur£— 
"l.  Sav  -  iour, bless    us      as     we    part,  Fill    our    souls  with  love     di  -  vine"; 

2.  If    »    on   earth  no    more  we    meet,  Let    us    meet    at  God's  right  hand; 

3.  Here's  my  hand  that    I'll     be    true,  For    that  bless -ed    home  pre  -  pare; 

4.  That  will    be      a     hap  -  py    time,  When  for  -  ev  -  er     free  from    pain; 

5.  While   e  -  ter  -  ni  -  ty    rolls    on,    And  new    glo  -  ries    e'er    un  -  fold; 


p— v 


]=£=& 


te 


JL. 


£ 


£=£=£=^=f*k 


its: 


-I — p — \j-\- 


SE 


£: 


jOa 


SgiNiifc 


Com-fort     ev  -  'ry    trou  -  bled  heart,  May 
Where  we  shall  each  oth  -  er    greet, 'Mid 
Will  you  prom  -  ise     me    that  you     Will 
In     that  pure    ce  -  les  -  tial  clime,  All 
We    shall  greet  our  loved  ones  there ,   On 


we    feel  that  we      are    Thine. 

the    glo  -  ries  of      that    land. 

meet    me  o    -  ver    there? 

our  friends  we  meet      a   -  gain. 

the  streets  of  shin  -  ing     gold. 


Good  -  by,  good  -  by, 

Good  -  by,good-by,dear  friends,  good-by, 


on  earth  we  meet  no  more; 


no  more; 


^P 


£ 


:ir  i*'  f 


£=&£=££ 


I 


--£- 


£ 


rir-r 


I^^^P 


J-r-4- 


m 


r 

Good  -  by,  good  -  by, 

Good  -  by, good-by, dear  friends,  good-by, 


rrr 


f 


£ 


f=F 


-J- 


£=fr 


we  meet  on  heaven's  shore. 

bright  shore. 

t.T:n   11,'    ' 


t=t 


iiiii 


fc'>   K 


EEEEEEE 


Junes  D.  Vanghan,  owner. 


No.  30.      I  Wiil  Not  Be  Left  to  Travel  Alone 

Adger  M.  Pace 


J  Monroe  Mobbs 


-a-    -a-  \j  -9- 


J    When  the  time  shall  come  for  me  to    go  from  this  world  of  wick-ed-  ness    be-  low, 

2.  When  the  sun  turns  dark,the  moon  tarns  red  and  the  trumpet  sound  wakes  up  the  dead, 

3.  When  the  saints  shall  leave  this  world   of  sin,    on    a  shin- ing  cloud  of    glo  -  ry.then, 


Etefes 


zzwz 


:^=^: 


I  mil   cot 


ba  left 


6_il_3fc 


-1-fe. 


:=]: 


to  trav  -el     a  •  lone; 
I    will    not     be  left     to  trav  -el     a  -  lone,  a  -  lone; 

fczzg— I— S= :g-  ^=g=g — ^ — P=Fr— "-—  £ 


h^^^4-$^=^^^ES^^^^ 


For  my  Lord  will  sure- ly    pi- lot   me  till    I  cross  the  dark  and  storm -y    sea, 
In    the  twiuk-le    of  these  mortal  eyes.with  the  Lord, I'll  rise    up    in    the  skies, 
For  with  them  I'll  ride  a-cross  the  blue    to  the  land  where  livesthe  good  and  true, 

^ Ell— ^ij_fe=p 


:p=3 

D.  S.  I  will  rise    a-  bove  this  wicked  world  and.  go  sweeping  thru  the  gates  impearled 
__^__ .       ..  Fine 


„ES 


=*e 


3S=S==fe^Efe*. 


-ad — 1 — 3 


thsl: 


_-& 


Si 


I    will   not  be  left  to  trav  -  el    a  -  lone. 

I    will    not    be    left    to  trav  -  el     a  •  lone,  a  -  lone. 


Chorus. 


_£a__2 


n 


— h — ^ — ^ — ^— =b- 


I  will  not  be  left 


trav-el    a  -lone, 


I  will  not  be  left 


to  trav  -el  a  •  lone, 


to 


r>  J>  .*  <h  i 


■— ■— p-  -r-g — ■— -F"  -+-r — H t F^^-P- 


Copyright.  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory," 


I  Will  Not  Be  Left  to  Travel  Alone 


-&>--&- 


D.a. 


w  i     «     \  8  s  c  5  u  r  i  u 

With  the  dear-est  Friend  "       I      ev  •   er  have  known 

With  the  dear  -  est  Friend  I    ev  -  er  have  known, have  known 

— 'I — £ — * — a — fc^li — a — a— -&— Ffc~  vmtmc 


No.  31. 

J.  E.  Rankin 


God  Be  With  You 


W.  G.  Tomer 


is 


-a — s — £ — J— f— ual — ^r~S — uai- 

1.  God  be  with  you  till  we  meet  a -gain,   By  His  counsel  guide, up-hold  you, 

2.  God  be  with  you  till  we  meet  a -gain,  'Neath  His  wings  se-cure-ly  hide  you, 

3.  God  be  with  you  till  wemeet  a-gain,  When  life's  per- ils  thick  con-  found  you, 

4.  God  be  with  you  till  we  meet  a-gain,  Keep  love's  banner  wav-ing  o'eryou, 

|  |     Jk.    -A-   -A-    -A-    -A-    -A-   A- 

— „ — a — * — a— *— hi- — I l*-S-ht — b — b — b — b — tr~  h^-*- 


■#*—#- 


*fczfc 


-j  \  h  ;- h— ^=?5=fe 


z — s_^s — « — m — w — 


rf=|=f5 


=£=£=: 


::£=:£: 


? 


:4=q: 


â– *T 


V     V 
With  His  sheep  se-cure-ly  fold  you, 
Dai  -  ly    man  -  na  still  pro -vide  you,   God  be  with  yon  till  we  meet  a-gain. 
Put    His  arms  un-fail-ing  ronnd  you, 
Smite  death's  throafning waves  be-fore  you, 


5- 


i — i 


yMJ\'r/$r£-t-^M 


Till  we  meet,  till  we  meet,        till  we  meet  at  Je-sus'  feet; 

Till  we  meet,  a-gain,  till  we  meet; 


•A- 


1^3 


£fc£ 


Ai-A-   A  -A. .A- -*i -A-  A14-AJ     fl    J       h     to     ! 


g=^t=ztzto=tfc 


â– Ifc*    14    -A- 


H 


q=q: 


to: 


SEEES-EI^— :tzHEE^tz=n=z!!zEi: 


-1=5 


f 


fcMr 


* 


#= 


F-"? 


las 


Till  we  meet,  till  we  meet,         God  be  with  you  till  we  meet  a-gain. 

Till  we  meet,  a-gain, 

.A-  -a±  .a-  -A-  A   A-  A^  -A-  -A-  „       1 

^z^-trt-r-i #— #-P— d 


m 


:^: 


X: 


£=£ 


:fcf-_L_Lk— k=F=ti=tft= 


S=£ 


No.  32. 

Lon  Craddock 


Wake  Up,  Christians 


M.  H.  Hodges 


— j— I— *—*—?=&--*— ^i—3—± 


--%-$ 


â– 4-T- 


1 


1.  Sin      is     all     a -round us     as     we  trav  -  el    life'sroad, 

2.  He     has  called  the  har-vest,but  the  reap- ers    are  few,   Oh,     let      us 

3.  If       we  have  been  faith-ful,  and  are  saved  by    His  love, 

3 S - 


b~4  *•"  :* — i* — '* — * — * — n — D — '^ — ^ — E — I* 


~P     D    P     P~~"C>     P. 


Wake  up  Cnris-tians,work  for    the  Lord; 

wake  up,  Chris-tains,  work  for    the  Lord    of     glo   -    ry; 

>•         Al  A)  n# A A A     ___ A 


â– & 


■v — P — y — ■- — P=—  y p— :1 


$=*££ 


-4 — + 


*=«=*=^ 


.JJ 


If      we    do     His   will  He'll  sure-  ly    light-en    our   load, 

If      we    fail  Him   here,  in  judg-meut  what  will     rce  do?      Oh,     let     us 

We  will   have    a   man-sion    in    that  Cit  -  y      a  -bove, 

t-^-t--^-%-^~^=^-4=^^ 


,_-£=£=&= g=& 


y— V—  L 


D.S.To   the    lost    and  lone  -   ly.  let    His  mes-sage    be  heard, 


s    Fine  Chorus. 


P_=^3^fiii==^ 


Wake  np,  Chris-tians,work  for   the  Lord, 

wake  up,  Chris-tains,  work  for  the  Lord.  Oh,   let    us 

>     f>    3  11*-    *-    -      - 


S  

— A — A — m — * — a — ,* 


±-_;n:_t:_f: 

L  0 0 0 L.  _ 


^W- 


£& 


3 — *=F* — i — * — g — 5 


I 


is 


Wake  up,  Chris*tians,work  for  the  Lord, 

wake  up,  Cbris-tians,  work  for  the  Lord    of     glo  >  ry, 


* sr 


:p: 


^ 


UP  -hi 


"PtJ  y     y  -y     |      p     *      c      I, 

Copyright,  1948.  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher  in  "Gospel  Clory" 


Wake  Up,  Christians 


£=±M&: 


-fc— *- 


D.S. 


ES=^^= 


Wake  up  Chris-tians.trust -ing  the  word; 

Wake  up,  Chris-tains,  trust -ing  the  word    of      Je   -  sus; 

a 4 ai_ « « d r . a.  _«, j § 

wn — * *. se a, A — 


No.  33. 


£EK=^ 


--  —      gi — « — ^ j-p — pg.     [- — ^ —  j_ — 

What  A  Friend  We  Have  In  Jesus 


JOSEPH    SCRIVEN. 


Charles  C.  Converse. 


_m i> U K  .  â–  . 


rv 


41 


£ 


â– h- 


iF3? 


3t 


s« 


1.  What  a  Friend  we  hare  in    Je  -  sus,      All  our  sins  and  griefs  to  bearl 

2.  Have  we  tri-als  and  temp- ta-  tions?   Is  there  trou-ble    an -y -where? 

3.  Are   we  weak  and  heav  -  y    la  -  den,    Cumbered  with  a   load    of    care? 


K 


s— t-t— C— i 


v=t 


t—i—r-^n^ 


g 


¥=P=^^=£ 


TT~b     P     U=g= 


^ 


J    I    J     B 


J 


* 


3  i  a 


r 


IS 


tff 


4r~L-3r-t 


3F 


What  a  prir  -  i  -  lege   to    car  -  ry 
We  should  nev-er    be    dis  -  cour-aged 
Pre-cious  Sav-iour  still  our  Kef  -  uge, 


Ev  -  'ry-thing  to  God  in  pray'rl 
Take  it  to  the  Lord  in  pray'rl 
lake  it     to    the  Lord   in  pray'rl 


m 


* 


£==£ 


£- 


^=fc*= 


« 


w=&- 


$=£ 


*=*: 


S 


F 


1 — l>    [>    b    l> 


&H  i  i  J'  J1  m 


m 


ffiH^ 


O  what  peace  we  of  - 
Can  we  find  a  friend 
Do  thy  friends  despise, 


ten  for  -  feit,  0  what  need-less  pain  we  bear, 
bo  faith -ful  Who  will  all  our  sor-rows  share? 
for-sake  thee?    Take  it    to    the   Lord    in  pray'r; 


M 


SSE 


3l 


a 


pp| 


i 


ati   4i 


^3 


t^ 


fa* 


^ 


All  be-cause  we    do 
Je  -  sus  knows  our  ev  - 
In  His  arms  He'll  take 


not    car  -  ry 

'ry  weak-ness, 

and  shield  thee; 


m 


*=£ 


rK 


i= — r 


££ 


Ev  -  'ry-thiug  to  God    in  pray'rl 

Take  it     to    the  Lord  in  pray'r. 

Thou  wilt  find  a  sol  -  ace  there. 

"t>    b    t>  p     b 


No.  34. 

Rev.  Walter  E.  Isenhour 


The  Inner  Voice 

R.  G.  Wilkins 

— ^ 9—--* 


1.  An       in  -    ner    voice    is    speak  -ing 

2.  The      in  -    ner    voice    is      bless-  ing 

3.  The     in  -    ner    voice    is     tell   -  ing 


♦- 

so  sweet-  Iy  to  my  soul, 
my  heart  from  day  to  day, 
me      I      should  watch  and  pray 


_— — _  a — . a A ^ 

fa$fc==b« p i * E : C 


-i~ 


:p=^F 


-A *—  -m 


=£*=& 


&-<-4 


And  bids  me  keep     on    seek  â–  

And  bids  me  keep      on    press- 

I  feel  its  sweet     im  -  pell  - 

.IN  -*-  -*-  JN    â–   >-       > 


ing 
ing 

ing 


9 9  +1 *~^~~J 

jqH—  -^ — -3 — 3 — #z=:"^ 

un  -  til  I  find  the  goal; 
a  -  long  the  heav'n-ly  way; 
a    -  long    the      glo  -  ry    way; 

* —  r± * a *■ — *-; — "I 

p=-f-=-=fc=!:= fc-] 


^EE2£ESEElEE 


:3£ 


i 


yond  this  world  of  sor  - 
For  there's  a  home  a  -  wait 
Where  man  -  y    saints    and    sag 

czp.— 1}£=£=:£— z^zzzzpsiz 
w         w        u        y        y. 


row, 
ing 
-  es 


where 

just 

by 


saints 

in 
faith 
>>- 

-r'l 


-M—\ 


heart- 


for  ev  -  er  reign, 
the  by  and  by, 
have    hum-  bly     trod 

—I j A- *■!-, 

— =z=p=£=pJ 

aches  and      no    sighs, 
Fine. 


And    where    a      glad      to  -  mor 
Where  there's  no    sin      nor      hat 


effl£ 


Thru-  out     the       by  -  gone      a 

'k — & — ^ — ji — 


ges 

-,♦- 


b: 
will 

and 
and 


■£=£=$=!=: 


«i — ■ 


:5==P==n: 


set  me  free  from  pain, 

not  a  care  nor    sigh, 

made  it  thru  to    God. 

-»-  -*-  -*-       . 

■f  -f  rr  -b     ♦ 


P=^jc- 


Where  saints  are      in     God's  keep-  ing,    and    glo   -  ry     fills     the  skies. 


r^=^=I=f5=^=- 


The     in  -  ner    voice  di  -  vine  -  ly,     is    bless  -ing    day    by    day, 

The     in  -  ner    voice    so      di  -  vine  -  ly, 


t—t—t—t—1- 


*ttg=#=$z=$=7=g: 


a.    .*.     i.    .^-    .^-     >. 

-* 'a * — h 1 1- !*- 


-*■•- — 

3 


=5= 


:d: 


:p=5= 


1 


Copyright,  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher  in"  Gospel  Glory  " 


V 


PV- 


The  Inner  Voice 


CF^— r 


m— 


j — . 

V 


-4- 


D.  A'. 


And     ev  -  er  sweet  and   kind  -  ly,  leads    up     the     shin  -ins;  way; 

And     ev  -  er  sweet  and     so    kind  -  ly, 


-t—t—t— t—t--t—t— £- 


Ft3E 


j=jz=£T   £    HE 


:; 


*==?=* 


_az:zzzzn  —_  _ — 

No.  35.       God  Plans  the  Best  for  Me 

Lizzie  DeArmond                                                                                    G.  Kieffer  Vaughan 
Kaui-et — i_l_h  _. y_ _^„ — l j_-uS 1 — *(—  F«r— *^ — n 1 — — i— - A -H 

£f =£-«— L«--jv* — <£■ h — L"ji_U" —  ,5, —  9 — l0i — 0 — o__  ,_Jj^__^ S-J 

1.1         can-not    tell,  I      do    not  know  What    in     the  fu-ture  days  may   be, 
2.The(  pres-ent  time    is    all      I    own,  If    troub-les  come  my  Lord  is    there, 
3. So        on  my   way    I    joy-ful    sing, His  hand  di- vine  is    hold-ing    me, 

A rA- * £s  -     I r  F~ — *  — si A 1 ; try- a 


-3-F— ■  j       I — I 
tec" 


r 


r 


inr 


3 1 — c«--^— ^|— •—  *      * — °~ ^—  ^-^ — «—•—■- # — S-° 

If         joy    or    pain  my    lot    be  -  low,  God  plans  the    ver  -  y    best  for    me. 
I  do    not  bearthem  all    a  -  lone, He    lifts  my  heart   a  -  bove  de-spair. 

What  e'er    the  com -ingyearsinay  bring, Godplansthe  ver  -  y    best   for    me. 

— F — rA- — «, c2s r*   — & & A — r£-~tA — — I ri- 

g=fcbi=Iz=!r=p=-Etczzr— t—  fcfcS 


=s=rr:piz=irz=S] 
— tzzfc1 — fc— frzB 


Chorus. 


!tzi^-^=^=^=--T-: 


-tori 


*=&= 


3d 


God  plans  the  ■  best, He  cares  for    me.  In    ev   -  °ry  thing  His  love    I     see, 

■it"      "^T    "TW  ^_     "I-"       "h"  "f©-     "I*"        in.      -|»- 


:c=ty._-^: 


EEE=±— gz=b 


-w- — w- 

■p — y- 


— I- 


4>- 


$=3: 


«- — + 


-SB r-«- R 1- 

-i k«-  —  ^  — H —   ,     , 

:|s=E|si=q— 5-i-F*zr^ 
t~  \j— *— *   -2 -^-fri 


^a=a=3EEgpfe-f 


God  plans  the    best,what  -e'or    be  -  fall,  I'm  safe  with  Him  who  knows  it    all. 

>-    -*f    J5     J  .  i ■'■■•     .  -*-    V  -♦-   -^ 


:p=^: 


-a- 


liiiH 


Copyright,  1929.G. Kieffer  Vaughan,  owner. 


:|i=(ri 


No.  36.      When  We  Reach  Our  Home  in  Glory 


Rev,  Rupert  Cravens 


4^—* 


J.  C,  Cooper 


1.  Press  a  -  long  and  meet  each  test,  soon  will  come  the    day     of  rest, 

2.  Life    up  there  will  sweet  -  er  be,    liv  -  ing    with  the  saints    so  free, 

3.  Loved  ones  of    the    days    of  old,    we  shall  meet   on  streets  of  gold, 

-A-      -A-      -±-  -A- 


fct*=fc 


_* -pi_JCL_^ .* fi m fg- 

-_t2=t3=t:z=:t5z=b=i=t3=^ 


:=^=#:F3===3=F^=fe=M-^-n 


r 


b+jL-b 


P® 


-j±drA 


m 


Keep  your  eyes  on  heaven's  homeland  in  the  sky:  Ev  -  er  trust  the  bless-ed  Lord, 
In'  the  glo  -  ry  light  of  heav-en.nerer  to  die;  Dreams  ofhome  will  all  come  true, 
Brok-en  ties  will  there  be  mend-ed    in  the  skr;  We  shall  see  their  smiles  once  more, 


,<-7  -a-      -■«-     -■- 

F-_-t_r_t: 


:- — +    m    *    »— f— £—  f— • 3--rt-—  ~— P—  i-t-— F— £— "— f— ~— ^~1 


— b Ft*  -£H "^^ -^ 


feast    up- on  His   Ho-  1?  word, Till  ( 

and    the  jour-ney  will  be  thru.  When  we  reac'a  oar  home  in  glo  -ry     by  and  by. 

on      the  shin-ing  glo  -  ry  shore, 

±  -«-  f- 


'St: 


-A-     -A-     -A-     -A-     -A-      -A- 

+--  v— t-1r_4r   ■ t: 


-p— <z_. 


-W-      -B-      -S3- 

-k Jfc tc fe k k K—  rk k k k k- k 1 (ST1 F ^~  t 


Chorus. 


Press  a  -  long  and  look    to  heav  -  en,  where  the  crown  will  soon  be  giv  -  en, 


JL 4_ 


-0, — «■ 


fct^^tzt^^dhfaj 


h     t>.     h  --   ---    -«- 

p_-  _i (_. 

0   p   I 


tz=t=t==t=t=q 

\>    P    b    bb 


-pr 


0-p-r 


Lay  up  treasures  in  the  Cit-  y    in  the  sky;      Nev-  er  faint  nor  fall  a-  wea-ry 


.*__,e_^_ 


tOpSEr31^5 


t533 


*=fc=fc=fc= 


t)  -ft   I 


p  j*  ti  j> 


t 


5SE£?^EEbHEB3EEe 


M 


CoDyright.  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory," 


When  We  Reach  Our  Home  in  Glory 

3 


it— A 


Christ  will  keep  when  days  are  drear  -y,  We  shall  reach  our  home  in  glo-  ry,  by  and  by. 


b   b  f 

No.  37. 


U    U    v    [)    p 

Light  From  the  Middle  Cross 


adger  m.  Pace. 


1.  On      a    lone  hill  -  side  three  were  cru  -  ci  -  fled,  And  to  -  day,  and  to-day 

2.  There  between  two  thieves,  for  the  world  Hegrieves,  What  a  load,  what  a   load 

3.  Je  -  sua  bled  and  died    on     a     lone  hill -side,  Just  tomake,  just  to  make 


33 


5=^ 


r 


=t 


I 


i*M 


±3 


JUL 


33 


1H= 


=§* 


V- 


*J 


* 


» 


I  see,  I  see  One  in  an-guish  toss,  from  the  mid  -die  cross,  There's  a 
has  He,  has  He;  Whilethe  one  re-viled,yet,  the  oth  -  er  smiled,  There's  a 
men  free,  men  free;  Oh,   be  -lieve   to  -  day,  and  you    too  can  say.  There's  a 

/        ,&• A      .  A A_! 


3 L^—- a    E£ 


B  -  r   r 


i 


2=iG 


p    p     i  1      p    p~~ 1      r    r 

D.  S.— Je  -sus  paid   the  loss    on    the  mid -die  cross, 
Fine.    Chorus.     , 


3=t 


* 


# 


T31 


i= 


tir    g 


-~F=£= 


f=F 


^=^ 


CJ         *^      "  III 

Light,  for  me.  There's  a  Light  bless -ed 

there's  a  Light,  for  me.  There's  a   Light, 

g  jg:    £^^  A    J:    jt 


& 


f#^i 


*=r 


gg 


is 


fcst 


s 


^ 


D.S. 


£^£ 


v — I    ^r 


^ 


Light, 


From  the   cross 


I     see; 


bless  -  ed    Light,  From   the    cross       I     see,      I     see: 


Jfe.  --JL      .    _ 

fe   -far    V 


y^g=fc^ 


•A 


# 


rf^MNI 


COPYRIGHT,    103  G,    ADOBE    M.    PACE,    OWTiTEB. 


No.  38,       When  We  Hear  the  Welcome  Bells 


E.  E.  W. 


E.  R.  Ward 


Ffc 


is=r^ 


tt 


y     *  â–   ^   -3.    * 

1.  There's  com-ing      a 

2.  Such   won  -  der  -  ful, 

3.  So        let      us       be 

A A A- A 


££ 


£: 


hap  -  py     glad    to  -  mor-row,  af  -  ter  our 

joy  -  ons    sing  -  ing,shoat-ing,  when    we  shall 

read  -  y,  wateh-iug,  wait-  ing,  when  the  dear 

± & 


==*=£ 


±=~ t— 1— -t 


E^£ 


S 


F 


P  •    p 


-K      k- 


4Vr 


0       P       P 


:*#^=£±§ 


?*-t^- 


-f-iTi 


-•3 

— 9 ' 


y  p  "   "  ""       "  *v  "    â–   r  ^  p 

toil  -ing  here  is  o'er,  oh,glo  -  ry,And  old  death  has  lost  its  sting,iost  its  sting; 
near  that  peaceful  shore,in  glo-  ry.Witb  our  Saviour,Lord  and  King,Lord  and  King; 
Lord  shall  come  a-gain,from  glo-ry ,  And  our  tributes    to  Him  bring,to  Kim  bring; 


w 


m 


% 


m 


-7-p-p- 


9SB 


$=:£: 


=* 


&E£= 


-«-  -*- 

And     we    shall     be      free    from  pain    and  sor  -  row,    go  •  ing  with 

There'll  be    no    more    sin     and      no    more  doubt-ing,  heav  -  en  is 

With  Him    we     shall     go    with      ju  -  bi  -  lat  -  ing,    ev   -  er  with 

~: m * m f" fA A : A A A A A- 


D.  S.  For 


er    with 


te 


3= 


sus,    our      Ee  -  deem  -er,  prais  -ing    Him 

4-* * 3 ii «— tL— W-h  a. ; 


:EH: 


:P: 


-d 


nd: 


-45 


CSIff 


tt 


=1 — I — ff- 


'^3 


Christ  to  heaven's  shore, Dp  yon-der, 

ours  for  -  ev  -  er-more, oh. praise  Him,When  we  hear  the  welcome  bells  ring,swoetlj  ring. 

Him   to  live  and  reign ,  in  heav-en, 

V    IN      f\      I  k  .  I  .  A  '  JN 


;— * 


SSSF 


9 


533 


:*"-4» 


•>♦-    -L--  -#■ 


I 


•  as  we  march  a-bout,  in  heav-en, 
Chorus. 


1 — =T    I     P— g— 


^ 


-W -r) -J J -d- 


KE5 


tafcgzzz*: 


Hear  the    bells  ring  out, 
When  we    shall  hear    the    wel  -  come  bells  ring  out, 

*.:'**  IN        fS        IN        IN        .IN 


:t: 


:t: 


-b--^ 


=J 


Copyright.  194S,  by  James  D.-Vaughan,  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory," 


ft 

iJ 


& 


%£E3 


When  We  Hear  the  Welcome  Bells 

ft— £-=£= 


D.S. 

ft rft- 


« 


Hi 


Glad  and    hap  -  py  shout; 
We'll  raise    a    song    of     joy    and    hap  -  py  shout; 


p.     .£ 


J>    J> 


â– Hfctt 


g — i — w_jzrzz=: 


P=r=tcr±=t=& 


-f^- 


g  — 


fcs 


No.  39. 


WM.  Hunter,  D.  D. 


I  Feel  Like  Traveling  On 


James  D.  Vaughan. 


2fc 


bkgz 


& 


-|- 


-i— i. 


-i — i — _k» 


-§ — L 


â– t- 


1.  My'  heav-'nly  home        is  bright  and  fair,    I  feel  like  trav-el-ing  on; 

2.  Its     glir-t'ring  tow'rs    the    sun    out-shine,  I  feel  like  trav  -  el  -  ing  on; 

3.  Let    oth  -  ers   seek         a   home   be -low,    I  feel  like  trav  -  el  -  ing  on; 

4.  The  Lord  has  been       so   good    to    me,    I  feel  like  trav-el-ing  on; 

-      "1     Tl 


§£rf 


* 


-P- 


t: 


:|t=:t= 


p.      jfL 


-h- 


^mm 


®E-J 


-\- 


=» 


~J — -J- 
-• •- 


4— L 


te^t 


* 


Nor  pain,  nor  death      can     en-  ter  there,  I  feel  like  trav-el  - 

Thatheav'nly   man  -  sion    shall  be    mine,  I  feel  like  trav- el  - 

Which  flames  de-vour,    or  waves  o?er- flow,   I  feel  like  trav- el - 

Un  -  til    that  bless-  ed    home    I      see,     I  feel  like  trav  -  el  -  ing    on. 


ng  on. 
ng  on. 
ng    on. 


i 


-t- 


> |A. 


£=£= 


fcfefefoft 


t=l=P=P= 


• 
-I — r 


I 


Chorus. 


t©-- 


Yes,  I     feel  like  trav  -  el  -  ing    on, 


f=tr- 


trav  -  el  -  ing    on, 


I    feel  like  trav-el  -  ing 


y     ,      ..      . 

on;  Myheav'nly  home  is  bright  and  fair,  1  feel  like  trav-el  -  ing  on. 

trav-el-ing  on; 


£££ 


f-^^-f 


V 


Ccpyrigrbt,  1936.  by  Jamea  D.  Vasshan,  renewal. 


No.  40.  Going  to  the  City  Fair 

Millard  A.  Glenn  A.  J.  Burchfield 


1.  When  we   hear  the  trump-et  sound-ing   in      the    sky,  And  we    see  the 

2.  It      will    be       a    joy    to  meet  Him  on    that  day, And  go  home  to 

3.  Oh,      I    would  not  miss    it    friend,tor  all      the  gold, And  for    all  the 

,             -A-        »        -■£:-     -A-      -4-       -A-  -A- 

=^£3==}nz£— [jzz£=j£:==»=»=±*— •— £z±; 


T" 


-bJ—- J- 


Sav  -  lour  com-ing  from  on  high, All  the  saints  will  rise  to  meet  Him  in  the  air, 
glo  -  ry  land  with  Him  to  stay;  With  our  friends  and  lornd  eaesthero  no  more  to  die, 
wealth  that  this  old  world  can  hold:  1     have  set -tied  all  with  Je -sus   to   gothere, 

-*-     -jfc-     -jSs- 
fe— -I- 1 f 1 1* 1 r-l* 1* 1 


S ^ ^ ^ * y 0 .  J_  L^ 


Chorus. 


3=F«= j=3=lit 


ir 


-4- 

we 


And  go  home  to    live   with-  in    the    cit  -  y     fair. When 

It    will  be       a  grand home-com-ing    in    the    sky. 

Won't  you  meet  me  broth- er,    in  that  Cit-   y    fair?  When  we     see    Him 


§z===? 


^=^=b 


— i=S= E=Etz=:t=SEb 


_,_      /  i     /    i 


==£ 


=3==$=iz^  3= 


see        Him        on     a   cloud  of  light,  With        His  an     -     gels 

com-ing  on     a  cloud  of  light,  With  His  Ho  -  ly     an -gels    in  their 


^f— 4 ^ 41— —- L4 ■ 4 4 4 L4 ; 

in    their  glo  -  ry  bright,Broth   -   er,  will  you  join    us 

glo -ry  bright,  Broth-er  will  yon  join  that  meet- ing      in     the 

Jlijj  J1  -  La  J  ^ 


|g:fe^ 


-♦ — * 
-P=tP 


ES=a=fEEfefe 


1=- 


* 


1=1= 


Copyright,i94S,  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher  in  "Gospel  Glory," 


Going  to  the  City  Fair 


V 

to 


in     the    air?  Go      -     ing  to  that  Cit  -  y  bright  and  fair, 

air?  Go  -  ing  home  to    glo  -  ry     in     the  Cit  -  y    fair. 


=-         1         -•-       # 


z==|=i^=5=:^S=5=S=^£=f=:^ 


No.  41.  Lead  Me  Shepherd 

HENRY   H.    TlLSON.  JAMES    D.    VAUGHAN. 


S^i 


SH=* 


=t 


=1: 


±7 


r_r 


*=±$ 


S=£ 


5 


1.  Lead    me  through  the    fields    of     sun-Bhine,  And 

2.  Lead    me,  Shep-herd,  through  the    val  -leys,  Lest 

3.  Lead    me  through  the  night's  grim  shad-ows,  To 

# ? 1 ""_  rft -f £ ^L 


the    pas -tures  green; 

I       go       a- stray; 

the    per  -  feet  dawn; 


9-4 


P 


gis 


I 


^=P     E     E 


-J= 


On  Thy  arms  of  love  and  mer 
Lead  me,  kind  -  ly  Shep-herd, lead 
Of       the      day      to- which  we're  hast- 


m 


£eM 


•  cy,    Let 

me,     To 

'ning,  Lead 


me  ev  -  er  lean, 
the  per  -  feet  day. 
me    kind  -  ly      on. 


:|: 


P- 


55 


Chorus. 


BE 


=± 


:a: 


* 


§te 


Lead  me,  lead  me, 

Lead  me,     lead  me,   gent  -  ly     lead 

p. p. ft ? rfi fL 


0    Thou  bless -ed    One; 


m 


-f- 


-« 


~IA 


eSII 


&F 


t=t=t 


H 


& 


:=t 


Lead  me,  lead  me, 

Lead   me,    lead   me,      ev  -  er      lead 


Lead 


=*=* 


M^N^MM^ 


me, 


-&* — u 


me  gent  -  ly      on.* 


Junes  D.  V&nffhan,  owner.  1924. 


No.  42. 

F.  R. 


Let  The  Light  Shine  On  Me 


Fred  Rich 


!'    1.  Thru  this    sin  -  ful  world    I    jour-ney.dan-gers  thick  on    ev  -  'ry    hand, 

2.  Lord,    I     want  my    life    to     be      a     light  to    oth-  ers  here     be  -  low, 

3.  Lord,    I  know  that  I'm     a    fail  -  ure,  for  with- out  Thee    I    would    fall, 


in 


,— — ^-A A A A A A_ r^1 f- P A A •» 

^±g:=*=±}» — * — s — !* — * — *■    *    u— Fp — p — p-    l,j     I*    * 


W     P     P 


Lord  I  pray  that  thou  wilt  draw  me  close  to  Thee,  close  to  Tnee; 
When  in  dark-ness  stay  thou  ver  -  y  close  to  me,  close  to  me; 
Yes,    I  know  that  all    my    help  must  rome  from    Tnee,  come  from  Thee; 

IN       IK  | 

a — a a — • — * — a'_J^- — :■: Js. 

HHxi 1 r* • — ' * — h h n * — F* 


±=&=$=fy==$=z 9r_zJt 


:gE3=t=: 


For     I    need  some  one  to  guide  me,  thru  this   wear- y     troub  -led  land, 

Give  me  grace  to    meet  each  tri  -  al     as      I    press    a    -gainst    the  foe, 

Guide  me    safe-  ly  through  each  tri  -  al,    be    Thou  now,  my       all        in  all, 

-k-     -k-      -k- 


A # —    A A A A A A ,_- \- A A _ 

fe»ztr1r — I — r 1 — ' 1 f — f — t — t — tr — t: fc. fc — ~t — J 

*      P      u      P      P      u      p P      U      r  ! 

D.S.On    the  mountain,  in    the    val-ley    or    wher-.ev  »   er 

faP R --H* A A — -™ 1 1 ~  — ™ — r-^l- 


may     be; 

Fine 


Let    the  bless-ed    light  from  hear  •  en    shine  on     me, shine  down    on      me. 


A A A- -A A A ^_ 

y — b»— Ly — v-— P — P — - — - -— 


.__Ai__  Jl_4 


m 


Chorus 


r     *  p 


p     p     r 

Let    the  bless  •  ed    light  fromheav  -  en   shine   on     me, shine     on     me, 

-k-     -k-     -k-  I 

«V--fe-  A_c^ , 


3=p 


p— "p: 


:P=E*==y==£: 


Copyright.  1948.  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory." 


Let  The  Light  Shine  On  Me 


Guide  m«    safe-  It     till      I     cross  the  mjs  -  tic 

rs     "IS       f\ 


sea,    mvs  -  tic     sea; 


^5^=8~EB:==b-=d-:*-=^=:-P:::-s:=:iz"==E*!::::r"»::-z^ — •— 


No.  43. 

J.    M.    HENSOM. 


Be  Still  And  Know 


W.  H.  Nelson. 


mnu,{  ±^m=^m^ 


1.  Fear  not,   0    soul,   a -long  life's  way,  Tho' rough  the  path  that  thou  dost  plod; 

2.  God     is    thystrenghin  time  of  need,    A   pres-ent   help  when  troubles  come; 

3.  He    mak-eth  wars  and  strife  to  cease,  The  spear  He   cute,  the  bow  He  breaks; 

4.  The  Lord   is  with  thea     on  thy  way,  Fear  not  the  path  that  thou  must  plod; 


£ 


i=£ 


££ 


* 


Si 


B« 


PsR 


^ 


£$ 


rs=^ 


v — y — y-7 


I— I  It:    3=^= 


£ 


*N 


'it 


* 


3 


f 


I 


Let  not    the  winds  thy  soul  dis-may,"Be  still  and  know  that    I 
He      is     a    wondrous  friend  in-deed,  And  guides  His  trust-ing  chil  • 
He   bring-eth   ev  -  er  •  last  •  ing  peace,  Thesleep-ing  na-tious  He 
Take  heart  and  press  a  •  long  each  day,  Be   still  and  know  that  He 


£=£ 


g=fr-tr  b  E  1^=^=^ 


s 


* 


am   God.' 
dren  home. 

a  •  wakes. 

is     God. 


Chorus. 
JV 


£=fc 


fe£ 


"Be    still  and  know  that  I     am  God,  Be  still  and  know  that 

A-     .Ai    -A     _a     A-     -Ai 


IS 


I 


^fa 


am   God;" 


P* 


-k     Ia 


V=&=v 


g'U-U. 


p    b  'r 


LJ LU 


i  b    b — b 


a 


r 


FT^ 


When  cares  dis -may,  I    hear  Him  say,  "Be  still  and  know  that 

-A     -A      At 


say^ 


am    God." 


A    A-   A^-    ~  A-^A-AAAj-AAi?- 


P=P=^= 


COPYRIGHT,    1S35,    BY   JAMES    D.    VAUGHAN. 


No.  44. 

Arr.C.  T. 


My  Lord  is  Watching  Over  Me 

New  Arr.  by  Curtis  Taylor 


ME 


-L« a « — 


S 


z^=^ 


-fc-r 


-W -9~ 


i 


1.  Oh,     I 

2.  I         am 

3.  When  my 

-A 


feel     bo     glad     to  -  day,    I'm  shout-  iog     on    the 
sure     He    loves    me    too,     be  -  cause   His  word    is 
voice    n©    more    you    hear,  dear  friend  don't  shed    a 


way, 
true, 
tear, 


I    know 


&S 


my  Lord    i9    watch-ing     o 

Al jfc- 


ver   me,    yes,    o »  ver 


■ 8 — 


|zz=gz=p=PL- 


S 


EH 


H 


±=t 


M— i 


» 


« 


b    l>    b 


"P~~cr 


$5: 


t*f->4  ■■..£& 


1 


SS£ 


t) 


And  His  lov  -  ing  voice  I  hear  in  tones  so  sweet  and  clear, 
I  will  ev  •  er  do  my  best  to  win  in  ev  -  'ry  test, 
For     I'll      be     on    heav  â– =  en's  shore  where  sor  -  rows  are       no    more, 


7T & A r|4 a * ±- — 


m 


tm-- 


:Jk=|£=±|5: 

y  â–   u     u 

D.  S.  Where-ao  -  ev 


r- 


=e=t 


$=EP=S= 


II 


tefe — te 


.-rszzca 


er 

-fi &L- 


I     may     be,     on     land    or     on     the     sea, 

k       k       h.  s.  Fine. 

-P P & n P— -ft- 


£ 


^3q 


H 


Oh,   I     know  my  Lord    is   watch-ing     0  -  ver  me5  yes,   0  •  ver   me. 


fcrzEf 


=t2=t2= 


£ 


Chorus. 


*=f 


M 


$=$==£ 


— its — Tx-zfe: 


iS=\     §         rhrj=g 


& 


1    know  my  Lord,  is  watch-ing    me, 

E    know  my  Lord  is  watch-ing  me, 

.  „      .J  J  j  fc  .  ,      .  J?  J>  J* 


I 


1. 


rf 


p=e=F=5=^ 


Copyright  1948  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher,  in  "gospel  glory.' 


r 


My  Lord  is  Watching  Over  Me 


:^=$=^— :£: 


-&— £- 


D.S. 


e;    — -?-—  -*— -i— S— *  '     ^       ^       p       p     Bf       f       ; 

And    ev-'ry- thing    I       do    He'll  sure -ly     see,    He'll  sure -ly    see; 

h       h 


ru 


3E 


No.  45. 

James  Rowe. 


Tell  it  Everywhere  You  Go 

W.    B.    WALBERT 

-J I I U_ . & 


£ 


:i 


-J — L 


^__4ZJ— iUg— g-f  -j— a|-Z3| 


Fi 


* 


-a-   • 


s>— 


t/      -i-    »     '      -     '■■"  -  ;      "      [J     £> p 

1.  Je  -  sus3avesfrom  sin,  mak-eth  pure with-in,  Sal -va-tion  free  He  doth  be-stow; 

2.  Je  -  sus  keeps  the  true, leads  themsafe-ly  thru, And  hides  them  ev  -er  from  the  foe; 

3.  There  are  mansions  bright  in    a  world  of  light,  For  all  who  do  His  will  be-low; 

r>  r>  r> 

•A-     -£-     -A-    -A-    "A"    -A-  -a-    -a-    -A-    -A-     m     -A-    -A- 


p=t 


=£=£=£ 


* 


1 


^fc 


-F- 


-y- 


> — A — fczp=p: 


£=£: 


_*- 


trlr 


t— r-t— t 


1 


:i 


£ 


4- 


i^ 


All  will  be  re-ceivedand  of  guilt  re-lieved, So 
Cheers  them  on  their  way  to  the  land  of  day,  So 
And  for  -  ev  -  er  there  they  the  crown  shall  wear,  So 


* 


i 


-P—  §- 


r^_^_Uf^ 


tell  it  ev-'ry-whereyou  go. 
tell  it  ev-'ry-whereyou  go. 
tell    it    ev-'ry-whereyou  go. 


A £ I4_ 


U     U     I       I 
Chorus. 


1— r 


-A- 


P 


* — ♦ — L* — i — .♦ 


S= 


-£_J_ 


ntfi 


l—f 


<^-! 


EE 


Oh,  tell  it     out, 

Oh,  tell    it     out  and  sing   it     out, 

-A-  -A-      -A-      -A-      -A-       e       -A-     -A 


V 

And  let 


:t=t: 


-A- 


V      I) 
the  weak  and  way-ward  know; 

fS      & 

-A-       -A-       -         -A- 


5=y= 


'^=k=fk^p=t 


^-rf<d* 


w 


s 


iee — § — ± 
it     ev-'ry-whereyou     go. 


?— 


f-vr-f — Lf-f— r 


Oh,  sing  and  shout,  And  tell 

Oh,sweet-ly    sing  and  glad- ly  shout, 

b 
m      -A-     -A-     -A-    -A-     -A-      »      -A-     -A-    -*■ 


i 


tIF-    -a- 


£=5=P=E 


u 


P 


WO.  Wrlbert.  owner.  1920. 


No.  46. 

C.F. 


I'm  Holding  to  His  Hand 


1.  I'm  walk  -  ing    with        my    Lord        a    -   long    this      pil  -  grim  way, 

2.  Tho     all      my    friends    for   -  sake      and      leave    me    lone     and  sad, 

3.  Al   -   tho     the    path       be      rough     and      bur  -  dens  bend     me    low, 


Mi>4  ia: 


:E?:=?_=£=fzi=:t==:t 

j-A—       IA  A A a-  a- 


W — gz±-j — j — g — J — a_^ — *,_ t 


That  leads  me    to    that  bright, bet-  ter  land; 
More  firm-  ly    for    my  Lord    I    will  stand; 
I'll       do    my  best,  and  He'll  un  -der-stand; 


And  as  I  jour-ney  on, 
And  ev-'  ry  -  where  I  go, 
And  what-  so  -e'er  may  come, 


-1-  -  -a »- 


-*rp-f  ~ 


■-? — &- 


P       P 


— # — i P — i — fe> — 6^ — & — p 


-A A 

"p    'D 


p~  tr 


-14 A IA^ — 

-p— p—r— 


s 


Fink 


— *— U — 3 — ^—5—^—f — t^ — 3 — » — ? — *=^— 1 3_^T_] 

He    leads  me  day     by    day, 

He'll  keep   me  free    and    glad, I'm  hold  -  ing       to      His  might-y    hand. 

I'm    safe  with  Him    I    know, 

fzz*=tp— p— p^p==*=*:z^=^=— p3=p=:==E^=*-i 


t~P7"V 


Chorus.    h      n      k 


id — j= — ♦ — c  Jl  __zp Li 6j — q — 3 

a  h" A A J-' A- -i 

: * 1^ ^ ^ -^ ^j_ J 


I,/  I  I 

I'm  walk        -        ing  now  with  Christ  my    bless  -  ed    Lord, 

I'm  walk-ing  each    day    with 

— A- 

t: 

A- 


^*t> ! ! \A * A ! L4, a A— — l-u 1-. ^ h-i- 


feSE 


p    y 


^_=_ _n_._ P__D 


;i 


-e 'EN — * — ^ — ^ *— — J 


p    i    ' " "     v  r 

And   talk  •  ing    with  Him  on   this  high-way  grand; 

And    talk  -  ing  yes, with  Him 

-A—  • — * A A A— 


wm 


spzh-— I t==±=:tz5g— £=E— 1£ 

-' |- jfc A A ' A A IA- 


P— P—  P— P- 


y      p      p  p     p 

Copyright,  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher  in  "Gospel  Clory" 


I'm  Holding  to  His  Hand 


s± 


J>-45— & 


«    I  .-• 


4 H~ 4 A 


D.S. 


b- 


:± 


L^_ 


4f 


I'm  trnst        -         ing    in  Hia  bless  -  ed      Ho  -   ly    word, 

I'm  trust-ing  yes,     in      His 


i^g=[g 


12 


— * — fe — to — a — p — p — a — \ 


V 


No.  47. 


y      •>     q  D       l> 

I  Shall  be  at  Home  With  Jesus 


JENNIE  WlLSOis. 


JAMES    D.    VAUGHAN. 


^m 


PF^/i.  feeling, 


te 


fr-h 


lP^« 


*=^ 


* 


1.  Years  of  time  are  swift-ly  pass  -  ing,      Bring-ing  near  -  er  heav  -  en's  goal; 

2.  Aft  -  er  all  the  days  of  wait  -  ing,         For  His  voice  to     bid  me   come, 


3.  Aft  -  er  leav-mg  earth-ly  pathways,      Which  my  wea-ry  feet  have  pressed, 

4.  Aft  -  er  last  fare-wells  are  spok-en, 


4-A 


I  shall  meet  dear  ones  I've  known, 


\ 


S3 


r-r-r 


j^—y-^- 


ffiB 


^=^ 


P   u   P 


3t=^32± 


m 


id — ■- 


iVi 


-P-F* 


# ^— ^rt: " 


-BST' 


** 


Soon  I'll  be  at  home  with  Je  -  sus, 
I    shall  walk  be-side  my  Sav-iour, 
I    shall  stray  by  life's  fair  riv  -  er, 
In    the  pres-ence  of  our  Sav-iour, 


Eg 


While   e  -  ter  -  nal     a  - 

'Mid  bright  scenes  where  an- 
Find  -  ing    ho  -  ly  peace 
When  we  stand  be  -  fore 
i. 


ges   roll. 
•gels  roam, 
and  rest. 
His  throne. 


X? 


I 


C=H= 


^~rD  ^-^ 


at 


Chords. 


m 


$=£ 


y  I'   hi  h 


1 


MZJE* 


3 


1 — tr  . 

O  how  pre-cious  is  the  prom  -  ise, 

t*  ir  j  £  £  £  £  tV 


7-5 14^— 14 14 A 1 H 14 


That  with  glad-ness  fills 


£ 


my  soul! 


*=& 


fes 


S! 


p=£=b£ 


h h 


£=£ 


J 


IZ5 


3 


»(- 


trp 

I  shall  be  at  home  with  Je  -  sus,       While  e  -  ter -nal     a  -  ges    rollJ 

i  t  V  f  f  ,f  -C 


I 


jjgfea 


s 


^ 


=F=:g: 


£=£=±£ 


-g"ir-tr 


z£ 


OOFYBIGHT,     1008.    BT    JAMES    D.     VATTGH  MJ\, 


I'll  Live  With  Him  Yonder 

Harmony  by  Fay  Jennings 


No.  48. 

Words  and  melody  by  Jimmye  Boyd 

-.J 


1.  So     of -ten  I've  heard  of   the  Sav-iourwho  came  from  His  heav-en    a  -bove, 

2.  He  died  on  the  cross  and  was  bur-ied  and  yet    He    a -rose  from,  the  grave. 

3.  He   lift-  ed   me  out    of   my  sor-row  and  took  all  my  bur-dens  a  -way. 

-«_     .(*.     .p.       .«.      .fc.      ^        a-    "*-       *        *'     -k      -k-     -k-     -k-     -k-       ♦X^s* 

*- — £ — J 

'i 


SfcK — a_l_2 X 5 5 B I_l — L«—    b ■ : 


"D     ^-- 

Of  how  He  was  born  in  a  man-ger  andsuf-fered  to  show  His  great  love; 
And  for-  ty  days  walked  with.  His  chos-en,thus  show-  ing  His  pow  -  er  to  save; 
He  light -cd   my  path-way  with  sun  -shine,gaye  hope  of    a  bright- er   new  day; 

v      _k.     _k_     .k.     _k_  _k_     .Ci  M.   ftw.     -i^.     .k.     +J      .«.       .^.  , — v 

-. n -> n i 1 *-\ â–  ~m f- 


i 


ff — »-L *-  -»-r **-r  ■—■—■—■—  a — ■— y-jr—g— • 


He  came  to    re-deem  the  lost  sin-ners  and  bring  them  back  in  -  to 

The  reas-  on   I'm  tell-ing  this  sto-  ry,  He  sought  me  andsaicd    me 

I'm  look-ing  now  for  Hissoon  com-ing  to  take  me    a-bove  the 

_ff.   .ft.   .&.   _e.    k.  .*.  .fc_    _k.    k.    k.     w. 

g?~Tp~rp..  '-!?â– â–     P~~P" 


the  fold, 
one  day, 
blue  sky, 


:p=rp= 


-i»i_^. 


r2i=p=|=rj==-=t=t=z:tzz:t=r_p=^-j 
:zznb— p-pk— ^zzkZzKz=.k=it=[:b=:H~j 


-p-p~p-p— p 


P.  S.  I '11  walk  with  Him  down  by   the  riv  -  er  that  flows  thrn  the  Cit 


P" 

of    gold, 

Pine 

=    .... .       =j 


And  now    He  is  back  in   His  heav-en,  for   us    in  -ter  -ced  -ing  we're  told. 
And  now     I    amhead-ed  for   glo  -  ry   to  livewithmy  Sav-iour    for     aye. 
Thank  God,  I  shall  live  with  Him  y6n-der  in  mansions  of    glo  -  ry     on     high. 


_  -K-        --K-        -a,-        -K-  A 

-h— F* — • — » — » —  I"- 
:±=ttn=g=E=a=b: 


k-  -^ 

Zfcapp 


.*.  Be  :? 


:p=P' 


P=P=P= 


fczfcflC 


-#- 


:t=P=t2=p2=*' 


I'lllive  with  Himyon-der  for-  ev  -er, 

,ii   Choms 

fog: 


in 


rap-ture  that's  nev-  er 


-k 
— » 

been  told 


|fti_l». 
t=E: 


I'lllive 


j — ♦ — 3— p»- — 


with 


=5 L 


— a-tasFa1— "— ' — "— *; — !JF*. — *■ 


u    u    p  r    p  p   's. 

Him  yon      -       der.When  life  with  its  troub-Ies  are  o'er 
I'll  live  with  Himyon-der  in   glo  -  ry  some-where, 


i 


§.==-  ^       ^r-      __.      j=-  W       *     -k      "k-      k-    -k-    -fc-     k-     ~  A 


p-p- 


#=* 


-p-p-p-p-p- 

Copyright,  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory. 


I'll  Live  With  Him  Yonder 


D.S. 


■—  ■HH — *— w-H f 


And  love 

And  love  will  grow  fond-  er 


i 
A' 


P= 


p=tcd 


*L 
I* — A- 


lo- 
i 

i  :5:  A* 


er  for  Him  on  that  bean  •  ti  •  fal  shore; 
so  fair. 


fa= =j=fc£±& 


— 3 — ir",^l»—i— *—•—■-  B-r  p* — ! 


m$m 


mm 


No.  49. 

Fay  Wallington 

» 1 - — I -Q — *-■- 


Jesus  is  His  Name 


L.  E.  Teal 


:T- 


1.  When  yon  need    a  lriend,help-ing  hands  to 

2.  Whon  you're  pressed  with  care,  bur-  dens  hard   to 

3.  ~ 


lend, As    you 

bear, You  can 

with  sor-rows  past, you  shall  come  at     last, To  cross 

ggap£==£:==         _ — ^^F* ar     ■       »:=A=FE — A~ 


Art- E—  F 


—   * H 1 * ™ 1 — 


jour 

call 

o 

-£- 

— i — 

— *— 

7 


ney 
on 
ver 


a 
this 
the 


long,  a  -  long; 
Friend,  this  Friend; 
tide,  the  tide; 


There  is 
He     will 
He     will 


* •(- 

one       I 

lift    your 
take    you 


« — Fh 4- 


— t- 

know  who 
load,  help 
o'er     to 


will 
you 

the 


I 

be 
on  the 
oth  -  er 


•fr— r- 


^zzzdzzzz^zr 


help 


stow, 
road, 
shore, 


-*- — * 9 — S-^ 1 


g--M*- 


D.S.  Till   with  those     we 


-,* — ci t— 

love,   in     that 
Fine.  Chorus. 


home    a 


—I — 
bove, 


^—^~^-^-i=^—z=z—: 


— * a) *- 

-m — I — w~ 

v.  i  i 

And   will    fill   you  with  song, sweet 

On    Him  you   can    de  -pend,    de  - 

There  with  Him   to     a  -  bide      a  - 

a?_# — ^ — 0 — 9 — ^ — 


song, 
pend. 
bide. 

■8» — 


Je 


is      His  name, 


Crown  Him  Sav-iour    and   king,  our    king. 


S=Cj p ^ C j 3 


D.S. 


Copyright,i948,by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher  in  "Gospel  Glory." 


No.  50. 

H.  A.  L. 


I  Have  No  More  Hills  to  Climb 

Harvey  A.  Lewis 


&tt=d£=L  _J a i— g—  i*^g==*:==£EidE==3 

P — ^-jj — 5 — • — « — i ta — = — 3 — s— 3 j 


1.  Once  the     sin  -   ful     way   seemed       right     to     me, 

2.  I         am     liv   -  ing    now     on  high  -  sr    ground, 

3.  Far  -  ther     on      I        see     my  iu  -  ture    home, 


§_.^jjX: — a, & «4 — *(£ — ;fc: — p 


ffi* 


I- — r 

lime,  sub 
time,    of 


§§i 


But  I've  had  a  change  sub    -  lime,  sub  -  lime; 

Par  a  -    bove  the  sands    of  time,    of     time; 

In  a        land  of  sweet  spring    •  time, spring-time; 

P  .h    .r>         J     .  -  £  Ik   £ 


3=zj=H=izt:=zz£=p=E|i: 


-£- 


3 


f=^i 


1E£ 


^^^1 


And  to  -  day 
Hap  -  py  in 
There  some  day 


the 
this 
I'll 


„; is — ^S ±— 

S3SEE£EEEE£E 


glo  -    ry 
land,  from 
sing  'neath 


light    I 
chains  un  - 
heav  -en's 


see, 
bound, 
dome, 


Copyright,  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory." 


I  Have  No  More  Hills  to  Climb 


-  _3(E 

In    this      Ca-  naan  land    sub 

••-        -•-  .  -0-        -9-   H- 


t- 

lime,sub 


P~    -— — 


II 


lime; 


"?Tr- 


a — ■ f ^—  .     ■         —1 


|^t 


£=£=*=* 


:J=rg: 


But    I'm  look  •  ing    far  -  ther     on,     to     that  land    of     per 

-0-       -9- 


feet 


U.S. 


dawn, 


~iM 


:^^ 


-r- *— — * p* 1 1 


-3L 


No.  51.  I  Hear  Thy  Welcome  Voice 


^^S 


£=fc 


»P 


£ 


Rev.  L.  Hartsough. 


ft* 


£ 


4i=r- 


\>  i    i   t"  â–        * 

1.  I  hear  Thy  welcome  Toice,  That  calls  me,  Lord,  to  Thee,  For  cleansing  in  Thy 
\  Tho'  com-ing  weak  and  vile,  Thoa  dost  my  strength  assure,  Thou  dost  my  vileness 
d.'Tis        Je-sus  calls  me  on,    To  per-fect  faith  and  love,  To  perfect  hope,  and 


Ifefe 


ME 


¥=£=£ 


^=^ 


:b: 


l.l   k-V 


=y=F 


(2. 


£££. 


Chorus. 


EE! 


ft: 


£—£ 


-qp â– *-& 


-g- 


9 


precious  blood  That  flowed  on  Cal-va  -  ry. 

ml  -  ly  cleanse,  Till  spot-less   all    and  pure. 

peace ,  and  trust,  For  earth  and  heav  'n  a-bove. 


tea 


£  - 


F- 


3E 


it 


:t 


fc 


I  am  com-ing,  Lord!  Coming 

-A-     -A-     -4-     -£r=-  •*=■ 


m 


_1c=fc=ttz:tz: 


^5 


^=P=P 


:tt=^z= 


now   to  Thee!  Wash  me,  cleanse  me  in    the  blood  That  flowed  on  Cal  -va  -  ry! 


k      pL j        gj     K      K      r     ^ f~      Is      r 


1      D" 


|2E 


No.  52. 

Chas,  W.  Vaughan 


I'll  Fly  Away 


G.  Kieffer  Vaughan 


M 1 1 1 «_) _i — J 

-j- ^ — 1:# m — ^ .—J 


ft* 

1.  When  my      Lord   comes    a   -    gain     to      this  earth    here    to  reign, 

2.  When  He     comes    in       the       air,      on      that    glad  morn-  ing  fair, 

3.  Tho'    His     com  -  ing        be     soon,    in        the    mora    or     at  noon, 


s- -— * * r-A r-± 4 * 1 

lBz:^=:zfcz=:btt=z=^z=z-!£z=:=^z==ts=z=i&izrE(£ fr E       K    :1 

[>      P \       b      p      i      P     P     '      P     p     I 


flS3=E3= 


^g=gzz^gz=E==E==e==E. 


"-PC 


"J: 


** 


♦- 


'ft* 


On  a  cloud  ride 
Then  with  all  of 
Al   -    ways  read  -    y 


fir  -«< 

a    -  way,     go      with  Him, home    to  stay, 

the  blest,  north    and  south, east    and  west, 

I'll  be,     when    He  comes  back   for  me, 


zz=k==fc=te=fcrz3 


P— 1>— p— p— I— *  -  V~r-  ^ 


345=1^= 


I'll  rise  and  fly    a  -  way,  Go  home  with 

I'll  rise  and  fly    a  -  way,  I'll  fly     a  •  way,  Go  home  with 


:r_l-_-t-_-t-r-t_t: 

.  _5t: 


.K      h-    -h- 


Copyright,  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory." 


P=fr 


I'll  Fly  Away 

_____  ^_^__^_      ^.^^^^ 

.__J__J__J— -d-^ 0 9 •--* 


Him  to    stay, with  Him  to   stay; With  that  snow  white  an-gel  band,  go  -ing 

*-    -*•     •*-  wm     -»•    -i»-    -N 

:      —  ESf= 


zt_z_ 


-to. 


top_— ^F_=___-_— _rF____t=zt=&:=:E— E==f:==^ 


U     P 


— h— h h- 


£fe__*____ii 


=t 


3t 


4- 


:_-i&_iz^= 


•J  £     ~ 

home  to  glo  -  ry  land,  I'll  rise 


=i__ZA__jt_  tz^fa_z__=: 

^  L>     U     U 

and   fly    a  «  way. 


I'll  rise    and   fly    a  -  way,  I'll  fly 


-ft -ft' 


ft  Efe.  t: 

-ft ft ft- 


£:jp3B^EgEEEI^=„-zg 


-»- 

-i — 

znrnS~ 


h 


a-way. 


r 


No.  53. 

W.J.K. 


Lord,  I'm  Coming  Home 


W.J.Kirkpatrick 


^^^___^^_~^_gi_i^ 

f — ^t-« — y-m^- — 0 1, — 0 — ls — ■      m — 0T i--i 1 — 0 — 0__l_3^ — j 


1.  I've  wan-dered  far    a  -way  from  God, 

2.  I'vewa9t  -ed  man-y  pre  »  cious  years, 
3;  I've  tired  of  sin  and  stray  »  ing  Lord, 
4.  My  soul     is    sick, my  heart  is    sore, 

— _ — 1-±- 


Now  I'm  com 
Now  I'm  com 
Now  I'm  com 
Now  I'm  com 


ing  home; 
ing  home; 
ing  home; 
ing  home; 


— -   _ — _ _. 

,#=t=±__t: 


:g  N  Fine 

?te=-d_^_.^=-=t5rSr^__5__=:— M__j=z^_jz:r_^__:— 3 

|___$_c#__,__^_#_t^i-^_j? g=j.   :^  -^r^r-— ' 


The  paths  of    sin   too    long 
I       now    re  -pent  with  bit 
I'll  trust  Thy  love,  be  -leive 
My  strength  re -new,my  hope 

~ r  A- ft ft rft- ft ft- '■ rft ft m » f~£s- 

i^zS_^i--|-zziz=^-gi L— I— q-g=p^^g-EE=g: 

__^zt:=:b^i_-_zz-^— ?;_E| g=fcz_z=EF— ^— U=$=±\£L~ 


I've  trod, 
ter  tears, 
Thy  word, 
re  -store, 


Lord, I'm  com-ing  home. 
Lord, I'm  com-ing  home. 
Lord, I'm  com-ing  home. 
LordJ'm  com-ing  home. 


_te 
i      v 

0  -  pen  wide  Thine  arma 
Chorus. 

-N 1 — j- 


of    love, 


Lord, I'm  com-ing  home. 

D.S. 

:c=]-=_:c 


.1  0 0 0 0 L<Si U 


com  -  ing 


Nev  -  er   -  more    to        roam; 


—- _ a- 1_ r*. a*- _ r-_ & ft ft — 

g^___t_=l p_I_L^z=£__:^==^==:E_-Z^-:: 


No.  54. 

Mrs.  J.  M.  Hunter 


Help  Us  in  the  Fight 


test 


XL 


Paul  W.  Cochran 


t± 


-H--h4- 


:^=^ir^= 


UK: 


:«fe_ 


a=a 


££ 


— -j — • 


1.  There's  a  bat  -  tie  fierce  to  wage,  it  should  all  our  pow'rs  en-gage, For  we 

2.  See  the    vet  -  er -ans  are  scarred, for  the    foe  has  fooght  them  hard,Tet  they 

3.  Pol  -  low  where  the  Cap-tain  leads,  He, who   fol  -  lows  close, suceeds,  And  the 

IN      JN      A.     -k-       A       -£-       ^      -P-     -«-     -k^    -k      -k~     -k- 


know  the  foe     is  strong, the  foe    is  strong;A       de-  ci  -  sion   you  must  make, 
press   on  with    a    song,  a    hap  -  py  song;Heedthe  call  for    vol-  nn-teers, 
strife  will  not     be  long,  will  not     be  long;  Soon  the  last    of    foes  we'll  rout, 

.*.  a*,    n-  -*-  &-    -k-    •«-   -»-     in   *.   -k-     «,    #-     * 


t3fc=t=a 


:fc=£: 


:t=r.:p: 


-?:=£: 


afttzat 


1  >         A.        'â– *" 


:p:zzpz=£ 


=i 


u    P 


v  U     b 

there's  no  neutral  ground  to  take, 

lay    a-  side  your  doubts  and  fears.Come  and  help  us  fight  the  wrong,yes,fightthe  wrong. 

oh,  how  glad  the  vic-tor'sshout, 

h    fci    h    h    i 


HE 


tat 


-k- 

:tz 


-A--A— 


Chorus. 


^kzzt=|s:=t-_H.  _.s _,-,.., - 

tr-  fc^ — tP — t?  — r — D — t?  -tp" 


~        â– #-      -Ik-  a), 


:|— f-^E 


S95 


1 


K  *       r?       U 


y     u     b    b    U    i 
Come  and  help  us     in    the  fight, 

Help  us  car-  ry  the  fight,  help  ns  car  -  ry  the  fight, 

\Bff-S hh h #—  f  — • h — -^ 5 *"l? — t?~~~"K~  ^ — £ — i 


:—  $ 


fc- 


zz-5— ^— 3: 


:3=z2=5=«j. 


=*:==fa 


- — 3—  ;t — Fd^" 


1 


Join         the  val        -  iant  throng; 

Glad-ly  join  the  val    -     iant         throng.the  heav-en  bound  throng. 


P= 


Jt 


i3=£ 


*i 


£==: 


f  -  s*. 


• — 5 — 5 — F 
pmb=b=t2: 


Copyright,  1948,  by  James  D.-Vaughan,  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory," 


Help  Us  in  the  Fight 


b   9   »   ' 


Be    a      he  -  ro     in    the  strife, 

Be     a    fight  -  er   for  right,  ia  this    ter  •  i  -  ble  strifes 


E— .  P- 


t k?-  t>— tr-,*— J 


=fc 


J^3 


Help 
Come  and  help  us 


0      b      U 


P 


M- 


/^g_<~_ LA A 


*     p 

ns  fight         the  wrong. 

fight         the         wrong, in    fight-ing   the  wrong. 

r>  :   .*  „    h   h   r>   fi   fi   p    i 

EEEEzEii—  : 


No.  55; 

.    .    .      'and  pray  one  for  another  .    .    .  The  effectual  lui  vent  prayer  of  a  righteous 
J.  D.  V.  manavaileth  much"  JamesS:  16.         James  D.  Vaughah, 


I  Need  the  Prayers 


With  feeling. 


:fcfc 


i>  r>  .n 


zB. 


=3=1= 


F*=* 


p 


3= 


1.  I  need  the  prayers  of  those  I  love,  Whilotrav'lingo'erlife'sruggedway,That 

2.  I   need  the  prayers  of  those  I  love,  To  help  me    in  each  try -ing  hour,  To 
3.1  want  my  friends  to  pray  for  me,  To  hold  me  up    on  wings  of  faith,  That 

IP— i — pU~  m  -r»-—c — P — s — c — •— ■ — ^t— 

-J 1 H — - 1 1-1 1 1 1 »■ \- \-^z^-  — ! 


.4 


^=^ 


• H 1 — rr- •-  -r*-— * — P • c •— i :f— — i 


±t=±>z^z±[ 


Fine.   Chorus. 


-0-jX 


'i- 


I  may  true  and  faithful  be,  Andlivefor  Je-sus  ev-'ry  day. 

bear  my  tempted  soul  to  Him ,  That  He  may  keep  me  by  His  pow'r .  I  want  my  friends  to 

I  may  walk  the  narrow  way,  Kept  by  our  Father's  glorious  grace. 


4-4—1* 


riflftFb 


£=£ 


znzhtz |zztfti_e~ie is    ft iz 

i     v    v    v    v    v 


D.  S. — I  need  the  prayers  of  those  I  love. 


D.S. 


prav  for  me,  To  bear  my  tempted  soul  a-bove,  And  in-ter-cedewithGodfor  me; 
-Al  .a.  Ai;     -A^-*   -a.  .      -A-  >i  -A-     M    -A-   -A-   -A-   -A^- 


tt=r=tr=P=t^=>=::=P::tF- 


oopyrijrht,,  1936,  by  James  D.  Vnatrhan,  Reacwal 


No.  56 

W.  B.  Walbert 


I'll  Soon  Be  Going 

— 4=-_ — 5~tH — v — I — * — I — * — - — 


E.  F.  Purvis 


±=2=% 


A U-A— g 

^ 5j ^ ___ 


1.  On  that  hap-py,glad  to-mor-row,  when  I'm  thru  with  pain  and  sor-row,  I  shall 

2.  There'll  be  shoutingjthere'll  be  sinsing, heaven's  bells  will  all   be  ring-ing,  Glo-ry 

3.  What  a  hap -py   ju  -  bi  -la-tion,when  themed  of    ev  -'ry    na-tion    all    go 

^ ~- A —  A_, A A A _• __A A A i€ 


d2=Z^ZZ==^= 


\9- 


=^3=^=Z 


=g_-l 


-*- 


-A — 


â– -4- 


the     sky,    up      in       the    sky; 
the      air,   will    fill      the      air; 


leave  for  man-sions  yon  -  der  in 
hal  -  le  -  Iu  -  jahs  loud  will  fill 
march-ing    down    the    shin  •  ing    streets  of      gold,  the    streets  of     gold; 

,H?—  a A a . — g — M  — g: 


*$£- — _ a 


-H5- 


:S— BE 


$==fi==pc==t: 


:p: 


^=fci=^=* 


ft 


^==h=£==h=# 


?— IN — h-F?— *h— =P— -*1— =P— *=z^ F-h— ^ — h— -P — rV-3 

P~44 — -^-r-A H A 1 A 1 g- F-M — A M A H— A- 

— p*fc — m — 'jj - J  — _ J « -*t ^ ^ ^— -=« =* 

There  to  sing  the  bless  -  ed  sto-  ry  '  of  the  might-y  King  of  glo  -  ry, 
Voic -es  sweet  will  all  be  blend  ing,thru  the  a  -  ges  there  un -end-ing, 
Safe   at  home  to  part    no,  nev  -  er,  there  we'll  sing  and  shout  for  -  ev  -  er, 


tr-p~  tr~ p:~ ' t>~^: 


^=g=R5=*: 


J1_J_ 


Fink 

fa  I 


*      Ij      ij     T, 

\J        v        v        V        \J 
In    that   love- ly    land  where  peo -pie    nev-  er    die,    they   nev-  er    die. 
'Twill  be  glo  -  ry,  end  -less   glo  -    ry      o   •   ver  there, yes,    o  -   ver  there. 
Where  the  countless  a  -  ges  there  shall    e   -  ver    roll,  shall    ev   -  er    roll. 


EHr-r — _— F* — • —  p ^- — •" 


=p=p= 


D.S.  Call-ing    me    to    join  them    o 
Chorus.         . 

t r-J 


P-P- 


^ 


-Kl- 


r; 


_ 


ver   there,yes,     o  -   ver  there. 


rts] ___^ — e — sj_ 


T 


3===:=lz==: 


t»  £r 


=■— - — _ — _- 

1   _.   p   p 


ing 


n 


t>    t)    l>  u 

Go  -  ing, 

I'm  go-ing,         yes,  go-  ing,        I'm  go-ing        up  yon-der, 
I'll  soon  be  go    -     ing,         go    -    ing  o   -       ver         yon    -  der, 

f^h^*  _    _  «     h    n    h  *t    f^   P*   * 


1_* 


«= 


-5= 


-1 — £ — gz  -jLr - — - — i "_r| 

£^EE_tj!i=___jte 


i 

Copyright,1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory." 


I'll  Soon  Be  Going 


-t>- 


-♦ — «- 
— i 1- 


dfc 


To    that     hap   -  py     land    so   bright   and    fair;     so   bright   and  fair; 
rs       IN 

Wfdsi-=t==£ — -£ s E e P— EP 9 E  -  v" 


^ 


a 


^^E" 


=t 


re: 


"  u  P  u 


y 


ifes 


'    d    u    P     '    J~15  T        P    P 

Call        -  ing,  call        -  ing, 

I    hear  them      now  call-ing,        from  heaven  they're  calling. 
I  hear  them  call   -    ing,        call   -    ing,        gen    -     tly         call   -ing. 

jUP — -J — • — • — * 


3=Hf 


No.  57.  Glory  to  His  Name 

Elisha  a.  Hoffman  J.  H.  stocktom 


I 


iii 


1.  Downat  the  cross  where  my  Saviour  died,  Down  where  for  cleansing  from  sin  I  cried; 
2.1       am  so  won-drous-ly  saved  from  sin,  Je-sus  sosweet-ly     a-bideswith-in; 

3.  Ohl  precious  fountain  that  saves  from  sin!  I    am  so  glad  I  have  entered  in; 

4.  Come  to  this  fountain  so  rich  and  sweet,  Cast  thy  poor  soul  at    the  Savioar's  feet; 


Ki^^f^^^^lii 


p  0 


r 


Fine,   Chorus. 


♦t— 4— L3 ■« 1&— •-•- 1 • ■«— L  — r? — *-^r--« — - — 9— * 


01-  -*■•-"        "     -^- 

There  to  my  heart  was  the  blood  ap-plied, 

Thereat  thecrosswhereHetookme  in,   Glo-ry    to   His  name.  Glo-ry   to  His 
There  Je-sus  saves  me  and  keeps  me  clean , 
Plunge  in  to-day  and  be  made  complete, 

A A*      A A-1 — A— r-A A £J— r-A-1—  A A =— 1 g— A — A- 


ffi 


$z=fc 


p  b  1 


A'      A— rA A £J— pA-1— A A «— 1 r- 


r-p-p-F 


name, 


SH 


Glo-ry    to   His  name;      Thereto  my  heart  was  the  blood  ap-plied, 

i A A-rdT-A-^j-ir-A fc=—  A 


£=P=t 


"1    b  b" 


frpf? 


k-ht — I f1- 


gaSg=H 


Jfo.  58.  It  is  Sweet  to  Walk  With  Jesus 

Rev.  Rupert  Cravens  Eloise  Carper 


I 


^^*| 


l.'Tis  sweet  to   walk  with  the    Sav-iour     ev  -  'ry    hour     of  the  day, 

2.  "lis  sweet  to    live      in  His  pres  -ence,  safe  from   dan  -  gers  of  life, 

3.'Tis  sweet   to   trust  Him  thru  life,    mid  chang- ing  scene     of  the  way, 

-ft-        -ft-  -ft-        -ft-        -ft-        -ft-        -ft-        -4-         -ft-  -ft-  -*- 


i£ 


:t 


3 


is: 


£=* 


-y — >-fc/ 


=^=:±z=tor 


^=^=z^=i)=i  at 


fefe 


-i 


'■¥ 


m 


And  have  Him  guide     us    what  -  ev   -   er     may     be   -  fall,  be  -  fall; 

De  -   liv  *  ered  safe     from   the      fow  -  ler's    an    -  gry    snare,  the    snare; 

He     nev  -   er  chang -es,    but     e'er      a   -  bides  the    same,  the    same; 

-ft-  -ft-  -A-  -ft-  -ft-          -ft-  -A-  -P-         -ft-  _  -ft-  - 


V 


& 


He       is     our  shep-herd    so  gen -tie,    ev  -   er 

Be  -  neaththe   wings   of    His  love,  for  -  ev  -   er 

E'en  tho'  death's  wa  -  ters  may  roll, there'll  be  no 

-F-        "A"          m          "A-         -A-  -ft-        -ft- 


watch  -  ing 

we    may 

cause    for 


His  own, 
a  -  bide, 
a  -  larm, 


_— £ P y Ly 1 y y y y y re e * j 


--rv 


5=A=|=: 


:--£--:i 


±: 


::£— jizzzitzz^r 


-e # ^ j 


fczj      T~~E^ 


.Fine 


5"P 

In       love     so  ten  -  der  He  hears    our    faint 

As   -  sured  each  mo  -  ment  of  His  ,    pro  -  tect 

We'll  cling     to  Je  -   sus,  stil!  trust  -  ing      in 


P 


•  est  call, 
â–   ing  care, 
His    name, 


— ► © — 

i  V 

our  call. 
His  care. 
His   name. 


Copyright  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory." 


It  is  Sweet  to  Walk  With  Jesus 


And    let    Uim  lead 


t 


Let   Him  lead 

i==:==z=c==?=Ifi=:?==rr=r=:[:- 


:_3 — £. 


r£- 


us   home    a  -  bove; 

home    a  •  bove; 

-A- 

i ^ — v — j 

D.5. 


iE=i 


EEE 


=5—     )-:     — g#- ■ 

:  I  y-         p 

Guides  us      on,  day     by      day. 

He  guides  us      on  -  ward  day      by     day, 


13=1 


-3 — £ 


-*-      -a- 


-â–  3 ^ p L 


—X> 


No.  59,  Pray,  Pray,  Pray, 

Vida  Munden  Nixon 

& rW-l 1— r 1 K — ^r- 1- 


Adger  M.  Pace 


1.  Whentheway    is    dark  be -fore  you, And  the  skies 

2.  When  it  seems  the  sun    is     hid-  ing,  Pad  -  ing  f  ar 

3.  Let    no  doubtthe  brightness  bor-row,Fromlife'spass 


W 


are  gray> 

a-      •     way; 
ing  day; 


« 


A — r* A # A — r^3 — £- 


=t=Efcrt=t=:E=E= 


rrcEiz: 


§h=3 


IT* 


=^=F= 


4 


Fine.  Chorus. 


•3*. t&i 

pray, pray.       Pray, 


e ii — l-i~ l  gi l<«- 


Tho'  the  clouds  are  heav-  y     o'er  you,Pray, 

In     the    Sav-iour  still    a  -  bid  -  ing, 

E"  van    in    the  vale   of     sor-row,       Pray,pray,pray.      Pray,oh,pray 


— £ & rA— A * * r  tSJ !& rl 1 1-| r* * * 


D.  S. With  a    hope-ful  heart  that's  cheery. 

1*1 ...  .4 


When  the  days  are  drear-  y,    Pray,  When  you're  faint  and  wear-y; 

Pray,yes,  pray 
.IS 


^.Hiirtrigip! 


:P=t: 

jB •- 


Copyright  1946,  by  James  D  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher  in  "  Silver  Trumpet." 


No.  60. 

Chas,  H.  Huff 


What  A  Happy  Time 


sill 


iffit 


V    0 


0    P 


—3 

A—  S 


5=5=*= 


W.  S.  Tidwell 


rf==j: 


a— ad— S-l-^— 7^     ■ 


1.  What  a   hap-py  time 

2.  What  a   hap-py  time 

3.  What  a   hap-py  time 


V&L 


9  V  *  ."8"  .  9 
wewillhavein  glo-  ry,have  in  glo  -  ryr 
we  will  have  that  mora-ing,havethat  morn -ing, 
we  will  have  for-ev  -  er.have  for-  ev  -  er, 


fetf« 


:r==K=£=s=K=Er=^=E=£zcp=E== 

EEE=l=H=&ElEi3=EEgZ^ 


{=>=^=t=tq 


=P=£= 


t» 


»gii^eEte===| 


_A ^ A A 


When  we  gath-er  there 
When  we  hear  the  Lord 
When  we  see  the  Lord 


Jfc  :jl  .p.  A. 


B 


«%=£= 


:t=t: 


£-*-*- 


*$&=9 


mi 


v  d  v  b  \> 

for  the  meet-ing  graad,for   the  meet-  ing  grind: 
eay-ing  en-  ter   in, say  -ing  en  -ter    in: 
in    His  glo  -ry  bright,in   His  glo-  ry  bright: 

«EteE3=S3=«§3 


mm 


_K m m . 1 k_ 


^-s ta-0-FH)-5 1-~ t?— p— p~b— t?-11 


With  a  hap-py  song 
With  a  shout  of  joy 
We  will  raise  a  song 


we'll  re  -peat  the  sto-  ry,grando!dsto-  ry, 
and  with  crowns  a-dorn-ing,erowns  a-dorn-ing, 
by     the  shin-ing  riv  -  er,shin-ing  riv  -  er, 

_A.     A-     -A-     -A-  -A-     -*-     -»-     ■*-     -A- 

_f.i=.±=r  ^-,f  r  t- :  r-  r  r 

-* A * A A— [-A * 1      -J 


How  the  dear  Lord 
We    will  go     in 
Prais-ing  His  name, 

-P- 


0      #-     p      p     •#- 

b    tf    u    b    1 

bro't  us  to  that  land,bro,t  us  to  that  land. 
where  theTe  is  no  sin, where  there  is  no  sin. 
heav-en's  Ho-ly  light,heav-en's  Ho-  ly  light. 


-P-  -P- 


fei 


::_z_>_r#. 


r>  .&  J 


ly   light. 


$=* 


=£ 


B.S.  And  we  shall  sing 
Chorus.  i 


with  the 


jg=g==— ~====== 

an -gel  band.withthe  ar     g«lband, 


^ 


e 


h^Ji  J>  IV=^=S 


I^Fi 


5S^^^ 


i==^ 

=P=zP=:S= 


-;    5    5 — g — P — g — r 


What  a  hap-py  time  we  will  have  my  hroth-er, 

What  a  hap-py  time  we  will  have  my  broth-er,. 

_     _    -A-  ^— — -^      -A-  A-    -»--»-    -A-    -A- 

_f •  f -  T-  f"  f- ;g=|r-r  r  f— tr-£- 


Copyright,  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory.' 


What  A  Happy  Time 


p :  '  0   ^.  b 


On    the  bright  Hills, 


in   the  glo-  ry  land; 


L«    0 .    0  -'  U    P 


On,  tha  bright  Hills,  in   the  glo- ry  land,  in     the    glo- ry  land; 


:^===^M^H^=^^hH^^^ 


D.S. 


a — a — a1 — ■ — *H — ! '  yJ 

Glo-ry   be  to  God,  we  will  knoiv  each  oth-er, 


trL*Hfc£zSfc« p_-^~R-^>-4W— I- f  -F 


Glo-ry  be  to  God, 

-•-  -•-  -■-    ■-  -P- 
—i — i 1 1 —  \— 

— i* — I* — A — A «& 


wewillknow  eachoth-er, 

„        .A-    .A.     „-     .m.     -A-     -A. 

:fut-t-T— "  tr— --J1-, 

-A— A— A 1 1 A 14— 


Almost  Pursuaded 


P.  P.   Bliss. 

h- 


if 

1,  "Al-most  per-suad-ed"  now  to  be  -  lieve;  "Al-most  per-suad-ed" 
!'.  "Al-most  per-suad-ed,  "come, come  to  -  day;  "Al-most  per-suad-ed" 
3.  "Al-most  per -suad-ed,"har- vest    is     past;      "Al-most  per-suad-ed" 


1 


t=tt 


^ 


^ 


t£=£=[= 


I 


i 


5 


^PPB 


-b- 


Christ  to  re  -  ceive: 
turn  not  a  -  way; 
doom  comes  at      last; 


Seems  now  some  soul  to     say, "Go  Spir  -  it, 

Je   -    sus      in  -  vitea  you  here;  An -gels    are 

'Al  -  most    can  -  not  a  -  vail;"Al-most"is 

1        r\      i 


£=& 


PTFgpi^ 


~\)    1 


£ 


tet=: 


go    Thy  way.Somemore  con-ven-ient   day,  On  Thee  I'll    call, 

lin-g'ring  near,  Prayers  rise  from  hearts  so    dear;  0  wan-d'rer  cornel 

but    to     fail;  Sad,   sad,  that   bit  -  ter  wail,"Al     •     most  but  lost." 


$Fz& 


±=t=t 


h_i — ^=^— t — \=  g — r=^ 


fe: 


a— 


No.  62. 

G.  L.  B. 


m 


I'll  Fly  Away  Some  Morning 

Grady  L.  Baker 


H 


1.  On  some  morn-ing bright  and  fair,  I  will  fly  a  -way.Go â– -  ing  to  my 
2  That  will  be  a  hap- py  time  when  with  lriends  1  love,l  snail  meet  m 
3*  On    the  wings  of    love    di -vine,  I'll  keep  sail -ing    on,  Till    ^  meet  those 


m=M^m^^ 


jB_      J^L.     A. 
£— r*--l* r* h— — ijzs= 


^^EEfeEEEP^Eb5=^=E^=E 


:U=t?--=t2=t2' 


VW      m S s — 'L« ■ « » # 9 9  9  9  9 

el  .  . 


homesomewhere,in    that  land   of   day;  Je  -  sus  will  be     with  me  then 

that  fair  clime  in    that  home  a  -bove;  Noth-mg  there  will    harm  the  soul, 

friends  of  mine  who    be  -fore  have  gone:  Then  I'll  join  them    m  the  sky 

" :"      U     p     17     v 


euid-ingme  a -long.Go- ing  where  there  is  no  sin,  hap  -  py  land  of  song, 
troub-leswill  be  o'er.We'II  be  glad  while  a  -  gea  roll,  on  that  peaceful  shore, 
orais- ing  Christ  oar  Ring  .Never  more   to    say  good-  by,  but  we'll  shout  and  sing. 

r  .ft.    jpi.    -ft.     JfM,       _         ^        -«■       -k-        -        ■*■      -""      -~       -*■ 


$=£: 


52=t2=p: 


-f-    » * £"—2"  _*_.: 


-y 


:i= 


z=g— f— r 


=f=& 


-r 


,  Chorus 


)EUS.  ft  _.         .  __, 

D — D    P    ^    5    t>    &  -  a  u       ^.    .=,.    -5. 


I'll  fly  a  -  way,  on  some  glad    hap  -  py     morn  -  ing, 

Fly   a -way,         fly     a -way, 


!    -f—  s— J— j- 


.«_    jB.     .«_    -«-    ._ 


# 


4 


£: 


U—tr-tr 


$: 


E=£=!=fcfc 


An(j     g0  r      to  meet    r  my  loved  ones    on     that    day; 

Go    to    meet,  50     to    meet  ^  fc 


* 


P        >         V         V         v 


±: 


Copyright,  1948,  by  James  D.-Vaughan,  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory," 


I'll  Fly  Away  Some  Morning 


..A 


— t-F* — + — * — -m      *      * — *-tw— F 


d5=^ 


v      '     y     y     y       '     y     P"    y 

I'll  sing  and  shoat  the  prais  -  es 

Sing  and  shout,       sing  and  shout 


imy    Sav  -  iour, 


th 


-ft! 


8    4  U      P      ~ 

To  heav'n  a  -  bove  where  all      is     love,  with  Him     I'll      fly 

PS       *  *        -fcr       -k-       •£-        -.  «,  *        -f"         "*-         "*- 

^T-h h* B » * h h H * — H» g » g [^ — 


5=p: 


way. 


No.  63. 

Rev.  J.  H.  S. 


Only  Trust  Him 


Rev.  J.  H.  Stockton 


1.  Come,ev  - 'ry    soul     by     sin     oppressed, There's  mer  -cy   with    the  Lord; 

2.  For     Je  -  sus  shed   His    pre- cious  blood,  Rich  bless-ings   to      be -stow; 

3.  Yes,   Je  -  eus     is      the  Truth,  the  way  That  leads  you     in  -  to    rest; 

4.  Come,then,and  join   this    ho  -  ly    band  And    on     to     glo  -  ry      go; 

jfezzjzzzj — %— pte— fez $: — %— nfcz=fc=~£ 


m 


M 


t=tj=t 


H=t= 


s 


Fine 


:4=d 


=t 


#=*=f. 


-.=i==t 


^-L.g— - — 

And   He  will  sure-ly     give  you  rest,   By  trust -ing     in      His  word. 

Plunge  now  in  -  to     the   crim  -  son  flood  That  wash  -  es  white    as    snow. 

Be-lieve  in    Him  with -out     de  -  lay,   And  you   are     ful  -  ly     blest. 

To  dwell  in    that    ce  -  les  -  tial  land,Whereioys  im-mor-tal    flow. 


D.S. —  He    will  save  yon,  He    will  save  you,  He    will  save  yon  now. 
i.  Chorus.       _  D.S. 


m-0* 


ft 


H4^- 


-r 

On  -  ly    trust       Him,    on  •  ly    trust  Him,   On  -  ly    trust  Him  now; 


m 


£=£=£ 


-a — 
4= 


S^ 


± 


No.  64. 

Adger  M.  Pace 

m 


The  Glory  Land 


:fc 


?-^*-^-P^^--r^T-& 


K— fc-i-^- 


:^5=^: 


Robert  McWhirter 


•d— 1 — F — d 


s 


„ i — — — 9 1 — v 1 — « — n — — « — ii      i . — rr 

*     -♦•     ~  -•-  -♦-     ^     -#-      ^  V       [)       p 

1. There's  a  hap-py  land  of  joy.su-per-nal,  o  -ver  the  roll-ing  tide,  in  glo-  ry, 
2. In  that  Ho- ly  land  there'll  be  no  sor-row,noth-ing  to  tempt  the  soul,  oh,  glo- ry, 
3. In    that  love-ly  land  with  gran-deur  stands  the  Cit  -  y  that's  (milt  four-sqnare,in  glo-  ry, 

-â–º-    Jk.    >.    Jk.    .*.     .. 


-  -        —  A—fr—A—*-- 


-V— I 


-k — k- 

~-y—9~- 


t- 


te£^lp^i?ifefete! 


P    P 


-5-17 


3 


^ 


ter -nal, where  all  thesaintsa  -bide 


It        is      a  land   of  bliss   e  -ter -nal, where  all  thesaintsa  -bide,  for-ev-er: 
There  we  shall  hare    a  glad    to-mor-row,  it    we  have  been  made  whole,tbru  Je-sus; 

And    I     am  told  my  Sav-iour  plans    a  man-sion  for  me    up  there, oh, praise  Him; 

-K    -K    -K    -K  '    _ 

3fP-k — Is — It—  fc — k  — ' — It — is —  f — 1 i F — F  — n- 

£=zi  ==fcz=|i=z|s:=:js:=|»: 


a 


-b— t?- 


; b— b— ^~b— p— P 

'Tis  the  place  that  Je  -  sus  is  pre 
Liv  -  ing  with  the  Lord  up  there  for 
And  some  glo  â–   ry   day  I'll     oc  -  cu 


I — aj—f^- 


3^=3: 


par- 

-  ev 

-  py 


ing 

â–   er, 
it, 


-«— 

for 
nev 
un  • 


n 


A Ur- 


:p= 


His 

er 
der 
P 

—A— 


re  -deemed  and 
from  Him  to 
the    shin  -   ing 


D.  S.  And  some  hap-  py  morn- ing    I 


££=$= 


:^=^: 


LMfP h»— =i § t-K- l-i fcj- 


will  join  them.nev  -  er 

i    h    I 


a   -  gain 


to 

Fine. 


31 — ; 


own, oh, praise  Him  Bean  -  ti 
roam  no,  nev- er,  Will  be 
dome,wiih  rap-ture,Sing-ing 


-  ful  land  di  -vine  -  lyplanned,it  is  my  home, 
so  sweet  with  joy  com-plete,  in  that  sweet  home. 
His  praise  thru  end-  less  days,  in  that  new  home. 


roam,  oh,  glo  -  ry,  Sing  -  ing 
Chorus. 


k_    _k.    _^_    _^.    .|_.    .*.    .*.   _#.    ^.   ->.    ., 


1 

v 


m 


song  both  loud  and  long,  in    our  new  home. 


have    man  •     y    loved    ones     in     that 


ffiS 


rJirz=S— 5:=*^*=! 


glo  •  ry, 

--D— ft-. 


land, 


oh, 


Copyrighl,i948,by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher  in  "Gospel  Glory." 


The  Glory  Land 

lip=p^p=JL=p5§Epi|iiiiiiii^ 

P  P       D       H       IJ       ft      *      ^       ^  I  ft 


Wait- ing  for  me    to  come.and  join  them,  In  their  songs    of 

Sing 

s lUL^LjLjL-tJ-^-g  — * 


love 


1/ 
ins 


D.  S. 


â– fir 


to     the  King    a  -bove,        'neaththe  shin  -  ing  heav'n-ly  dome; 

songs,  be  -  neath  the  shin  -  ing  heav'n-ly  dome,  up   you  -  der; 


-*- 


w j  - 


; 89 9 » IB B h h fc» V 


No.  65. 

Mrs.  Elvina  M.  Hall 


Jesus  Paid  it  AH 


JohnT.  Grape 


♦—  -♦-= — 3 ♦ «— — I 1— f-d-r—ol u— m—  -•©<— — \y — » *-= 3 


§es 


*â–   -  [/ 

hear  the  Sav-iour  say,  "Thy  strength  in  -deed  is  small.Child  of  weak-ness 
ord,  now  in -deed  I  find  Thy  povr'r,  and  Thine  a -lone, Can  change  the 
ince      noth-ing  good  have  I     Where-by  Thygracetoclaim,I'll         wash    my 

— ■  -^Egzz^EtmEm&zEzz^EEEEc^ 

—hi — i— t»— » — r — »—  -l — 


ztelszz!*: 


±lrz=tn=t3^ 


^tr-fe^c 


Chortts. 


-&: 


£=:£: 


T 


watch  and  pray, Find  in    Me  thine  all     in    all." 
Iep  -  er'sspots,And         melt  the  heart  of  stone.  Je  -  sus  paid   it     all, 
gar -ments white,  la     the  blood  of  Cal-v'ry's  Lamb. 
-*- 

4r_ t-r 


1 


$£ 


BMJ^id^^^^ 


£=£ 


1 

IS 


All  to  Him  I  owe;     Sin  had  left    a  crim-son  stain; He  washed  it  white  as  snow. 

-£z_t:-tr_g_d. 

U.    b — Is — F 


£l« 


ff-,r  f  ,c   k  ,' 


l>    V  v 


No.  66.  Traveling  the  Royal  Road 

G.  W.  Gaskell  Warren 


I =±_S_LA_  M — j, — M ^ 4 ^ ^ a—U^—L^ £ — .^ A— ^— I 9,       A1' — 1 

-^-       K  -a-  -fl|-  -â– -  -[3.  _fl_         _p_         -yy 


1.  I'mtrav-el  -ing  a  -long  the  roy-  al  road  that  leads  to  heaven's  glo-  ry  -land, 

2.  Some-times  I  get  so  tired  of   this  old  world,  and  long  to    fly     a  -way  to   rest, 

3.  I'm  glad  that  I  can  say  I'm  on  my  way  to  meet  the  King  up  -  on  thethrone, 


rv T~e-rS-S-"-« «— * * » ^ » ®~  r  * * * * ^ * rr-l 


£±3= 


t  tf  b  u  u" 


=A— LA A A A A A A A A A—1-" * " ^- *A— A S^—* 

-a-  -a-    -«-    -»-    -a-        \j  w 


-9-  -a-     -«-     -»-     -ia-  y 

I'm  go  -  ing  to  that  Cit  -  y  built  four-square,  to  join  the  ho  -  ly  an-gel  band: 
I  want  to  be  at  home  with  Christ,  my  Lord  and  all  the  hap  -py,good  andblest; 
There  sor-row  ne'er  shall  come  to    me    a  -gain, nor  death  shall  ev  -  er  claim  His  own; 


_=fs±J=fci^5 


A1 — A-  H~— la— ft  -* 


& 


Twill  be     a    joy   to  live    in  that  sweet hoaie  that  Je  -  sus  has  pie-pared  for  me, 
And  when  my   pil-grim  jour-neybere  is    o?er  I'll  go      to  heav-en's  blest  a  -bode, 
A      hap- py    ju  -  bi -lee     is  wait-ingthere,thebless-edmorn-ing  soon  shall  dawn, 


.^-tzi^t: 


dps: 


i|s_-'a a — a |s; 


-*-£-- 


:t2=tr5=cJ=fc3=^=p=t3=b=U=b=t3-tb=b=b=b: 


he  saints  in  that  a  -bode. 

FINE. 

■■■■•■-  ---^^1  i=^i=*-*=^=E=a 


D.  S.I  know  He  has   a  place  for  me    up  there  a-mong  thesaintsin  that  a  -bode. 


Ob,  what  a  hap-  py  time  I'll  have  up  there  with  Je  -  sus  thra  e  -ter-ni-ty. 
I'm  sing-  ing  hap-  pyprais-es  all  the  way  and  press-lng  on  the  Eoy-al  road. 
So        I    will  press  a -long  thru  toil  and  care,  to    heav-  en  I   will  trav-el     on, 


-i —    -■- 

m 


t- 


Isr — Is— " r: l-l 


P-St 


-Pk — i 


— -Hfe 2s. — rr 1* r !---t>'k ST- T 

__H  _Up_L,3, 9 9 0 9 q 1 J 

-tp-p-^-g-^-p-p— -J 

Oh,  broth-er,come  a  -long and  go  with  me  and  trav-  el    on   the  Roy-  al  road. 
Chorus,  j^h  &!      f^     -,       _k  _*_i 


?m4 


I'm 


T 


p   K   e   p    "    y 

on    the  Roy  -al    road   to     glo 
I'm  on  the  road  glo 


V 
ry 


land,  ana 

land, 


§e 


S§=S 


Zfc q_=ZATT=A-: 


ifc 


.^i 


Copyright,  1948.  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher  in  "Gospel  Clory" 


Traveling  the  Royal  Road 

sing- ing   all      a   -  long  the  way,  I'm    let  -  ting  Je  -sub   ev  -   er 

sing-ing  a    •  long        on     the  way,  Let  •  ting         the  Lord 

fc      h  fe  D-s- 


«=' 


y 


4 — £_:!!_£_■ — ■ — » — p * m 


v- 


^rrn- 


fe 


hold  my  hand, and  guide  me    ev  - 'ry   pass- ing     day; 

hold     to  my  hand,        guide  me  on    each  pass  -  ing    day; 


No.  67. 

James  Nicholson 


:t: 


J=£ 


Whiter  than  Snow 


-y — y — i 


Wm.  G.  Fischer 


£££=£333 


1 1 (g^-L^ @ 1 


1.  Lord,  Je-sus,  I  want  to    be  per-fect-Iy  whole,  I  want  Theefor-ev-er  to 

2.  Lord,  Je-sus,  look  down  from  Thy  throne  in    the  skies,  Andhelp  me  to  make  a  com- 

3.  Lord,  Je-sus,  for  this    Imosthumbly    en-treat,  I   wait, blessed  Lord, at  Thy 

4.  Lord,Je-sus,thouse-est    I     pa-tient-ly  wait, Comenow, and with-in  me    a 
[>•■■■ 


-I- 


live     in     my    soul;  Break  down  ev-'ry      i    -    die,  cast  out    ev-'ry    foe, 
plete  sac  -  ri  -  fice;     I    give    up    my -self,     and  what-ev  -  er     I   know, 
cru  -  ci  -  fled  feet;    By  faith  for  my  cleans -ing     I      see  Thy  blood  flow, 
pew  heart  ere  -  ate;    To  those  who  have  sought  Thee, Thou  nev-er  saidst  no, 


D.S. 


Now  wash  me  and  I  shall  be  whiter  than  snow.  Whiter  than  snow,  yes,  whiter  than  snowj 


,  Fine. 


Chorus. 


-*— *— V 


3=t 


3(= 


U"-l< 


1 


CE± 


tt 


=F 


IIeS! 


P 


No.  68.        He  Made  a  New  Creature  of  Me 

Chas.  W.  V.  Chas.  W.  Vaughan 


1.  I        was  wand'ring  sad    and  lone,  with    no  place    to    call    my  own, 

2.  Noth-ing    here  can  change  my  love    for     my  Lord  who  reigns  a  •  bove, 

3.  It     will    not    be     ver  -  y     long    till      I      join   the  bloodwashed  throng, 


.m — p — a_  qz 

p  n  r 


I'm  hap-  py    to  -day, 

I'm  hap-  py    to-day, 


P     P     P 
for    I    am   free; 


for    I  am  free; 


-9-    -#-     -»-     -»- 


'Hr -^ — —- -- — t_k__5_b_^D e 3_g — b. 


P     0     P  ^     ! 

&0fa*zz^?t£tzit^^ 


Je    â–   sns   came  and  saved  my  soul,  made   the  hal  -    le  -  lu  -  jahs    roll, 

For      He  keeps  me      by    His  pow'r    ev  -  'ry  day    and  ev  -  'ry    hour, 

There  for     ev  -   er-  more    to    sing    hap  -  py  prais  -  e3  to     the  King, 

I*-  -N     -*-  -*- 

-I -i 1 1 — H* fc * — k ' 


r*Hn 


b   P   u 


He  made  a  new  crea-ture  out   of    me. 

Made  a  new  creature  out   of   me,        out   of  me. 


S=E=I 


h  -,♦-    >-    >-    -*- 


A A A 4 A 1 1 r- 

:=|a — ^z=t2 — = tnzO-tA — : 


JliJ 


IN     Pi 


Chorus. 


^W^-aF-*2131— *— al-p* ^— a— r— a— s— l-g-Fyzsi d-j 

If — =) — -s cs — F=B— p— p— p ^•-u-"-^-3 


Je-sus  made  a  new  crea-ture 


out   of    me, 


Made  a  new  crea-ture  out  of  me,     out  of  me, 


effirEzfE 


— i 5"— ■£-  -IT  'lfc— £— t-~-h-r1*'- —  ?— I — ' — «—i 


Copyright  1948  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher,  in  "gospel  glory." 


He  Made  a  New  Creature  of  Me 


3n 


A — A — A A — A A — AL 


3B 


:=£ 


That  is  why  I    am  hap 


'=»=Az:5=:*=?z1 
\j~XT~ 


P~ 


py,glad  and  free; 


That  i3  why  I  am  hap-py, glad  and  free,60  hap-py  and  free 


_. -r-^-t- 


gl? 


^^t^^^^J^ 


^^TO^^^fe 


^-h-^-5- 


:z4=l=S?Art:^=A-t£: 


J 


His  won-der-ful  joy  is  flooding  my  soul  shice  the  dear  Saviour  came  and  made  me  whole, 


B 


:S-S_J-S-Ji 


A-       -*.-       -A  > 

;--k-  -k fa. 


No.  69. 

E.  H.  Stokes 


Fill  Me  Now 


=t=t 


=fc 


3=Fl 


*g — *— u 


John  R.  Sweeney 

-<s> P— f-<s* -I , 

1 1 j-— I ♦ r-+r- 

igzzzpzzL^ — *— iSr 


1.  Hov  -  er    o'er    me,  Ho  -  ly    Spir  -  it,  Bathe  my  trembling  heart  and  brow; 

2.  Thou  canst  fill  me,  gra-cious  Spir  -  it,  Tho'  I  can -not  tell  Thee  how; 
3.1  am  weak -ness, full  of  weak-ness,  At  Thy  Sa-cred  feet  I  bow; 
4.  Cleanse  and  com -fort,  bless  and  save  me, Bathe,  0  bathe  my  heart  and  brow; 


-£2_ 


*SB=3= 


* 


t- 


Fa: 


—=:=:(= 


:=1: 


:=t: 


t= 


-g-    -g-    -J-  -p-__-^- 


y_^_^ — 


FlNE. 


"4 


^: 


3=^: 


Fill  me  with  Thy  hal- 
But  I  need  Thee,grej 
Blest  di- vine,  e  -  ter 
Thou  art  com- fort -ing 

■&-    -£-    -M- 


@^=p^P=p=bpz= 


|cz±s=ztz 


— 5-—  ^ — *- 

lowedpre8-ence,Come,0    come,  and 

>t-ly   need  Thee, Come,  0    come,  and 

-  rial  Spir  -  it,    Fill  with  pow'r,and 

and  sav-ing,  Thou  art  sweet -ly 

*-    -f2-  -£-    #    -*- 


fill  me 
fill  me 
fill  me 
fill  -  ing 


r 


"(fir 


I  I  I 


lit 


now. 
now. 
now. 
now. 

-fix. 


D.S.-Fill  me  with  Thy  haHowedpres-ence,Come,0  come,  and    fill    me 


H*'  \xA' 


3—t 


a. 


-p- 


DOW, 

D.S. 

4=B 


-H- 


-oHr- 


-Hs 


j2ZZfl 


Fill    me    now,        fill 


me    now,      Je  -  bus,  come,  and     fill     me 

■#-         ~-  -J-      -J-      -g-        -r«-        -P-      _£- 


e 


{ft  â– 'iF-T 


£= 


now; 


No.  70.  My  Saviour  Will  be  Near 

Adger  M.  Pace  James  D.  Walbert 


1.  When  I'm   wea  -  ry      and     oh, 
I  2.  When   it    seems  that  there's  none 
3.  When  my     life      on     this    earth 


lone  â–  

call 

near 


'4_A IA_ 


s=z=5==z*z:-%. 


ly      and 

me    their   own, 

ing     the     end, 


=£=e==e — b — $--m 


~^^m^ 


â–        *]     "S.      '  -*      -at       -*-      -At      -*-      -^-      -^-      -i^- 

'Tis  then  my  bless-ed  Sav-iour  comes  near  and*mak-eth   me   glad,         so    glad, 
And  with  my  heav-y     bur- den     I    have   to   trav  -  el      a  -  lone,  a  -  lone, 

And   as    I    cross  the  riv  -  er,     I     see    I'm  need- ing    a   Friend,        a  Friend, 

-A-      -A- 


And  all  the  bur  -  dens  of  life  are  car  -  ried 
'Tis  then  1  hear  my  dear  Sav-iour  say  -  ing 
I'm    sure   that  He     will    be    near    to     com -fort 


WEB 


ezfc 


way, 
me, 
soul, 


a 
to 
my 


t?~ f— b— b— tJ" 


:t33=^==^=P=tp 


— fr" 


-J     1 


p  D 


And  light  of  hope  shines  o  -  ver  my  soul  and  brings  a  new  day. 
Lookup  and  lay  your  bur -den  on  me,  and  you  shall  be  free. 
And  guide  me   safe  -  ly      o  -  ver    the    tide,  to    heav- en    my  goal. 


-i — p- 
-n P" 


;&£ 


t2=i 


Chorus. 


-5— S-z- 


-fr-  h     h- 


0 


-»— at- 


^1— «- 


My  Sav-ioarwill  be    so   near, 


$=:$=$: 


p-i?F 


<^-=== 


<beei 


,     ;â–      ,     â–   l,    K    p    u     ^       ^ 

What-ev-er   the  task  may  be, 

ev  -  er     be, 

-K     >-    -*- 

- - — f— E--&. 


ver  -  y  near, 

>-   A-   -K- 

-T  T  V 
-k — *— 


Copyright  1948  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher,  in  "'gospel  glory. 


My  Saviour  Will  be  Near 

that  when   I    have  cause  to    fear,  I'm  sure   He  will  com  -fort    me; 

shrink  with  fear  com  -fort    me: 

-♦-    -*-     -♦- 

■iL , lir-ltL-t--, ,-m—* 


5-3— S Eg 1 


^^~7rh~"^*~  ~*~  *~~     *~ *— *~  *— *— w-Jga— — =p 

And  When  He  shall  call    me     o    -  ver   the    tide  at    clos-  ing    oi    day, 


^H 4Sbfi  JJl 


iJ     *1  ^  -S-   -*-    w*  -a     ^*-w  B  U  L*J 


0       b 

On  wings  of  love  I'll  sail  a-way  t 


for- ev-er   to  stay,    with  Him  there  to   stay. 


5-*\- 


-k— k— i*— fc— *-f 

:pz:p-^z:toz 


:^H2s_H_^,. 


ft=A= 


!est  in  Peace 


J.  Porter  Thomason 
3— ~+- 


1.  Eest  in    peace,    si  -  lent  -  ly,  Now    thy    earth-ly     days  are    o'er; 

2.  Sleepin    peace, sweet   re  -pose, While  thy    spir  -  it    mounts  on    high; 

3.  Thou  shalt  wake, from  thy   sleep,Life  "   will    then  have  just      be  -  gun; 


i£ 


*^=1=^ 


-I i 1 f 


_^_g_.  ...     ... 


fc=fc: 


=t==t 


at 


ej 


— f-w -d -H — — i 1 ^ ™ ym « s5 


Born  a  -  way,  as  on  wings, There  to  rest  for  -  ev  -  er-more. 
There  to  be  with  the  saints,  Nev  -  er  -more  to  say  good  -  by. 
Death  shall  come   nev  -   er  -  more,  When  the   crown    of      life      is        won. 

._:£ :£_,:£ £. . £—rt- *_  -*=• 


-A-        -A-       -&•      -F-       -F-        -K-        A-        -A- 


:t=z=t: 


PSS 


i=~-tzE: 


its: 


Copyright,  1942,  J.  Porter  Thomason,  Owner, 


No.  72.      I  Want  to  Join  in  Singing  There 

Theo.  P.  Theo  Powell 


1.  There  will  be     a      won-drous  sing-ing    o  -  ver     in      the    glo  -   ry   land, 

2.  Hap-  py  songs  will  then    be  ring-  ing  when  that  choir    be  -  gins    to    sing, 

3.  Therewith  all  the  saints  and  sag  -  es   gath  -ered  on    the     glo  -  ry  shore, 


^4J=is=EiL3=is=tiz=:iz=S—  £zzz*=E=fc— t=E=M 


I    want  to    join 


p"~3~Tnf 

in    sing-  ing  there; 
I    want  to    join  in     sing-  ing  there,  in    sing-ing  there; 


gp=g= 


:z-_t_t_t: 

:fcz=lK— Iszzte 
:p=b=p— b; 


ts~ H -=1 = 1 1 


b_^_^_L^.._tJ_y_p 


m 


-#-  -8-       n  p         ;       -â– -    4 

All  the  saint-  ed, white  robed  sing-ers  will  be  in  that  cho  -  rus  grand, 
Teeming  mil- lions  will  be  sing- ing  prais-es  to  the  Sav -iour.King, 
Sing-ing  song*  of    joy    and  tri-  umph ,prais-ing    God    for  -  ev  -  er -more, 

-*- 

_.      tr_ 
:£=zi=ztK: 


I    want  to    join 


id2 


BE 


D    P"  u    '    u 

in    sing-  ing  there. 
I    want   to  join     in    sing- ing  there,  in   sing- ing  there. 

:±:    :£.   :£    £    ...  h      n      p>      h     P 

=b=b=b=:b=^— gz=£=fc — ,b: 


I    want  to   join  in   sing-ing  there, 

I    want   to  join  in   sing-ing  there* 


_a|  _.~_ 


_-■- B -■- -[— -_  _ 

zfc~[szz:lizz:is 

zp—bzzzpzz:t^==== 


=Ei=ts=E=E=ts=J 


C  opyfight,  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory." 


I  Want  to  Join  in  Singing  There 


*J  v  1     h     i,     fi     fi     »-  nub 


-p tr 


1    x         _l    P    b    p    E>    »  n    P 

The  song    of    love,  in    glo  -  ry  fair; 

The  song    of  love    in    glo  -  ry   fair,   in    glo  -  ry    fair; 

K  h  ^ 

:a i E 1£ E f— i A~E" *-" j 


^•SEE§= 


-fe* 


-■ — -J — h— r —  —  ■ — tt  n2 


==1— 


♦ 


m 


sfi; 


With    all  the  saints  from  ev  -  'ry-where, 

With    all  the  saints  irom  ev-  'ry-where. 


s 


-=1  .€- 


i^6-=2fe 


I    want  to    join 


in    sing-ing  there. 


% 


d2=: 


irz:?: 


I    want   to  join     in     sing- ing  there,  in   sing-  ing  thers. 

-A-      -A-      -A-      -A- 


."  _  e 


P   45   JLjLil 


-^; 


7XT- 


No.  73. 


God  is  Present  Everywhere 


J.    H.    FILLMORE. 


ft* 


:^^^ff^4j=E^==^ 


-? — i 


-4^-y 


1.  They  who  seek    the  throne  of  grace   Find  that  throne  in 

2.  In       our  sick-ness,   in     our  health,   In     our  want  or 

3.  When  our  earth -ly   com -forts  fail,  When  the  woes  of 

-P-  -9-    ■*-    ■¥-     *     -f2- 


ev  -  'ry  place; 
in  our  wealth; 
life    pre  -  vail, 


WB. 


Mh£ 


m  m  w 


4^ 


£ 


i 


fit 


E 


fe&3 


NP^ 


If  we  live  a  life  of  pray'r,  God  is  pres  •  ent 
If  we  look  to  God  in  pray'r,  God  is  pres  •  ent 
'Tis  the  time    for  earn  •  est  pray'r,  God     is      pres  •  ent 


fe  | 


£ 


ev  -  'ry  •  where, 
ev  -  'rv  -  where, 
ev  -  'rv  •  where. 


W0m^ 


No.  74. 

W.  E.  H. 


I'm  Glory  Bound 


:3zr£=-£--£=± 


W.  E.  Hinton 


=*-— j- -^ Ltf # 5 ^ 1 0 fl_ 


_j _ _, 3 1 S 


1.  I        am  walk- ing    in    the  light,  in    the    path    that's  al   -way3bright, 

2.  When  my  work  on  earth  is    done  and  the      vie  -    fry   has    been   won, 

3.  Oh,    my  broth-er,  come  a  -  long, join  me       in       my    hap   -   py    song, 


nx 


,4z«— i~^z=z~L~t— !*=£— jz=r pi 

1/      U  •     y    ■  y      i        v      v 


^=±=:$^=^td=== 


A *  | 


h^~ 


^~ 


tj 


Us- 


It  will  lead  me  home  to  heav  -  en  some  sweet  day; 
I  will  meet  Him  o  -  ver  yon  -  der  face  to  face, 
Let  the    Sav  -iour  fill      you   with      His    per    -  feet  love; 

IN       IS       IN  > 

-A fg—  rA * A & *—- — A A r»— -A- 


1 


-.-* rN-r-& & h N— 


§Sez^=?=:B— *— z&zzalzzr  ^=ar-  fezzz^zzaz— J— a|zzj 

For      I'vemade  the  Lordmy  choice  and      in      Him      I     now      re  -  joice, 
In        that  land  of   pure    de  -light, where  there  comes  no  shades    of   night, 
Then    at     last, when  we    get  home,  un  -  der  -  neath   the    shin  -  ing  dome, 

-rA A ii A A A r 

...       -^=s=fA=ts— tsz=g==?=t5==p==p==p=:=^i 

V      \J      y       y       y       y       i         V    - ,  V    .        â– ".  I 


a: 


i&jz 


g-fcr 


^SP^? 


-fe-r^ & 


£— , 


=T3: 


-fV 


EWJH-^ d Ld d H esi -4 H !â–  


z=zzzfr 


©?& 


&££zk 


— @- 

As  I  trav-  el  ia 
And  I'll  praise  Him  for 
We    will     sing    His  praise 

IN         IN         IN 

-A g £* A -A 


this  love  -   ly        glo 
His    won-  drous   sav 

e3 


ry     way. 
ing  grace. 


i   Oy 


~p" 


zpzzzt 


with   the    saints    a  -   bove. 

p> S h* « gr— j 

ZZna       ~~ZZ  f      j 


:fc 


£= y-— t2==t2: 


Chorus.  ,, — — — — ^^  ». 


^: 


.£_ 


-i — h^= 


g 


Zfr 


I'm  glo  -  ry  bound,  oh,  praise  the  Lord, 

I'm  glo-  ry  bound, oh,  praise  the  Lord,  oh.praise  the  Lord, 

-A A- 


§& 


^r-z=S=H== P— jz^gzzjgjzzzg— =fe=^=C— E=?=j 


y    â–   1/     /     y  v 

Copyright,  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaugban  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory." 


®=5=W 


m 


I'm  Glory  Bound 


W'  v  â–   -o   "I v ^J 


_h- 


FP 


: — » — j 


I'm  trust- ing  now,  Hi9   Ho-  ly  word; 

I'm  trust-  iug  now,  His  Ho  -  ly  word; 

_ — , a — A — 4 — 4 A — A — A — A — .. 


-A) 


m 


Oh,won't  you  join  me     in    this  way, 

Oh,  won't  you  join  me     in  this  way, 


EEi==i=z:feEz|sE3 


IK 


D  •  b    U    U    \ 

with  Hfm   to   stay. 
I'm    glo-  ry  bound  with  Him   to    stay, with  Him  to   stay, 

■**  ■*-  -*•  -g-  r  f  ^'  ■*■  ■*"  ■•■ 


S 


-ar— S- 


=p=f- 


:«c 


:— ^: 


~b 


No.  75.  How  Sweet  the  Name  of  Jesus  Sounds 

John  Newton  Rev.  Thomas  Hastings 


WW 


:4=iz 


dC 


,-1- 


4— 4- 


=t=zFfezz=h 


:stzt 


$£$=$ 


^=L-.E=z|z:bgzzg: 


-si — a-- 


1.  How  sweet  the  name  of    Je  -  bus  sounds,  la     a     be  -  liev-er's  ear!  It  soothes  his 

2.  It  makes  the  wounded  spir-  it  whole,  And  calms  the  trou-bledbreastj'Tisman-ca 

3.  By   Him  my  pray'rs  ac-cept-ance  gain, Al-tho'  with  sin    de-fi!ed,Sa-tan  ac- 


ig^3 


-A-r 


,A — 1»— rA — A— ri^ — A— rc p- 


:tz=fcs: 


' — — ^-"-si- 


=Es=rf!b::iz:Eg— a-Ej— £:E: 


■w — tf 


3=F 


sorrows,  heal  his  wonnds,  And  drives  a  -way  his  fear,  And  drives  a- way  bis  fear. 
to  the  hun-gry  soul,  And  to  thewea-ry  rest,  And  to  thewea-ry  rest, 
cus-es    me   in  vain,  And    I     am  owned  a  child,  And  I     am  owned  a  child. 


g^=r    r> F — a— Fp— ^-F^— l=Fp— a-F         EEEEEEE3 


1*11  Away  to  Rest 


No.  76. 

Charles  H.  Huff 


L.  C.  Higdon 


~&- 


:^=4= 


— It—1 


1.  When  the  sun    of    life     is    set  -  ting,and    my  work  on  earth 

2.  When  I    hear  my  Sav-  iour  call-  ing    for    the  ran-somed  of 

3.  When  the  trumpet  loud    is  sound-ing    and  the  saints  shall  all 


19 

the 
a 


done, 

race, 

-  rise, 


I'll  a-  way 
I  will  go 
I      will  rise 


to  rest, 
to  Him, 
and  go 


m 


'-^---3- 


-f—sj— St- 


and 

and 

to 

-A-   -  A- 


P    P    \)  U 


%* — * — <«- 
re-  ceive  the  crown  I've  won; 
in  heav-  en  take  my  place; 
the    sup- per     in    the  skies; 


-f-» — ■ — ■- 

"  P    D     v 


$mm$^m^^0^ 


-bv 


* 


Cares  of  life  I'll  leave  be-hind  me,  sor  -  rows  all  will  fade 
'Tis  a  joy  to  know, some  morning  when  the  harps  be  -  gin 
When  the  Lord  shall  say  come  high-er,      en  -  ter      in    with    bis 


a  -  way, 
to  play, 
to    stay , 


,  , jl ■*, . r* *— ?* CST ^ — I 


U    U    b    v    \i 


V     V     p 


eJ 


:-fc-^- 


ffi^E 


-ab— 


-a—  *  — 


pztaM^Mtzt: 


I'll  a  -way 


I'll  a -way 


-i- 


to  rest, 


in     the  land   of    per-  feet  day. 


to  rest, 


^-3~= 


m 


-*.    -a-    -•-  +-'-'    :h:     :h"    -h-     +-     -♦"    -t- 


1 4 


P    h 


-tu*- 


Chorus.         k     k     k  I '     P  _h        _h 1__p.__h- 


-     b    b    ?  u  ^  U  i 

At  the  set-ting  of  the  sun, 
to  rest,  Set    •  ting      of  the  sun, 

*—t~  »~~^~ 

Copyright,  1948,  by  James  DTvaughan,  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory," 


I'll  Away  to  Rest 


With  the  good 


and  blest,  wear  the  crown  that  I  have  won; 

With  the  good  and  blest,  -  that  I  have  won; 


He 


I A A * A A A A — i ■ * — »—  ± W 

-    -    -  55    P  p  p  P 


^3      E^^^"1 


ipii 


-fc. 


a 


:*=a: 

b  y  ^  u 


i 


With   a  shout  of  joy,  when  the  clouds  hare  passed  a-svay, 

With  a  shout  of  jot,  Clouds  have    passed a-way, 

#- 1 


§as 


m 


A — -A A A A rA— -A — m — A— -m 

0    0    l>        .  P       .U         b    t?    p 


,s^fe=%t#==p^%M= 


t—y. 


I'll  a-way,  I'll  a-way,  to  the  land  of  per-fectday. 

I'll  a- way,  I'll  a-way,  per-fectday. 

-#-  -•-  -•-  -•-  -P-  -•-      -•-  _    .ft  h  j> 


^=3: 


m 


b"_jpu — pi 


■*—  -h-  -♦ 


u^UJitif 


No.  77. 

JAMES    ROWE. 

SoZo  or  Quartet 
h 


0  p  u  p  r 

I  Shall  Reach  Home 

Howard  E.  Smith. 


K 


3 


SSS 


^ 


=£ 


tpsh 


1.  Foes  may  be -tide  me,  Darkness  may  hide  me,  Christ  is   be-sideme;  I  shall  reach  home. 

2.  Stormsmayafrightme,Dearonesmajslig'htme,  Sin  try  toblightme;  I  shall  reach  home. 

3.  Bur-dens  may  bend  me,  Grief  of  t -times  rcud  me,  Strength  He  will  lend  me;  I  shall  reach  home 

4.  Heav-en   is  near-ing,  Clouds  dis-ap-pear-ing,  An-gels  are  cheering;  I  shall  reaeh  home. 


m 


JE 


=J= 


-A-     -£s- 


ft=£ 


§ 


a 


^ 


Chorus. 


tefea 


*: 


3^K^$ 


^a^s 


-«T #- 


-♦- 


^- 


1 


He  will  not  grieve  me,  Slight  or  de-ceiveme;  He  will  not  leave  me;  I  shall  reach  home. 

-A-  -A-    -A^-   -ft-     t£t^ 


-A-     -A-     -A- 


E 


^ 


£=fc 


?=# 


fcfc 


F^ 


F=t-^ 


B 


JAMES    D.    VAUGHAN,    OWWEE. 


No.  78.      Stay  in  the  Middle  of  the  Road 

W.  B.  W.  W.  B.  Walbert 


#^= 


m=i 


Â¥ 


3c 


it 


45= 


z&-_=q: 


--S-— # 


=* 


I 


1.  Broth-er,    as     you  trav  -  el       in     this  world    be  -  low,    So       of  -    ten 

2.  There  are    man -y      de  -  tours   on   this    gos  -  pel     way,    And    man  -  y 

3.  Keep  your  eyes    up  -   on    the  bright  and    shin  -  ing    goal,   And    ev  -    er, 


:fe 


-t> — P" 


-tp — tr 


-3 £- 


X 


=£3 


-*i gg 


H=|=tf 


— =-p== — ^ — ==q 


Btrug-gling 'neath  a    heav-y     load,    a     heav    -   y      load;  Look    up,     and 
snares  of    sin      on    them  are    sowed,  on    them    are  sowed;  But       if      you 
strive  to    reach  that  blest    a  -    bode, that  blest      a  -   bode;  Ee  -    mem-  ber, 


jdL 


1? P P P \ 


Efe 


# 


£=* 


s=£=* 


keep        in        step    with      Je  â–  

want        to      reach    that   land 

Sa    -    tan's    bid    -ding     high 


-5- 

sus 

of 

for 


r=^=ff_= 


mm 


m 


as 
nev 

your 

-&- 


you 
er 
im 


on  -  ward  go, 
end  -  ing  day, 
mor  -    tal     soul, 


t — f— — * 


_  .-, pL_ £ p_     I _ 


:i=**=±»_.      -     - - 

My  broth  -  er,   stay    in    the    mid  -  die      of    the    road. 

the      mid  -  die    of    the  r«ft3. 

D    P    D ' .  T>     HjJ^  _h    l 


Stay  in     the    mid- die      of     the    road, 


Stay  in     the    mid-  die, 


the    mid  -  die       of      the    road,  Broth -er, 


-A-        1*- 

t — r= 


£ 


-p — p — tr 


=1 


Copyright,1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory." 


Kg — ^      gj       ^ — al — g — *— bj- 


Stay  in  the  Middle  of  the  Road 

^=^=#=3=3 

Stay    in     the    raid  -  die     of     the   road;  Don't  let   old 

stay     in    the    mid  -  die,  the   mid  -  die     of    the   road; 

-A-         -Jk-  -*-         -*-  -a-  -A- 

tp — p — f— t?— ^ 

:3—£ — -* — r—  i 


WIG ==P==D=ZD==:i!=n=PK 5 E 


*=^— *: 


£=* 


-IV 


$: 


=£E-EE?=a 


=F^= 


Sa  -tan    turn  you  'round, but  keep  your    feet      on     sol   -    id    ground, 
*      & 


:&: 


t2 — p — t? — fcr 


1/      w      t? 

My  broth  -  er,   stay    in    the    mid  -  die      of    the    road. 

the      mid  -  die    of    the  road. 


A.    .A.    .*.    ,A.    .*.     r>     P    _P     D     huj    h    I 

g=jp=t=t2ZZlt2=t2IlZt2ZZi:t2ZZp^I _Z=~:fl 


No.  79.     My  Faith  Looks  Up  to  Thee 


Ray  palmer. 


Lowell  Mason. 


3==%^j— <sj+d=^— jM-i 


i 


f=s 


^^y- 


1.  My  faith  looks  up  to  Thec,Thou  Lamb  of  Cal-va-ry,  Saviour  Divine;  Nowhearme 

2.  May  Thy  rich  grace  impart  Strength  to  my  faint-ing  heart,  My  zeal  in-spire ;  As  Thou  hast 

3.  While  life's  dark  maze  I  tread  And  griefs  around  me  spread,  Be  Thou  my  Guide;  Bid  darkness 

-*-    -A- 


ra 


ft B       B-    B       Ci.       (3       0       O       »•     B       f> 


jU. 


:t: 


£= 


t=± 


5= 


P^FrTF 


pSJ 


* 


fa^^ 


2 


S 


3: 


while  I  pray,  Take  all  my  sins  a  -  way ,  0   let  me  from  this  day  Be  whol  -  Iy  Thine ! 
died  for  me,  0  may  my  love  to  Thee,  Pare,  warm  and  changeless  be  A  liv  -ing   fire, 
turn  to-day,  Wipe  sorrow's  tears  away,  Nor  let  me  ev-erstrayFromTheea  -  side. 

-±r--±-   -A aSs-  -A-5-  -A-    -A- 


^S 


I 


» 


s: 


s~  |a    |j- 


m 


*E 


I"  I   Ml    b  ispf 


No.  80. 

Fay  Wallington 


Over  the  Tide 


Will  L.  Matthews 


m^pmmmmm^mmi 


1.  I'm    so  glad    I     have  found  the  way  lead-ing    to  that  e  -  ter-nal  day, 

2.  Thru  the  pow'r  of  His    sav  -  ing  grace,some  day  I'll  lookup-  on  His  face, 

3.  When  I  reach  that    e  -  ter  -  nal  land,    1    will  sing  with  the  an-gel  band, 

•A-  .,*-      -A-       -A-      -A-        ■*-      -A-  -A- 


-rtrr- 


a 


Where  my  sou!  with  Je  -sus  shall  a  -  bide, with  Him  a  -  bide  for  -ev  -  er; 
Far  be- yond  the  roll  -  ing  o  -  cean, wide, the  o  -  cean,wide,in  glo-ry; 
Prais  •  es    un  -  to  Him  who  for   me    died, who    for  me  died,  on  Cal-v'ry; 


Ejgfg — ,* — *■  -* — * — * — a — * — *— F— 
_y£^z=p=p=p=pz=p— g—g~l 


! — » t±~r 


f 


1 


D-4- 


| — 5 — g — | — " — f — f —  -^ — ^j — " — * — ^ — *i — jjj — 'J-H 


There  is     no    con-dem-  na- tion  now, light   of    love  shines  up- on  my  brow, 
For    I'-m saved  to   the     ut  -  ter-most, thru  the  pow'r  of    the    Ho- ly  Ghost, 
That  is    why  I'm    so    hap  -  py  here,  that  good  day  is     so   ver  -y  near; 
.A-    -A-     -A-     -A-     -A-     -A-      _      -A. 


m^ 


-£•-- 


£ A A A A A A- 


£ 


b — ^i b * * ^b h F=i:ff—  F3 


P 


1/       "V 
And    I'm     on     my     jour  •  ney  home,  o   •  ver    the    tide. 

the     roll  -  ing    tide. 


-A- -A-_ 


afep 


-A- 


-A- 


-tk & & ft 


-A- 

~i — 

-A— 


— »- 


Chorus. 


cfej^fafc^Sj^z 


i 


I    am  now  on  my  jour 


E§K 


95 


ney  home,nev-er-more  from  my  Lord       to  roam, 

:^z=bzzbj=^z=ciz=t3=ir=pzzt=j 


Copyright,  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory." 


Over  the  Tide 

■  — | J ■ M ■ 1 — 

-«i — t — g — f — 1 — 4-  ~ 


— i— 


Bl 


fe$ 


He    is    with  me    aa    my  Friend  and  Guide, my  Friend  and  Guide,for-ev  -er; 

-A-    >      _     -<*-      .       j^ vJS     a_- 

— I — is:~ 

And    I  know  He  will  take      me  thru,  If    to  Him  I    will  e'er        be  true, 

—i* — »—<* — *— » — F — »— S^ziJ^F —  — 


s^ 


-: 


:=S^^S=S=S=c========z==:=:3 


JLi 


.j__r, — 41 


r       P      y      P.  P  p      "     B*    r^ 

And    I'm     on     my     jour  -  ney  home,  0   •>  ver     the     tide. 

the     roll  -  ing    tide. 


:=t: 


E2*rf 


-A- 


-A.         -A-       -A-       _A_        ... 

-£. P- ,- 9 0 » — 

-!? » hh 1 n— 


2 


^  1 
-  -J- 


No.  81.  Pass  Me  Not 


Fanny  J.Crosby 


£=* 


8 


W.  H.  Doane 


_£3zz^zz^gJ=ir=-= 


.    L---- A| =j. 

1.  Pass  me  not,  O   gen-tle  Saviour,  Hear  my  humble  cry;  While  on  oth-ers 

2.  Let  me  at     a  throne  of  mer-cy,  Find  a  sweet  re  -lief;  Eneel-ing  there  in 

3.  Trusting  on  -Iy    in  Thy  mer  -it,  Would  I  seek  Thyf ace;  Heal  my  wounded 

4.  Thouthesurint'of   all  my  comfort, Morethanlifeto  me;Whomhave  I    on 

D.S. — While  on  oth-ers 
•     .     Fine.   Chorus.  0. 5. 


£fc 


D. S. Thou  art  call-ing,Donotpassme  by. 

deep con-tri-tion, Eelpmy un-be-lief.    Sav-iour,Sav -  iour,liearmy humble cryj 
bro-  ken  spir  -  it , Save  me  by  Thy  grace, 
earth  be-sideThee?Whominliea»'n  but  Thee? 


-&•  -M--*- 


^B 


£z£±|s 


s- 


t=w=4 


^=3zrJ^-^Sg — 1 


KH&Sga 


No.  82. 

Adger  M.  Pace 


What  a  Joy  to  Know 


A.  0.  Hargett 


1.  What  a  joy  to  know  '  as    we    on-ward  go  toward  the  setting  of  the  sun, 

2.  What  a  joy  to  know   in   this  world  be-low,  we  can  have  Him  by  our  side, 

3.  What  a  joy  to  know  that  He  loves  us   so,  He    is    bid-ding  us  come  home, 

â–   -#  -#-     -0-    -0-                                              .0.          .0- 

Jjl 5 5— P— P= P-^p— V=tp — p" 3 

-N — i- 


■±-±—±iz 


That  the  Lord    is    near,bring-ing  hope  and  cheer  to  His  chil-dren,  ef-'ry  one; 
Fill  -  ing     us  with  song   as    we  press    a  -  long, tho' the  world  may  us  de-ride; 
To      the  land    of  light  and  the    Cit  -  y  bright,   un-der-neath  the  cloudless  dome; 
.0.     .0.     .0.      0.     .0.     .0.    -0.     .0.     .0.     .0.     .0      .0.    .0.       i\      P\      IN 

p    p    P    p    p 


p=p=£ 


:p=* 


-a— 5 


33-* 


-.^..j 
^=J 


Driv  -  ing  out  the  night, mak-ing  path-ways  bright. all  the  way  to  courts  a-bove, 
Mak  -ing  hearts, now  sad, hap  -  py,free  and  glad, when  they  find  His  sav -ing  grace, 
Where  we'll  sing  His  praise  thru  un-num-bered  days, with  the  saints  and  an-gels  fair, 

.A.     .A.     .A.     -Ai 


fct5=nz=: 


: — t — ♦- 
i — i 1 — 


S=£ 


-It It r~ 

:p=p-b 


-55  - 


1 


Till  the  glad  heart  sings  of  the  joy  it  brings, and  the  wonders  of  His  love. 
Start  for  glo  -  ry  land  with  our  hap  -  py  band, there  to  see  Him  face  to  face. 
Look-ing      on  His  face    in  that  hap  -  py  place, we  shall  live  for  -ev  -er  there 


Chorus.  k     k     k 

) , — &_f> — h K — k— 3^ 


* 


-p'-v- p^rf 


What  a    joy,  what  a    jpy,just  to  know  weshallsee, 

What   a  joy,  what   a    joy,  just  to  know  see  His  fats. 


i§g^ 


•m-  -i9-  -m- 


"t"  "?"_"3" 

-it—  it—  a-  > 


Copyright,  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory," 


What  a  Joy  to  Know 

Andwith  saints  onhigh.far    a-  bove  the  sky, sing   a-bout  His  love  and  grace; 

sav-ing  grace; 


^ 


„&_&_-&- 


^^gg^asfe 


z=t5=45=^5=^r— p±=^=^=2[=^z:^=^: 


-ft— F®: 
-g-r|- 


â– 0 


What  a  joy  it  will  be, with  the  pure  and  the  free, 

What  a  joy  it  will  be,  with  the  pure  all  the  free, 

f\    c\ "  f\  i  rs    i\    !\  -,♦-  -«-  -i9-  -A-    _ 

„ -»-.   »-  -ih      ' -•_  «■    -•• -y-    -h-    -(— -|—    .p.  .j. 

ffij 1 — *3j3 -tat — ft—  *■=•  — — pi £ 1 K tk A — i*. i 

M*_«— g_U_- — : 


-  -bt P —  A-1-  — —  — 5- 


s 3 


— p— 1 P— 5-P= 


Just    to  praise  Him  there  in    the   Cit  â–   y     fair, thru- out   all    e  -  ter- ni  -  ty. 

-A-      -A-     -A-      -i*-       _         „        -9-      -!*-      -A-  _  _ 

-     -  .r1r__t-_ ff-_ i?-_- r_ it—t    •*-   -p-    " 


*    "*'  !  "  ':b:   :a=fc^iS^^fefc=fe: 


— m xi — rr)— 


-£-  . 


zjszzs: 
'U  •  U    k 


1 


No,  83, 

A.  Reed. 


Holy  Ghost  With  Light  Divine 


GOTTSCHALK. 


» 


lE^Q 


Z^=2 


f 


lililsiiiftS 


1.  Ho   -  ly  Ghost,  with  light  di -vine,  Shine  up -on     this  heart  of  mice; 

2.  Ho   -  ly  Ghost,  with  pow'r  di- vine3Cieanse  this  guilt  -  y    heart  of  mine; 

3.  Ho   -  ly  Ghost,  with  joy  di- vine,  Cheer  this  sad-dened  heart  of  mine; 

4.  Ho   -  ly  Spir  -  it,    all  di- vine,  Dwell  with -in     this  heart  of  mine; 

k  ,        rA.  u  Jr\J 


r 


"rt; 


"£«J: 


•r-J- 


:*r 


=» 


St 


-o--^,- 


i»i 


"F 


Chase  the  shades  of  night    a-  way,  Turn  my  dark-ness    in  -  to  day. 

Long  hath  sin    with-out    con-trol,  Held    do  -  min  -  ion  o'er  my  soul. 

Bid      my    ma  -  ny  woes  de-part,  Heal   my  wound -ed, bleed- ing  heart. 

Cast  down  ev  -  'ry     i  -  die  throne,  Seign  su-preme,  and  reign  a -lone. 

_*hj L^La =_?- a J: 


fcsg 


No.  84. 

-    Mrs.  L.  W.  C. 


We'll  Sing  the  Glory  Song 


Mrs.  L.  W.  Carr 


---".     -5    -J  ~"     ■     "  "     "  ~P     y     £     y     P     .P"      . 

1.  There's  a  home  of  peace  and  hap  -  pi  -nesswait  -ing,  it       is  wait  -  ing, 

2.  In      that  home  the  saints  and   an -gels  are   sing  -ing, sweet-Iy   sing  -  ing, 

3.  Soon  the  time  will  come  for    me     to    be      go  -  rag,  op  -ward  go  -  ing, 

-A-  -A-       -A-       -A-        -         m_      -A-         "*- 

..  —  w— rs — * — « — * z~ « it— Jr  ,  |r_:p    r   1r — "P — J 

3=t2=Ft=t=P=lt>= P=p=p=Ep=p:=$=:£=p=p— 1 
yHj-^t— ^— r* — s — * — • — 5 • -P — Fh 


r  •  i .;.  r  -*-   ■*■ 

Just    be-yond  the  drear-  y    dark    bor  -  der      line, dark    line;  In    that 

Hap  -py  prais-  es     to     the    Sav  -  iour     di  -  vine,  di  -  vine;  And  some 

To    that  coun-try, with  them  ev  •    er       to    shine,  to    shine;  Where  the 

-A-       -A-       -A-       -A-       -A-         -A- 


_5 is~  ~|^;*|g     [*     is— ^|gr 

=p=pz:Ep.z=:p=p— p— 1£ 


* 


-« — j — ♦ — 4— ♦-  - 


±zr=2=izz:: 
:•=— pz— p=z: 

-a *! a! 


=t=p: 

f\  y 

> k — k fc — -* ►" 5—    -    - 

"P— p—  p— p— P P — 

land  there's  man-  y    beau-  ti  -  ful  man-sions,]ove-  ly    man-sions,  And      I 
bap- py    day    I    sure-ly    will   join  them,I      will    jointhem,  And  their 
saints  a  crown  of    glo  -ry     is    giv  -  en, crown  is     giv  -  en,    And     I 


ifeS=S 


-a- 

4E: 


V- 


SUi A A A A A. 


:£=p: 


£=0 


k — k — k- 


fc£=& 


Chorus. 


Se*E3EE3ee£ 


*=: 


-A- 

c 

tru  -  ly  know 
song  of  joy 
sure  -  ly     know 


-A- 

P 

that    one    shall 
will    ev    -  er 
that  one    shall 


â– *â–  


-r>  1 1  '  n~~ — ■ r* * •- " 


be   mine,  be  mine. Some  hap 
be   mine,  be  mine, 
be  mine,  be  mine. 

gk r»l j e — r— 

-  —Fa A-p: 


py 


-*s= 


£=tz: 


zazz  ^=±=±=^=5=g= 


n — n--r> — ! — ~ r~ — 


yt — :{5_=f5-45_:t5-2f_g : 


■-p— D' 


day,  some  gold    -    en  morn-ing, 

Some  hap-py  day,  and  free  from  care, 

-A-     -A-     -A-    Um 


I'm  so    -    ing 


V      V      v    ~'V 
Copyright,  19  48,  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory." 


We'll  Sing  the  Glory  Song 


there        and 
There 


join        that    throng; 


b 


In    our  beau-ti  -  ful 


and        join      that  throng ,the  blood-washed  throng; 

3t  L 


-h— J 


robes  anderonns  with    a  -  dorn-ing, 

In  our  beau- ti -ful  robes  so  love-  ly  and   fair. 

„*__     _a_     —a...     _a_       a  _     _a.  -^-       -A-      -A-      -A-      -A- 


cvjtlsj S S is J£ IS 


:jj-tf=£— tfc=?=R 


All  to-geth-er,we'll  sing  the  glo        -       ry  song. 

We'll  sing  the  glad  hap-  py  glo-  ry  song. 


te^g^^^BE^ 


=t2=U- 


E=b=^=P=P=t=' 


No.  85. 

Isaac  watts. 


Arlington 


•f>— fc 


te£ 


Thomas  A.  Arne. 


f* 


-A-- 


^i=d=^ 


1.  Am      I        a      sol-dier  of      the  cross,    A      fol-'wer   of     the  Lamb, 

2.  Must    I       be    car-ried  to      the    skies  On    flow-'ry  beds     of  ease, 

3.  Are  there    no    foes   for  me     to    face?  Must  I     not  stem   the  flood? 

4.  Sure     I     must  fight,  If  I    would  reign;  In-crease  my  cour  -  age,  Lord! 

X       3L      4-  .           .           -         -*-       -*-      -f-      -*-       A  ^L 


£ 


-*- 


-» — e- 


V=& 


^^ 


-y- 


££ 


i 


#=fc 


« 


3 


i 


name? 

seas? 

God? 
Word. 

4*- 


And   shall     I      fear  to      own  His  cause,  Or   blush    to   speak  His 

WThile  oth  -  ers  fought  to      win  the  prize,  And  sailed  thro'  blood  -  y 

Is       this    vile  world  a    friend  to  grace,  To    help    me     on     to 

I'll    bear    the    toil,  en  -  dure  the   pain,  Sup  -  port  -  ed     by    Thy 


g=# 


m 


No.  86. 

D.  H. 


£=2=i: 


My  Saviour  Will  Lead  Me 

David  Huntley 


F=«^-te=i^tz4s 


x  i 

1.  When  my  work 

2.  When  tbe  shades 

3.  When  I've  crossed 


♦•     ♦      -»■* — «~ *— c# — p — tr 


on  earth  is  end-  ed,  work  is  end-ed, 
of  night  are  fall  -  ing, shades  are  fall  -  ing, 
the      si  -  lent    riv  -   er,     si  -  lent  riv  •  er, 

_■£_■  S" 


And    the     sun 
And     I'm   wait 
In    -    to     that 


is  sink  -  ing 
ing  for  the 
sweet  home    a 

_-K £J 

—  k tt k- 


v       v      v.     ,1/ .     i 
low,     is      sink  -  ing     low; 
call,    my     Sav  -iour's  call; 
bove,  sweet  home    a  -  bove; 


:p=p: 


-« - L •     -w 1 

\»  -#-        -*-       -*-  ^        -♦- 


-7* 


"P — P" 


p 


I  will .  have 
I  will  have 
1     will    sing 


M 


~l- 


a  hand  to  lead  me,  hand  to  lead  me 
the  sweet  as  -  sur  -ance, sweet  as  -  sur-  ance 
the  praise   of      Je  -  sus, praise    of     Je  -  sus 

— * i-A -I A W & "t 1 

z^zzz^ziii— :FtE=zji — g — £=—   - 
y     y      y      i/      i/      P 


£ *f r p 


In  the  way 
That  He'll  lead 
For    His       ev 

•-      -•- 

-\—      -i— 


y  y  w        y 

that      I      should   go,  that  I      should  go. 

me    thru      it       all,  yes,  thru     it       all. 

er  -    last  -  ing      love,  His  last  -  ing      love 


2^ig=rzzz=fct===t=r=?==r!!===iz==a=: 


>-      ■♦-      -*- 

— i — 


^ 


-  Chorus.       | 
3H3-Z1 .  __t_ 


n   i? 


JC* 


3d — at — a!— 


2* 


— p — 5 — p— p — p— 
Yes,    my  Lord  will    sure-ly     lead    me, 

Yes,    my  Lord  will    sure-ly    lead    me,     He    will    lead   me, 


-*— F— I 


W P 6 K-— , 

=— ^=rpz=pz— pz=J 
z=b=b=z==J 


P=p: 

Copyright,  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory." 


te£E?=E=!i 


My  Saviour  Will  Lead  Me 

f 


tp p p ! 1 — _"j C3i — g 


t  t 


1 


Lead   me     by  His    hand    of      love; 

Lead    me      by      His,  hand    of      love,  His    hand     of     love; 


,gtoF=3 


:t: 


—  A rA A . m A— -J 

rrfc— Er      L     i — f^=l 


Till     I 


â– *-      p 

the  chill  -  y      riv 


f 

cross  the  chill  -  y     riv  -    er, 

Till     I     cross    the  chill  -  y      riv  -    er,   chill  -  y      riv   -  er, 


:k±zt 


And 


IS 


reach 

And 

•- 

-t— 

— t-* — 


He 


my    home    a  -    bove. 
reach  my    home    a  -    bove,  my    home    a  -    bove. 
-■»-  -»-       .  IV:      ft        IS     .   r\       j 

_Jr 2-__4r t-_r*: :*h_j*l_j!* 


:t2=l 


P 


No.  87 

E.   A.   H. 


Enough  for  Me 


Rev.  E.  A.  Hoffman. 

— h- 


a 


*=* 


3=3 


£8 


=£=* 


knowledge! 
â–   va  -  tion! 
pre  -  cious, 


love    sur  • 
won  -  der 
3.  0    blood    of 


pass  â–   ing 
-  M  sal 
Christ,  so 


IE 


0    grace, 
From    sin 
Poured  out 


so  full  and 
He  makes  me 
on    Cal   •  va  ■ 

•f-    4-    4- 


free! 
free  I 


£ 


« 


4^ 


v^- 


M- 


CTio.  And  that's  e  •  nough  for    me, 


0     that's    e  •  nough  for 


HW-i   1  J.    £    ± 
1    t    I  J-    2 — i- 


me; 
Z).C. 


I 


F 


« 


know  that 
feel  the 
feel     its 


Je  -  sus 

sweet     as 

cleansing 


% 


saves  me, 
•  sur  -  ance, 
pow   â–    er, 


And  that's 
And  that's 
And    that's 


e  -  nough  for 
e  -  nough  for 
e  -  nough  for 


me. 
me- 
me. 


r    r  T- 


^=F 


£ 


:[_:: 


p: 


I      know  that     Je  -  sus      saves  me,     And    that's    e    -  nough  for    me. 


No.  88         Glory,  Hallelujah, 

R.  B.  and  A.  M.  P. 


I  Am  Saved 

Ranee  Barkley 


?rz~~ft — h~r^~~^~^ — k — I ft — ft~r~K — ;: — 


1.  Once  when   I    was   lost    in    sin,    had       no 

2.  As        I  walked  that  down-ward  road    try    -ing 

3.  I'm    so    glad    to    me     Hecame,glo  -    ry 

IS  ft  .0.  .0.  .0. 

c— x — K— a — r<* * — ♦ — ♦ 1 1 1 

f-i^-* y&-+&- — -& -A A -14  A  A— 

^4^ ^45 — g — g— £—  ^=P P  - 


hope      of    heav'n  with  -  in-, 
hard      to    bear      my   load, 
to      His  .    Ho  -    !y    name, 


h ►  — •- 


A 


\=j=.n=±=& 


ures  of    this    world   that    can- 

be-neath  the    heav    -  y    weight 

the    jor    the    world  could  nev  - 

9- 


not      last,  can  -  not  last; 

of      care, weight  of  care; 

er      give,  nev  -    er  give. 

■»-      -»-     ?v  -•- 


Then  I  sought  the  Sav-iour's  face. trust  -  ed 
Then  I  heard  my  Sav-iour's  plea,  say  -  ing 
Now    I'mprais-ing  Him   for      love     and    the 

ft 


Him  for  love    and    grace, 

leave  it  all       to      me, 

hope  of  heav'n    a  -  bove, 

l\  _.        -A-       -A- 


tt 


3EEE 


:p==t= 


blot-  ted  out  my 
on  the  Lord  and 
Him  and    loved  ones 


f — K«" 


9V- 

sin 

left 

1 


ful 
it 


past,  sin 
there, left 


shall    live,    I 


P        ■•- 

-  ful      past. 

it    there. 

shall    live. 


v       9        n 


-■&.-• 


:t=: 


Chorus 


tA=t=i-tFszzl==:S-4=ii=^=§5=i=I^^==^^==5--r:3 
p      p  ■      -•-  -r  --»- 

Glo  -  ry,  hal-  le  -  lu  -jah.Je  -sus  came,took  a  -way  my  guilt    of    sin    and  shame, 


t-ty 


â–º K_ 


b. — «, — k— r*- — i ft — * — i 1 — i»k — i ,♦— rf- . — p> p — i 


".t/r — b*  —  b1- 

Copyright,  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory." 


Glory.  Hallelujah,  1  Am  Saved 


p  ■*■   ■  -••        i     \j     ''/     r 

Giv  -  ing    me   the    joy  andpeaoethat    I      so    long  had  craved,!     had  craved; 

-A-    -A-     -A-     -A-     -A- 

^=*=r£=k=E?=*=  a=a— S== 5—  g=fc=p=t===£=l 


.^-K-^- 


Now    I    want  to  sing  and  shout  His  praise  as     I    trav-el    here,thru  all    my  days, 

_A-  -A-  -A-  -A. 

_— -■-      ■»■      -m-     -|—     -•-     -("     -f -h-     -g-    QK -0- (   _ . ^ 

■g.— ^A —  A^A  — A— Pi A A A A A A A A— Pi A L__ — _A 1 

^p^=^=g=g=te=s=^=g:==^=g=g=g=fc=fc===i;=fc=:l 

—  ."i r: _ — z. — \-i n z. z. z. c r. z. — t  u a — lj m 1 — _J 


--P— £_* 


/RP-R  - — ^ — «P — ^— PS— id — is — fc — S^-sr* — s — =*-r — > 

fig— ap— g — | — »— P*— g» — P — n — S— gg — g — 1— Fxt^ 

B    -3-     d  â–   P  â–   â– **  v     r     P      P     -#- 

I  -    y.  .-   /    .   t 

Sing  and  tell     it     to     the  whole  wide  world  that    I      am  saved,  I      am  saved. 

Ut A A A A HA A A A A 1 1 \-t&- 


tp — tr~  la- 


No.  89.  Jesus,  Saviour,  Pilot  Me 

Rev.  Edward  Hopper 


Â¥ 


Wr=*E 


-4=* 


A-- 


*= 


a: 


l-r4 


:^: 


H 1 \—+- 


J.  E.  Gould 

.  PINE 


si 


■^r— ♦' f 

1.  Je  -  sus,  Sav-iour,   pi  -  lot  me,     0  -  ver  life's  tem- pest- eous    sea; 

2.  As        a    moth-er    stills  her  child,  Thou  canst  hush  the      o  -  cean  wild; 

3.  When  at     last      I     near  the  shore,  And  the    fear-ful  break-ers    roar; 


r— p— e-l-i 

D.C.Chartand  com- pass  come  from  Thee,  Je  -  sus,  Sav-iour,  pi  -  lot  me. 
D. C. Wondrous  Sov'reign  of  the  sea,  Je  -  sus,  Sav-iour,  pi  -  lot  me. 
D.C.May     I     hear  Thee  say     to      me, "Fear  not,    I 

*— JhH : f= r-r-l -P— fc-H 

2 — ITS. 


Will 


2 ^ ^ — L^ •fc. 


■z\ P — Sic 


pi  -  lot  thee." 

D.  o. 


T^tT 


^-^ 


it 


:=]: 


^^=^=^=t=^^ii 


pp. 

Unknown  waves  be -fore  me    roll,         Hid -ing  rocks  and  treach'rousshoall 
Boist 'rous waves o  -bey  Thy    will,      When Thousayst  to  them"Be  still!" 
'Twist  me  and  the  peace-ful    rest,      Then  while lean-ing   on    Thy  breast, 

— P*^ — » — i • — »- — » — P»- 


l-^N 


=^=[:t=^= p=p=|:==- 


:e=I:£=: 


No.  90. 

W.  B.  W. 

02-~* ' 


Sing  Out  The  Story 


W.  B.  Walbert 


Sfe± 


^-f—^.- 


—.--ti — 1- 


—I- 


:3=P==£: 


-• — ^ * — 4 


:^: 


1.  Sin? 

2.  Sing 

3.  Sing 


ry, 

ual, 

ry, 


out  the  bless-  ed  sto  -  ry,  how  Je  -  sus  came  from  gio 
of  His  love  e  -  ter  -  rial,  com  -ing  from  realms  su  -  per 
hal  -  le  -    lu  -  jah,  glo  -  ry,  tell     out    the  Grand  Old      Sto 

-A-        -4-        -4-        -A-        -A-  -A-        -A-  -A-  -A-        -Ar 

^=^z=z^zzzi£zzzgzzbs=z:Sz=:^i=ZA &  — -  •  fc Is. 

i y — b1 — v — y — y — Ly — i y — y — y y y 

j K ! 1 


t| +* — *; a — r^ 

it      o'er    land    and     sea,    o'er   land    and 
to      the      fall    -  en      race,    to       all      the 


o   -  ver      sea; 

fall  -  en       race; 

Him  your    Lord   and    King,  your  bless  -  ed    Lord   and     King; 


iS=! 


XL* 


:^=£=^=?-±=Fs 


.SI ID. 


-4=1= 


b= 


Sing  of  His  great  sal  -  va  -tion,  for  ev  -  'ry  tribe  and  na  -  tion, 
Ban  -  ish  -  ing  gloom  and  sad -ness, bring- ing  great  joy  and  glad- ness, 
Praise  His  great  name  for  -  ev  -  er.    love    and       a    -  dore    Him     ev    -  er, 

-A-        -A-        -A-        -A-        -A-  -A-  -A-  -&-  -A-  4^ 

^;=:czzre==±:=:r:zz:u:zztzzz±:— parjzzp  —  c. ^-^.[z-^zc-zzr:  ~ 

£Zis       |s       |s       te       |s       fc       It     rfr       Is        ft        ft~~~~fc        a        fr~ 
— y 1 y y y y — y — L^ ' V — V V y y — 


Chorus. 


v  -     u        j       v       v 

Pur  -  chased  on     Cal  -    va  -    ry,      on      Cal  -  va  -  ry. 

All      thru     His   match-less  Grace,  His    match-less  Grace. 

High-  est      ho  -  san  -  nas    sing,    ho  -  san  -  nas  sing. 

"  Err^r 


-P- 


F£: 


Oh,    broth-  er, 


V      V    •   P.      ' 
Sing,  sing, 

Sing   out  the   won-drous sto  •  rv,  praise  Him, 

P    '  I 
hi  h     P>     h     h     h  2:   :*: 


the  King   of      glo  -  ry, 


*_A 

~  I- 


— •- 
I 

the 


•■ — *— B ai— r 

igznzzzr  F, 

-I f cl 


.,* 


-h 


i 
sing  tiie  sto      -      ry,         praise        His  glo      -       ry, 

Copyright,  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  G/ory." 


•j  Er 


Sing  Out  The  Story 


;j — FS-- 


Je  -   sus,  your  Lord     a   -  dore,  your   bless  -  ed    Lord     a   -  dore; 

i 
.*.  -4.  .p.       XL* 

â–  I | .__ X* 


-TVI 


— * ■ » —  -p—-n—. — r w — 


u 


K— ♦ — 

Sing, 
Sing    of 


:z± 


--I- 


V 


V 


£=£= 


His  great  sal  -  va  -tion,bro't  to 

hi          ^    \^    h    [)    ^  ±  -A 
fiir~* — * — M — g — * — *~r       


each  tribe  and    na  -  tion, 


|> 


_2.       ^,. 


Sing 


sal 


tion 


to 

-A- 


each 


tion, 


•J    i) 
Praise 


g g 1 F; • s; i- — c 


Him 


for 

rip. 


i3V 


er 


_j4- -*• 


*=~F— p: 


more,  praise     Him 


:*- 


-^A 


_«t^'_ 


No.  91. 


There  is  a  Fountain 


William  Cowper. 


Western  Melody. 


fee 


ffi£ 


-fi: 


fe 


S^SgiSS^i 


n 


. — LL_] La. 


* 


:lV 


3EZ 


1.  There  is  a  fountain  filled  with  blood  Drawn  from  Im-manuei's  vein's,  And  sinners,  plunged  beneath  that  flood, 

2.  The  dying  thief  rejoiced  to  see  That  fountain  in  his  day ;  And  there  may  I,  tho'  vile  as  he, 

3.  Dear  dying  Lamb!  Thy  precious  blood  Shall  never  lose  its  pow'r ,  Till  all  the  ransomed  church  of  God 

4.  Then  in  a  nobler,  sweeter  song,  I'll  sing  Thy  pow'r  to  save,  When  this  poor  lisping  stamm'ring  tongue 

A-  **•      ir*i  -A' -Mr  -A-     .¥*      I 

0  ]. 


J^    A'  A-  -A?  ~A-   i. .  A- -A-      **  -A*-JL- -A-     tut       I       #*l  -*-1-*- -A-  -A-       -A-  -*- 
^,  *     ,         Fine.    ^  K    ,  , — ,  n.  S. 


n      -—  ^     -         Fine.    ^,  ^    .  ^ N 

p-^~T^    ^ ;  f  ^F-*^ *f  . *      fT~^  ^ y  t  '. fU 


=jz: 


E 


Lose  all  their  guilty  stains.  Lose  all  theirguilty  stains,  Lose  all  theirguilty  stains, 
Wash  all  my  sins  a -way,  Wash  all  my  sins  a -way,  Wash  all  my  sins  a -way, 
Be  saved  to  sin  nomore.  Be  saved  to  sin  no  more,  Be  saved  to  sin  no  more, 
Lies     si -lent  in  thegrave.Lies  si -lent  in  the  grave,  Lies  si -lent  in  the  grave, 


# 


t^PFf 


-r- 


e-firr 


SE 


No.  92. 

J.  B.  H. 


!  Want  to  Go  Home 


Jesse  B,  Hardin 


1.  So     of-ten    I  think  of  heaven  a-bove  where  dwelleth  the  saints  and  those  that  I  love, 

2.  The  Saviour  has  gone  a  place  to  prepare  for  all  the  redeemed  His  gio  -ry   to  share-, 

3.  The  riv-er  of  life    is  flowing  near  by , and  there  we  shall  live  and  nev-er-more  die, 

A — A — A — ft— 4- 


___ — a — •>• — — — — — — ... 


-A— A— A 


—A— A— A- 

-*- 


$=P 


irr^-trtrlrt^nrnra-^-tJ-p-T? 


Eg3 


=£=£= 


gfcfeg: 


^3=* 


zzE^-^-*-*-^=:g=g=fc^=Frj===-_—  z=zg=1 

^       I  U    I)  ITTb 


± 


I  want  to  go  there,  that  Cit 

I  want  to  go  there  that  Cit 

1 A— A— A— A— a„_a_ 

:S— i— i— tk— A~*  ~ 


— < — * — a — a — a — a — h — n — ~ — - 

— p— 0— ^— D~D-  ^ — P — t? — 1> 


U    U    0 

y    to  view; 

y    to  view, that  Cit -y    to  view! 

*E^EEEE=fe?!EE3 


â– ^-^y-^-r-rr-fV-E 


to) ahfe" — «|— ■-}— < 1 — H — ri— B 1 1 — ■#-«-* — w—  r- i — *s — H — ™ ' — d — l 

W |n?^ — J — ^_L$,_gJ._,_|_^  _^~^j_ai|*, — S— l^ — « — n — si — 3, — g, — J 

Its  walls  are  of  jasper,streets  of  pure  erold  and  all  is    so  love  -  ly  there  to   be-hold, 
They  say  that  we'll  know  as  we  shall  be  known  and  worship  the  Lord  around  the  white  throne, 
I'mread-y    to  go, it  can-not  be  long  till  I  shall  go  there  and  join  the  glad  song, 

r\ 

__ — A— A—A— A— A — A—, a — A — A- 


SH3=§^tt=£=fc  ': 


V  u" 


-A — A — A  — * — tA A— HA — h — ri — V — ** 1 


S£ 


•J 


»ff 


m 


-IA — A- 

-4^ — fe— fe — D— J^ — &— ±~p  r-j, 

♦ * * * : * — T^J-r-rl- 


£=*=£=* 


A— ft— Ai_, 


L?5l- 


^-J 


I    want  to    go  there, 


:^=P 


oh,yes,  I    do. 
I    want  to  go  there,oh,yes,  I    do, 

r>  ft  ^  S  i    h 

0 #- 


oh,  yes,       I  do. 


#: 


--&=£ 


r^—gzt^: 


m 


ill 


-P" 


Chorus 


u  p  P  u     i  r- : ^ 

I  want  to  go  there,  I  want  to  go  there, 

I  want  to  go  there,  I  want  to  go  there, 

_A A . A. 


ggi-s— ~g 


-A_A— A- 

:E=^=—=-=t:=q-g 

-I* — & — A — A — |A ! — *2 


:3^, 


jHF 


A » A— J 


Copyright  1948  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher,  in  "gospel  glory. ' 


I  Want  to  Go  Home 

u  p  B  tr     i  ET&  B  0  w  -,u 

And  live  ia  that  land  with  all    of  the  true; 

And  live  in  that  laud  with  all    of  the  true, the  good  and  the  true; 

._   A— A— A— A— A— A— = * — A-rS — g— ft— f — ft — R-n 

1 — 14 — 14 — 14 — 14 — 4 — n_ 


e 


^H 


.;fe=i 


— e 


1 


To  be  with  my  friends  and  loved  ones  of  old  will  sure-ly   for   me,  be    glo-ry   un-told, 

7+ — ■ — 0 — P-Fh— •— ^ — • — P — - — f-~^- — i — ^— Ph — •— -  B--*--         — 1 

E^E^E^E3E^E^prziE^^=S^El=g=0 


Rrl — £  Er— * — * — • — * — : — «i — •?-•!- 

&=^=^»EEq^i 


3=3 


>« 


^$ 


'Bh 


^~ 


I    want  to    go  there, 


oh, yes,  I    do. 


I    want  to  gothere,oh,yes,  I    do,    oh,  yes,       I  do. 

r>  &  ^  h  .    h 


Bfe 


*I_aI 


:p=d=t?=t2=U=t2=S=5Zf:e-! 


EEEi3EgEg=i= 


No.  93. 


America 


Samuel  Francis  smith 


Henry  Carey 


^J^S±^*=» 


3* 


1.  My  country 'tis   of -thee, Sweet  land  of    lib-er-ty,  Of  thee   I    sing;  Land  where  my 

2.  My  native  country  thee,Landof  the  no-blefree,ThynameI   love;  I  love  thy 

3.  Let  mu-sic  swell  the  breeze,  And  ring  from  all  the  trees,  Sweet  free-dom's  song;  Let  mortal 

4.  Our  Fa-ther's  God!  to  thee,  Author    of    lib-er-ty,  To  Thee  we  sing;  Long  may  our 

T-  i-i^rrf*     *ff"    '*■'— 


p^^-t- 


fa  -  thers  died, Land  of  the  Pilgrim's  pride,  From  ev  -  'ry  mountain  side  Let  freedom  ring. 
rock8andrills,Thywoodsandtem-pledhills,Myheartwith  rap-ture  thrills  Like  that  a-bove. 
tongues  awake, Let  all  that  breathe  partake,Let  rocks  their  si-lence  break,  The  sound  prolong, 
land  be  bright  With  freedom's  ho -ly  light,  Protect  us     by  Thy  might,  Great  God, our  King. 


-0^-m-  -m-  -#-  -»■  -•-  -•--•-  ■•-  -•-  — 

^         ^x\ — P cl — \?-\-c- 


iJ^d^J^k 


lliiBllI 


No.  94. 

Rev.  G.  C.  Morris 


The  Tree  of  Life 


$=*=^=*=i?. 


William  R.  Wallace 

ts=z 


6(5 = — lh ■ — 5 a        5—  J 


1.  There's  a    Tree     in    heav  -en's  gar  -  den  where  the  wea  -  ry  find  sweet  rest, 

2.  Man- y      wea  -  ry      foot-sore  tray  -'lers  come  from  dust-y    lands   a  •  far, 

3.  Yes,  the  Tree      of    Life      is   stand-  ms     in    the    par-  a  -  dise    of    God, 

*       -k-      -*-       •        •       -fc*       *       -a-    -'-      »      -*-     -k-     -fc-    -fe-      * 
^•tez|zzi£z=riz=:S:=:S==S==s^=:s==!s=i:S=Ft:=:t==u--t=:^=:i 

—* C — — CtP — t? — t? — IP 


} 


) — 4 " — H 


45— t- 


;£=# 


=±: 


.• j. 


.j    a— *—  u» |  — 

And    the     shad-  ow       of  its  branch-  es  nev  -    er  fade; 

Some  are    bleed  -  ing  from  the  bruis  -  es  on        the  way; 

'Tis        a      bless  -  ed  place  of  rest      which  He    hath  made; 

h  -k,                  .«.  .«.        .«.  jt/' 

n — Fb — rh b b b b h— b — R»— 


:y: 


fez_-£. 


Si--, 


:— ?— J*-  -t I1 ^ 


h 


* — i — i — 

£ A A! i 


:i- 


-A 5A-1-A— 


:^=3=«zi:hZzJ 

-A1 A! A A-— j 


And  there    is       a  wel  -  come  wait- ing    for    the    faith-ful    and  the    blest, 

But    we      see    this  tree    up  -  lift  -    ed    like      a      love  -  ly   bea-con   star, 

It        will  shel  -  ter  all     the     pil  -  grims  who   the  long  rough  way  have  trod, 

.9.  .  -  -W-  -»-        -f>-        -k-  ^         *        -K.        A        .^ 


m-p — ■— F# 

1 U- 1 

] — * * — -r* 


z£=*EE3E=JE 


£3£ 


sft  g-     >— rig— ^-pg g a— ^— g a— ^ST-r^-^— I — -*-—*-—. 


In        the  shel  -  ter        of 
And   its      shad  -  ow    there 
And  there's  room  for     ev    â–  


bz=£-H» 


■_  r£- 

0- 

n: 


-I is 


a. 

zzsz 


its  love  -  ly 
will  mean  e 
'ry     Chris  -  tian 

_k- ^ --- -*- -k-_ 

— »zzrzHZz:_t — z#zz_i: 
:=^==t2=z^zz:=pz=p: 


cool 
ter 
in 


i 
ing      shade, 
nal      day. 
its     shade. 


m 


Chorus 


==^  x_  k_^  .__ft|rl_3: 

ILi — J-i— # — # — Fs 


1    ** 

The  Tree   of   Life 


i 


is    wait  -ing  there, 
The  Tree  of  Life  is    wait  -  ing  there, 


.«.    .#.     rrt-    #. 

:|s a a a: 

:p=:pzzT2— b.; 


==F==£: 


■=1— S 


=fe 


Copyright, 1948, by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher  in  "Gospel  Glory.' 


**=**£=£ 


The  Tree  of  Life 


time,  the 


V      v        d 
sands   of  time; 


com-pare, 


-A A g M M A y— 


J    5    u    u 

the      ev  -  er-  last-  ing  Tree     of    Life    sub  -  lime,  of.  life     sub- lime. 

.  is-    i\      in  ';js      i 

-F- -k- 4, 4I -^-         -^-  4. 

:^Ep=p=p=t=»=-=»=*EE;=EEEEEEEEE 
— c ^ — £ — 5 — 5 — fc>— s*- ^-- 


No.  95. 

Charlotte  Elliott. 


Just  As  I  Am 


Wm,  B.  Bradbury. 


1.  Just 

2.  Just 

3.  Just 

4.  Just 

5.  Just 


as    I    am!    with-out     one  plea,  But  that  Thy  blood  was  shed  for  me, 


as 
as 


5 


fcfi 


Fa= 


a. « ft 


am!  and  wait  -  ing  not,  To  rid       my  soul  of  one  dark  blot, 

am!  tho' toss'd  a-bout.  With  many  a  conflict  many  a  doubt, 

am!  poor  wretched  blind,  Sight,  rich  -es,  heal-ing  of  the  mind, 

am!  Thou  wilt     receive,  Wilt  welcome,  pardon,  cleanse,  relieve; 


k'  w 


M 


m *-s-La — * s— *- 


And  that  Thoubidd'st  me  come  to  Thee,  0  Lamb  of  God! 
To  Thee  whose  blood  can  cleanse  each  spot ,  0  Lamb  of  God ! 
With  fears  with-in  and  foes  with-out,  0  Lamb  of  God! 
Yea,  all  I  need  in  Thee  to  find,  0  Lamb  of  God! 
Be  -  cause  Thy  prom -ise    I    be-lieve,  0  Lamb  of  God! 

A      -   .  I  -p-  -•--* 


I  come!  I  come! 
I  come!  I  come! 
I  come!  I  come! 
1  come!  I  come! 
I  come!  I  come! 


No.  96. 

Charles  H.  Huff 


That  Wonderful  Day 

H4 Mr-£- 


Doyle  Hawkins 


EH££3E£££5 


£*= 


=t 


L^i- 


i, 

2. 
3. 


When  the  Sav-iour  comes  for  ussomewon-der-ful  day, some  e  -  ter  -  nal  day, 
I  am  look-ing  on  a-head  His  glo-  ry  to  see,glo-ry  light  to  see, 
When  we  land  up -on   the  shore  of  flo-  ry  land  fair,  of  that  land   so  fair, 

h    b     rH-T    ^    "\ 
a      S     ,-JL  * «_ 


«_„ k, ^ c «!_,.« € 


0 0 <a -Jrf 


M        V         â–          |f         p 

We  will  sail  a -way  with  Him  for-ev-er  to  stay,  with 
Look-ing  for  the  day  when  lle'll  be  com-ing  for  me,  com 
And  we  look  up -on  the  face  of  Je  -  sus  up  there,  on 
s — k-  r*_(«_«_ttt_e —  — |  — « — «—  r* — «- 


+Hr« — • —  f  -  -"— g — " — fig  —  ? — ESz: 


9  .«-        -B-  f 

^     I)     b     I 

the  Lord  to  stay: 
â– ing  down  for  me; 
His   face   up  there, 

-«— gk — k — M-i 


v       -i-    "  -     -      - 

And  we'llride  up  -on    a  cloud  so  won-drous-ly    fair, won- der -ful  and  fair, 
It       will  be     a   hap-py  day  and  won-drous-ly  sweet,  it  will    all    be  sweet, 
We     will  sing  a -loud  His  prais-es  with  that  glad  band, with  thai  hap-py  band, 

-A-     -A-     -A-     -A-     -A-     -A-     -A-     -A-        *-      -A-      -A-        A-        A-        A-        A- 


Hi a ' r1 r^ 1 1 — 1 5K K \& r«* »s as «i "*■ 


--& 


f» 


We'll  be  go -ing  home  with  Him.  His  glo -ry  to  share, glo 
Jnst  to  know  our  friends, and  all  our  loved  ones  to  meet,  all 
Glo  -  rv,  glo  -  ry   hal-Ie  -  lu  -  jah,  it  will     be  grand,  it 

£  t  -±  -  a r^fc 

Chorus.  I       Is)      ft 


-a-    -I—    -t—    -h- 


--  k — k— r 


-MH 

V9 

-H- 

b 

\) 

\) 

[) 

-  rv 

love 

tosh 

are. 

our 

dear  ones  meet. 

will 

all 

be  grand. 

R 

0 

h 

h 

— =*— 

-=n — 

-«r- 

iEE 

—~ 

-*— 
Zt3— 

Oh,  glo-  ry     to    God,  He's  com-ing 

To  our  God, 


gam, 


yes,    a  -gam, 


|ggE=i — EEEip — p— g:===j 


Copyright  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory." 


That  Wonderful  Day 

&z^:iz=3==:z:b~z=:=zz:j=:3=^: 


now  pro-claim; 


rap  -ture  with  Him 

^ «M 


There  with  Him 


for  -  ev 


we  shall  reisn, 


In 

1_J 

§3e£e£ 

-fl — r — i — f>— 1>— *— &- 

^g-3— g h «— ^— ^— w~  ~- 


-h- — 


er  we'll  reign, 

i 

_rq iL 

r  j jE . 


<3=p 

i 

-7^1  — 


l/— W  ^ 


k 


D    P 


-0— t?— f- 


Oh,  let   us  then  praise 
1     X 


§§?=§=! 


=5j 


Let   us  praise  His  won-der  -  f  ul  name. 

His  won-der  -  ful  name,  His  won-der  -  ful  same. 

r>  h  fi  b  h  i 


h 


JL 


tr- 


ft=: 


£=y: 


:» — •— rh — " 


No.  97. 

Mrs.  Margaret  M.  Kay 


& 


eE^£e^= 


1.  A-sleep  in 

2.  A-sleep  in 

3.  A-sleep  in 

4.  A-sleep  in 


Asleep  in  Jesus 


3t=* 


m 


^m 


W.  B.  Bradbury 
j    -    h      P 


m 


Je-suslbless-ed  sleep ,From  which none  ev  • 
Je-sus!  0  how  sweet,  To  be  for  such 
Je-sus I  peaceful  rest,  Whose  wak-ing    is 


I" 

er  wake  to  weep! 
a  elum-ber  meet! 
eu-preme-ly  blest! 


bliss- ful    ref-uge 


A  calm  and  un  -  dis-turbed  re-pose,  Un-brok-en    by    the  last    of    foes. 
Withho-ly  con  -  fi  -  dence  to    sing  That  death  has  lost  its    venomedsting. 
No  fear, no  woe, shall  dim  that  hourThat  man  -  i  -fests  the  Saviour's pow'r. 
Se-cure-ly  shall  my     ash  -  es    lie,  Wait- ing   the  summons  from  on  high. 


No.  98. 

D.  G. 


He's  Coming  Back  Again 


Darius  Green 


m. 


Wf: 


±-A 


ts==fr 


:=&= 


1.  When  Je-  sus    left 

2.  A    crown  of  thorns 

3.  He's  com-ing  back 


His  throne  on  high, 
was  on  His  head, 
some  glo  -  ry  day, 


^         -+~     -»•     -m       S-      -• 


m 


t-7. -s 1 * * A * A * £ — i-A * a x * — i 


To    this   old  earth 
His    side  was  pierced 
To    take    us    home 


gJEEHEE 


He  came  to    die; 
un  -  til     He   bled; 
with  Him  to    stay; 

f — F— P—F— F—  -y— .— -*--  4H» 

■       pi       »       *       *       *      i~-  9— 

p:z=pr-p:zzp==t;i=p:=z p~rA~:=zzi=zz 


He  paid  our  debt 
And  then  they  laid 
And  then  we'll  join 


and  rose    a  -  gain, 
Him  in    the    tomb, 
that  bloodwashed  throng, 


-gd 

AZ=5--t5= 

^—~=~=:^^-^±zcz\-i^s==z.z=rz^^ 

11 

— m- — a — h — r# p — tf_     ■ — i c# — # — ■ —  k — #_j 

- 

1 ! l-^!'                       ^     l>     l>     P     u 

And  went  back  home                                 to  live    and  reign. 

But    He     a  -  rose                                   and  broke  the  gloom. 

In    prais-ing  Him                                   thru    a  -  ges  long. 

Ii          P         â– -    -r-    -   J>   J?   J   J?  J? 

^ 

:^=p=*=p="=i^=»=p=^== = J 

£M— ~ 

^          ....  ^     ..< p..    ;/    i  A                              a—  J 

W-* 


Chorus. 

P r, 


ffiz- 


===zEi= 


-£- 


rg-B: 


i^: 


ffi 


He's  com-ing  back  just   as     He    said, 

He's  com-ing  back  just   as    He    said,  just   as   He  said, 

.0.      -0.  .0-      -BL      -0-     -P.       -0- 


3 — 5- 


-^- 


CoDyright.  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory," 


He's  Coming  Back  Again 

=^==s=^=:=:|=e»':z:::^= 


"— fH— UJ---    ■  .  ^^ — • — * L[;     m — tr  — b-  • 

To  wake  the  saint  -  ed  sleep- ing  dead; 


To  wake  the  saint- ed  sleep-ing   dead, the  sleep-ing  dead; 

£S_i^ Z C- u a a a 1 F P — Fu a ■ ■ »-] 

^  k      Pi      P\       i  -^—— ■ ~^  A      P\      is  i "~--_h 

EEg      ^    -=hV= r~    ■»— g — 1 ^— ^-P-.__ f-3 

•J  *  °      p      P      P  


And  then  we'll  rise  in      ju  -  bi  -  lee, 

And  then  we'll  rise   in      ju  -  bi  -  lee,  in     ju  -  bi  -  lee, 
-•-    -•-  -»-    -P-    -•-    -■-     ■•■ 

l_jr— t— ^--ia— Y— t'-ri.— E— iT— t: 
:  aj — p — p — g — p-  -p — P: 


3 — g- 


:Z-    t_  p_: r—  P— i-, 

EpBp=EEnE-B 


-45 


-r-J 


^-^=^=====r= 


===i=zt5=i-^=rt-^^= 


^ 


— =? 


:p=r_-^= 


esters 


s 


^     U  l> 
Go  home  and  with                                Him    ev  -  er     be. 

Go  home  and  with  Him    ev  -  er     be,  and  ev  -  er     be. 

...  ...  ...  _-.       ...    -     b  j\  j  £  J? 


frfr-5!—^ 


£=z--=g==£— 2=pz±£: 


No.  99. 

FAWCETT, 


Blest  Be  the  Tie 


Hans  Geurg  Nageli. 


^p~4-  2    r 


:fc 


te==* 


1 


-I a) f- 


&I= 


^ 


f* 


Ct 


1.  Blest  be 

2.  Be  -  fore 

3.  We  share 

4.  When  we 


the  tie 
our  Fa 
our  mu 


a  -  sun 


that 

ther's 

tual 

der 


'JTS 


mm 


f=I 


binds  Our  hearts 
throne  We  pour 
woes,  Our  mu 
part,    It  gives 

3ULL 


&- 


1$- 


t 


lj= 


=2= 

in    Chris    -    tian  love; 
our    ar    -    dentpray's; 
tual  bur    -    dens  bear; 
us     in    -    ward  pain; 

f  \h  ' 


m 


r 


==3tEIE3=tE3E 


3E 


â– fc- 


A- 


The  fel    â–  

Our  fears, 
And  oft  > 
But  we 


low-ship 
our  hopes, 
en    for 

shall  still 


of    kin  - 
our  aims 
each  oth 
be  joined 


r 


m 


£=P* 


dred  minds  Is   like 

are  one,  Our  com 

-    er  flows  The  sym    • 

in  heart,  And  hope 

J  rV 


to  that       a-bove. 

forts  and    our  cares. 

â–   pa-thiz  -  ingtear. 

to  meet»  a-gain. 


3= 


He 


p 


tz 


£=?£ 


y<r 


No.  100. 

B.  E.  D. 


I'll  Pray  My  Way  to  Heaven 

Bill  Edd  Dodson 


1    s 

1.  While  trav'ling  down 

2.  I        want  to     do 

3.  When  bowed  to  Him 


life's  rug-  ged  way, 
my  Lord's  command, 
in     earn-est  prayer, 


b^=y=g: 


SE 


$ 3 £- 


b±=tc 


Rt-=! — S- 


45=^=^=^5 


3=2*=* 


.J « ^ 3 ♦— -I 

a — ± — a — a  — ■ 


To  God  I  love 
While  go  -  ing  thru 
I      seem    to   lose 


£— *~ 


« 


to  kneel  and  pray; 
this  wea  -  ry  land; 
my    ev  -  'ry  care; 

1- -rs— 


V 


*=g 


^ 


Bgzzi-sBf =:====f=:gz  -p 


P    U 


§==1 

A— * 


It  helps  me  bear 
That's  why  I  talk 
He    lifts    me    up 


my  heav-  y  load, 
with  Him  each  day, 
and    helps  me  stand 


\>  u 


:E==t=2S=:ft=:i======p==s     h     h==§~-3 


"^  ~~3g- 


And  keeps  me   on 
When  I      be  -  fore 
On    high  -  er  ground 


the  up-ward  road. 
Him  hum  -bly  pray, 
while    hi    this  land. 


1  *  X)         P         P    ~ P"  17         I? 

Oh, yes,  I'lFpray  my  way     to    heav-en, 

Oh, yes,  I'll  pray  my  way     to    heav-en,  glo  -  ry     land, 


ggEEE 


— . fi — m — p. — ^__i 


A- 


^^=^=zts==!i==g=^=t=:E5==:ts=S=ris— t£=j 
=tC= t2=p={2=P==gEEt2=p=p=i:p=P=3 


Copyright,  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory." 


I'll  Pray  My  Way  to  Heaven 

W-21-* ~  M » » ♦ g  — ♦ ♦— rd W-1 

•j     '  '     ~  p     D     i;     P  ?     *    -■-    -■-    * 


I    want   to  meet 


ggEjjEg 


my  friends  up  there; 
I    want    to  meet  my  friends  up  tbere.my  friends  up  there; 


— « — »_# — p. — p — p — *    * — «_.^ — fc — # 

v  â–   y  u 

3 — L* ^=- »_J 

! *  A A 4-    â– * 


&4-i^ 


:*-—  1— 


"^         S  Q         P         p         p  y         v 

Oh, yes,   I'll  pray  -         my  way     to    heav-eu, 

Oh, yes,   I'll  pray  my  way     to     heav-en,  there  to  stand» 


S 


P-* 


k: 


—   -h 


L- p. * * «_ 


I 


~=fV 


=* 


-N- 
F= 


Bless  -    ed        Je   -  sus     hear 


e (B_ 

ls=— pc 


^ 


£: 


2fc 


P 


d£=*"- 


BtS 


b     u  : 

my       prayer. 

Lord,    hear    my      hum-  ble  prayer. 

r>    p    h    h  p 

F .  a) -^ * *  y    — 


!==F| 


£= 


No.  101. 


1 


SK—ft 


zfczat 


W=l 


ere  He  Leads 


f         $  V  V 

I  1.  I       can  hear  my   Sav-iour  call  -  ing,    I  can  hear  my  Sav-iour  call  -  ing, 

2.  I'll     go  with  Him  thru  the  gar  -  den,  I'll  go  with  Him  thru  the  gar -den, 

3.  He     will  give   me  grace  and  glo  -  ry,    He  will  give  me  grace  and  glo- ry,£, 
-&—   -p-    -P-    -#-    -0-     f. 

rfc — Ft b~. — h rl P^ 


fe£ 


-ftv- 


IEE 


£g 


-y- 


=£ 


*= 


-P- 


ip=N 


D    t     P    p"   i     u 

fol  -  low,  Where  He   leads  me      I      will    fol  -  low, 
ad  lib  D.  C.  for  Chords. 


Cho.  Where  He  leads    me 

If 


i 


±r 


^£ 


!*U 


will 


J 


±r 


4=£ 


-h- 


ZJ 


1/  y 

can  hear   my  Sav-iour  call -ing,  Take  thy  cross  and  fol-low,  fol -low  me. 

I'll    go  witn  Him  thru  the  gar  -  den,    I'll  go  with  Him,  with  Him  all  the  way. 

He   will  give   me  grace  and  glo  -  ry,    And  go  with  me,  with  me  all  the  way. 


I 


P-t> P— 


Â¥ 


fe 


-*— 


-*— 


*± 


zpzzfc^ 


&tn 


u    '      u~tr 0   p   b   P   i 

will    fol  -  low,    I'll    go    with  Him,  with  Him  all    the  wav. 


Where  He  leads  me      I 


No.  102. 

W.  B.  Walbert 


I've  Left  Old  Egypt 


:?=fcfe=5=i=5: 


John  M.  Dye 


1—1—* — 1- 


:g=* 


Efc—3,- 


tS**-- 


P  I 

to-  day, 
be-hind, 


ES  u  5  .5 

my  heart  a  song  of  praise  is  ring-ing  to  -  day,  is  ring-  ing 
have  left  old  E-gtpt  and  it's  gar-  lie  be  -hind, it's  gar  -  lie 
- 'ry  bridge  is  burned  be-bindme"praise  the  dear  Lprd,oh,praise  the  dear  Lord, 

â–  * m -_JP'         A _ A- 

-» — 9 — * — 0 — | p— * —  * — r! * ° £ — ~#: 

-A— Fa — * — A— a — * — a— B — E? — 0 — Fa a A pi f- 

~t?— Ct> — P — tP — tP  — t? — t? C,p— 1?~ ^— P 

:1-t«— ?—l—+— :*—  (       "       " 


-A ^— r— I- 


ifcfcfc 


? — - — ^. 


g=izF«==i!—^1-=:5=:«=l 


All    my  sins  have  been  for-giv-  en,    tak-  en 

NowI'm  feast-ing  on  fair  Canaan's  hon-  ey 

With  my  Sav-iour  now   I  walk  in     per-fect 

1       IN      IN      IS      Fs      A  v 

-A— 8-r-— -■—  d— ~— M— S — t 1- 


PUP 
a  -way, yes,  tak  -  en     a  -way; 
and  wine, it's   hon  -  ey  and  wine; 

ac-cord,    in    per  -feet    ac-cord; 

r\  I 

—m—rd A * A A *!_. 

-*-Fh— t— fc— £zz  »z=t=H 


•-to: 


-U— 


at 1 ™ A A  — 

g-z-t—izzi—i- 


-1—  hrf — i — »~ 


EEEzd 


And  my  heart  is  bub-blingo  -  ver,  riv-  ers  of  joy 
Where  the  gen-  tel  Zeph-yrs  blow  and  love-  li  -est  flow 
Un  -  der-neath  the  cleans-ing  tide  1    know  that  my  Lord 


_^_?a--^-_Jlz?l_:?-_^ 

g^~ p:b=p— p— p=p: 


-» — 


are  flood-ing  my  soul, 
ers  there  to  be-  hold, 
will  care  for  my  soul, 

d d A!__Ai_5__^_ 

P=p— p!=p— 9—p- 


H^A4AJ^ 


Fine 


— tt    Fsi A — » ■ A — A — A 


S=t 


â– tSJ 


I 


Oh.glo- ry  to  God!Oh,glo-ry  to  Godll'mhap- py  and  wholej'm  hap- py  and  whole. 
A  won-der-fulland,a  won-der-ful  land  of  beau-ties  un-told,of  beau-ties  un-told. 
Un-  til   I  shall  reach, un-til    I  shall  reach  the  hea?-  en  •  ly  goal, the  heav-en  -  ly  goal. 


e-^3 


:=!_£: 


h  h  fi  ^  J h  h 


To  sing  an 
Chorus. 


.-_ . v . >— ^-  -  -  ■.•pa 

re-joice,to  sing  and  re-joice  beneath  the  bright  dome,the  heav-en  -  ly  dome. 

h 


£=S==S 


V~ — % -^— ^_ 


* 


My    soul     is       re 


'*— gil: 

My    soul     is 
deemed, 


re  -  deemed, 
I'm 

i    J1 


hap  -  py     and 


ft 


R 


i 


s=* 


:z=r==-£: 


v 

CoDyright.  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory," 


I've  Left  Old  Egypt 


whole, 


I'm  hap  -py    and  whole  Sweet  bil  -lows  of     joy 


Sweet  bil -lows  of     joy 


â– k-    -k-     k- 

r  -F-  -E- 


-k-     -k-    -k- 


are    flood-  ing    my    soul; 


I 


* 


_â–  


No    long  -  er 


m 


are    flood-ing    my    soul,  are  flood ,  ing    my    soul; 

-k-        -k-         -»■- 

3— E 


fcz=fcz*= 


it: 


h 


I* 14 H 


dark-ness  now    1    roam, I'm  trav-  el  -  ing   the  road  to  "Home, sweet  Home," 

a R d & — I 


^_M?— *— f— ^— •— a— *-r^-*—  Ji_- s— £ 


■ — i — =-1 — i — i- 

— a £ a & & -a 


:fc: 


P" 


y    p    y 
No.  103. 

JOHN     NEWTON. 


D 


Amazing  Grace 


WM.   Walker. 


m 


ft 


3 


a 


^ 


a 


sr 


» 


15 


f 


:.- 


^ 


'1.  A  -    maz  -  ing  grace  how  sweet  the  sound,  That  saved  a  wretch  like     me; 
2. 'Twas  grace  that  taught  my  heart   to   fear.  And  grace  my     fears  re  -  lieved; 

3.  Thru  ma  -  ny     dan-gers,  toils,  and  snares,  I     have  al  -  read-y     come; 

4.  When  we've  been  there  ten  thousand  years,  Bright  shin-ing     as  the     sun; 

±afc. 


I         once  was    lost    but    now  I'm  found,  Was  blind  but 
How    pre-cious    did  that  grace   ap-pear,  The   hour    I 
'Tis  grace  that  brought  me    safe  thus  far,    And  grace  will 
We've  no  less   days   to    sing  God's  praise,  Than  when  we 


m 


now 
first 
lead 
first 


I     see. 
be-lieved. 
me  home, 
be  -  gun. 


m 


e 


2ZI 


~-t 


fF*F=g 


No.  104. 

W.  B.  Walbert 


When  We  Meet  Up  There 


J.  F.  Durden 


— a-F^—  i— ai— a!  — zi— 1— I  zzizzsjzzSzitf  zzJzzizz?zz2izJ 


1.  When  the  days  are  long  and  yon'ye  lost  your  song, and   the  way     is     dark  and  drear, 

2.  Oh,   it    will   be  sweet  man- y  friends  to  meet,   in  that  land    so    brightand  fair, 

»%-tkr-4k s*--ft & A ft 1* ft ft A A & — r-ft ft ; \ 1* 


\ 


fci=l=E*zz*_- 

Wheth-er  weal  or 
Nev  -  er-more  to 

-0       -»       -»        -# 

_w : 

— ♦ — v— 

woe.  as 
sigh, nev 

-•- 

izfezzftzzft: 

a  -  long  you 
•  er  -more  to 

-9        -0-     -9- 

-fz 

go. 

die, 

-•- 

zz^zzjfcpg: 

look   ye     up 
it     will    all 
-e      -9-     »- 

zszz3zz:|zziizl 

and  ney-  er  fear; 
be    glo  -  ry  there: 

-£_sfe     k_ £i_, 

W — ft ft— 1-1 I-- 

_z_p_ 

-1 & ft— 

-ft — 

_* A— P- 

_£  _  B g [ 3 

ZpZZpZZpZZiZZf 

v    y 

V      p 

P 

j-z^ij^^ 

izJzr^tizzalzza— izziz-Jzzizzizzizz±zEMzzJ:zzizzizzzzzJ 


Just     a -cross  the  way  is      a  bricht-er    day    for    the  ran-somed  sared  by  grace, 
There  we'll  shout  and  sing  prais-es  to    the  King,  while  the  cease-less    a  -  ges  roll, 

K  -A-      -*- 

R  .       -a-      -9-      ■•-     -•-      -9-  .»-      -9-      4-      -t 

& — 'ft-Hft — ft — ft.--  ±  ■   ft  —  ft — ft — ft — ft — ft— hft — * — ™ — ~n 
^ H-m — n — n-   ;--■■      A — n h n y H— rh n b > 


-9 


:gz-gzz|zz|zzgzgpzzg=^z-f: 


fee 


1=E-J 


fct 


-#c 


3-^: 


^zzzbzztejzzz 

Eizzlzz^zzfti 


-f) — ^ — 

r_p._^_.g=^z9z=i-z=pz:*zzfzzizzgzz? 

When  we  meet  up  there  in  that  (Jit  -  y    fair   and    be  -hold   our  Sav-iour's  face. 
When  we  meet  up  there  we'll  be  itee  from  care,  in  that  home-land   of    the  soul. 

c . . e — e — p — p — 9—W — v — & — b1 1 


Chorus. 


M — a — i* — 


JUU 


zjS-zft-ift — ^ — | zz 


When  we  meet  up  there  in  that  home  be-yond  the   sky, 

When  we  meet,     meet  up  there  star-ry    sky, 

-A-   -A-  h      f>      h 

■0-     -0-     -9-     -f—     -f-    -0-     -9-     -0*       .  )        M 

Copyright,  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory." 


When  We  Meet  Up  There 


g^EfeEE 


'-*- 


-sH-p— tp— t? 


Nev- er-more  to  roam,  nev-  er-more  to    say  good-by; 

Nev- er-more        sad- ly  roam,  to    say  good- by; 

â– PbJ 


25 C* S S i; A It A A A— f£ P— P F- 


Thereto    live  on  high  with  the  hap- py.glad  and   free, 

Sweet-ly  live        thereon  high  the    glad  and  free, 


0.    .0.   —   -i_    .m.    .0. 

—iw m 1 1 -I ' r  I 1 — 

fire — a — i, — a — I* — = — * — * — * — * — ifc— t-tfc- — a- 


£= 


*  -■ — ^T ■ — J^h-P— 


=, ty_£_£_3_ p 


"p— tr 


Safe 


£=£= 


3 — g — g— arr- 

^     V     9 
There  to  sing  and   re-joice  thru  the  long   e  -  ter-  ni  -  ty. 

There  to  sing  and  re-ioice  thru  the  lone,the  long  e  -  ter-ni  -ty. 

-*-  -*-"  â– *â–   *â–   -*-  p  ^  h 


fe 


-Z P fc.. 


K*-t- t-i:  -t-        . 

No.  105.  Give  Me  Oil  in  My  Lamp 

Unknown  Arr.  by  Adger  M.  Pace 


I 

•J 


JULJVi- m.  t 


4=i- 


i=s± 


£=it==fe 


-fy 


— J- 


-*—*—4—*- 


^ 


Hzxfc: 


-*â–          -*-  -*â–     5- 

1.  Give  me   oil    in   my  lamp,  oil    in    my  lamp, Give  me    oil    in    my  lamp  I   pray; 

2.  Give  me  joy  in   my  soul,  joy   in    my  soul,  Give  me   joy   in    my  soul  I   pray; 

sftazS — [?— r& — a — Is — \^~r\ — | — * — r — a     a   rA     a     -  -*t- 
pzz:tz=p=pr- L     ] - --â– -â– â–  


§S£ 


:pL_pC — p — a — r — a — A_p — a — g_  p     a 
1— p— tr-h-b-p-11^-^ r 


A_&. 


4- 


â– ft-fr-p 


=d=±;eJes 


-± 


iiiiiii! 


1/      9 

Give  me  oil    in  mylamp,keepmeshin-ing    in    the  camp,  Un- til  the  break  of  day. 

Give  me  joy  in  my  soul,hal-le  -  lu-jahsthenwillroll,Un-til  the  break  oi  day. 

-F-   -F-    -F-      A       A      -k-     -k-     -k-              -k-  *      -F-     -W- 


P" P" 


:s=£=fc 

-p-F-t 


:fc 


i^r 


I P — I 1 —  r-~ 


No.  106. 

Adger  M.  Pace 


"Follow  Thou  Me" 


B.  F.  White 


^=^=^=±=E^z:±' 


-F-fc Fh — =t5- 


1.  In 

2.  He 

3.  Oh, 


tbe  dear 
is  say- 
my  wea 

-*-.      -A- 

-b— fcr 


old    Bi  -  ble    we   read  the  bless-  ed      sto  -   ry, 

ing    un  -  to    the    sin-  ner  now, from  heav  -  en, 

-ry    broth-er,  the   Lord  to   you      is      say  -  ing, 

-A-      i.  „        -A-         A-      -A-          -A-  A- 

=A=fe=s=t5:=E?;=:iA— £=k=t=tz 


._fc_4Jt* 


£=!- 


n 


U     ^   tt£     H     n      P      P      P      '■>      U 


tt      u  v  tt5  g  p  p  p  p  y  v 

How  the  Sav-iour  said,"Coine,fol-low  me,Come,  fol -low  thou  nie," 
"Leave the  ways  of    sin  and  fol-  low  me,  yes,  fol  -low  thou  me,"  Hal-  le  -  lu  -  jah; 
"Lay  your  burdens dowu  and  fol- low  me,  oh,  fol -low  thou  me," 


§5 


I A 

is— ■- 


— ■ — i — 


Itb — s — » — F — w — s — s — w — »— -h — 4 — » — «» — ■■ — h W 


J: 


_*_--: 


IIU—H^- 0  a 1 1 1 L* . 1 ■ 0 El. 

fx—0 9 -s 4 * ♦ * — C3 3 # jU ♦ 


-I* — »- 


Pe  -  ter,  James  and  John  the  be  -  lov  -  ed,  saw  His  glo  -  ry, 
You  will  find  that  un  -  to  your  soul  there  will  be  giv  -  en 
Give   to    Him  your  ev  -  er  -   y  weight  and  cease    de    -  lay  -  ing, 

-A-  -A-          -A-        SA-  S 

-i j—  f~ 


s=fe=ts=ts=ts-fc=S^t=:E*— t=|c=|sz=|s: 
—I p — P — P     b~~P — P     ^ — • — '"  ~-h"   """ 


— « id « Cj"# 


=J5: 


P      r 

2± 


~p: 


-p--i — — 


_A)_ 


* 


U     "  •  9 

And  they  said, dear  Lord,  we'll    fol   -  low  Thee,  we  will 

Kest  and  peace  to    thrill   and     set      you    free,  that  will 

And  some  day  you  shall    His     glo  -   ry      see,  shall  His 

h      B  & 

-A-       -A-      -A-        „        -A-        SA-                         ».            P        "A-  -A- 


fol  -  low  Thee 

set     you  free, 

glo  -  ry  see. 

h 


P 


:p=:^=£: 


-•K 


Chorus. 

r*    H  >•  p      -p      > 

l1       J  J     J       * 

J/   *]           >* 

i  •  * .  .«  -*  *  j^  *,   *i   r     . 

>•        1                       a' 

-0- £ 

■                              flw       • 

•j  b  b  p  u  '           o  '      r      '             p 

"Come a -long  and  fol            -           low  me,"     our          Sav             -           iour 
"Come  and  fol -low        me,"      our         bless -ed    Sav-iour 
"Fol        -         low,       me,"      our         Sav         -         iour 

-A-                           -A-                -A-                                         -A-                                 _ 

Sp*-         5       ^1    is              h    3    k.         k- p     k                F 

1                       y              1               P 

'                                                                P 

Copyright  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory." 


"Follow  Thou  Me" 

i 


said,        and 
said,        and 
said,        and 


will  give 
I    will  sure-ly  give 

I  will         give 


you 


SRF=E 


" pi 


3i^ 


— 0 0- 

I  / 

k k k k  - 

«    .£■-*- j 1 k- 

'"i        m        m        m        n 


rest; 
you   rest,  I  will  give  you  rest; 
you   rest, 

»==—  »— <=  =T nI3 

k —  — k 


L * 


— t? p- 


Tru-  ly  shall  be  giv    -    en 

And  tru  -  ly  you  shall  be  giv    -      en 


I — H 1 

• — » — 0 — 0 — 

o  -  ver   yon  -der, 


ft      fi 

-*-      -A- 


r>  h 


W_A A 5 =^- Fr= 


fcEJ 


K=  , 

-• • — -0-  _ 

sweet 


:r=£r.^z:  ^=^"fc«^=fc a-^Esf== ===== =ii 


hap- py  homo  with        all  the  blest.   . 

e  with  all         the        blest. with  the  good  and 

i  J  -;  -J  i    &  ft  h  M  .h  i    h  h  i  i  wh  r> 


No.  107. 

S.    F.    ADAMS. 


Bethany 


"  A-——- 


7± 

=a: 


I 


B 


8 


Lowell  Mason. 


<i  4 1  tstsfct 


P5 


w 


-zkz& 


-p*7-^ 


^•-4  J- 


i5=^r 


1.  Near- er,  my  God  to  Thee,  Near-er  to   Thee!  E'entho'  it    be   across 

2.  Tho'  like   a  wan -der -er,  Daylight   all  gone,  Darkness  be  o  -  ver  me, 

3.  There  let  the  way   ap-pear ,  Steps  un  -  to  heav'n;  All  that  Thou  seudest  me, 

I   •'  "far-  .     *>.  _  I -Es- 


pgfT 


s 


Jt 


#fe? 


s: 


S3 


-&-SH 


:1s-t- 


f^T 


Fine. 


d 


^ 


i 


D.  S. — Near-er,  my  God  to  Thee! 
.       ,  ,       .       D.S. 


^^ 


3 


3=* 


xfc 


Thatrais-eth  me! 
My  rest  a  stone, 
In      mer  -  cy  giv'n; 


aJ    *    gfe 


:&=£ 


Still  all  my  songs  shall  be,  Nearer,  my  God 
Yet  in  my  dreams  I'd  be,  Nearer,  my  God 
An -gels  to  beck -on  me,  Nearer,  my  God 


g  g     I    :  g      J      ft  g 


to  Thee! 
to  Thee! 
to  Thee! 


g=3t 


-fSr. 


£ 


Near  -  er    to  Thee! 


No.  108. 

Adger  M.  Pace 


He's  a  Friend  of  Mine 


J.  L    Freeman 


1.  Oh, the  joy  and  peace 

2.  I    was  lone  and  sad 

3.  There  is  nothing  now 


that    is    in    my  breast, 
when  He  came  to  me, 
for    my  soul  to  dread, 


gpE 


A-  -A-    -A- 

t=t=t 


3-lE— s-tg-|s-jr— 5 


:c 


5=£ 


£* 


A~l- 


V-iHrV-V 


9 — W—  • -a ■--'  <  ^1- 


0    0    U    U— fcr3 


— Jtst 


-*— •<—  rj— *—  r^- 


Since  the  Lord  came  in 
And  I  had  no  hope 
For  I  now  can  see 


te 


jHg-g-M=£=£ 


and  my  heart  has  blest; 
of   e  -  ter-ni  -  ty; 
bet-ter  things  a-head; 
IN 


j    pr-g— p— izrpzjEzr    g=ppzr^s     .g 


j , t>_,- 

. — I 1 1 5I_i_Ll 


Tak-ingall  my  cares 
But  I  let  Him  in 
I've  a  home  with  Him 


; £Lij 

and  my  doubts  a  -  way, 

and  He  saved  my  soul, 

on  the  oth-er  shore, 


P — p 


m — j 


1 


-A-     -A-    -A-    -A-    -4-   -4-    -A- 


g 


0  r 

— F — r 


-*-    -I*-  . 


— c^— ^— 1?~ p— tp— 13— c^— p— p— "- 


r-rsrtr-tn- 


tMMfed 


Giv-hig  me  the  song 
And  1  leaped  for  joy 
And  I  mean  to  live 


S 


b     0     P    p£     P 


P 


that  I  sing   to  -  day. 
when  He  made  me  whole, 
there  for  -ev-er-more. 


-A-    -A-   -A- 

~       I        g    p    •    p    a 


l-i  :±=tf=^=P=P=fci=t2=P=! 


a-  -*-  -    -^     fc)     ^     fr  l  r> 


-A- 


r; 


Chorus. 


^_^_^__^__^. 


•=j— ^— i^zij— aj-^i 


â– HB-r 


EEEgEE^gE^EgE^ 


I'm  so  glad  to  know  He's  a  Friend  of  mine, 

I'm  so  glad  to  know  He's  a  Friend  of  mine, 


%~mo3-±:jlJl 


,-ui— 


-A,— A 


p-^-b-p-f- 


1* A-j 


Copyrighl,i948,by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher  in  "Gospel  Glory." 


He's  a  Friend  of  Mine 


h- — — P— ^— ^H-*-*— ^— ^  -  J— •~r?-^=  __ 7-*-1 

And  Hesaies  my  bob!  thru  His  grace  di  -  vine; 
?soul  thru  His  grace  di-vine, thru  His  grai 

m       ft     ft     ^     H     P  -     -    -A-    9      J>    -A       •*-     -*- 


And  Hesaies  my  bob!  thru  His  grace  di  -  vine; 
And  He  saves  my  soul  thru  His  grace  di-vine  .thru  His  grace  di  -viae; 


And  whenl  someday,  shallHts  glo-ry   see, 

And  when  I  somo  day  shall  His  glo-ry   see,  shall  His    glo-ry   see, 
-♦-    -♦-     -•     -♦- 

•put:  -^--if—V-- t-J* 


-A      -A-      A-    -A-    -A-    -A- 


— 1_ — | 1 1 1 [* — i a ■ ■ b. — ^s ■- 


:— fhHBrnriHHH^ 


2^B 


0  "1         '*" 

;   .ft  ft  r>P  -fe  b  J> >,  r-.  ■  '■■    — -^ 

fi       ^=P=fei" 

-« m 1 — 3 — _ — t r d 

I  will  praise  His  name                          thru  e-ter-ni-  ty. 

1  will  praise  His  namf  thrn  e  -  ter-ni  -  ty,  thru    e-ter-ni  -   ty. 

-A-    -A-    -A-    -A-    -A-    -A-    -A-    -A-     m        J>          ft         ft          ^          ^ 

eg            ^       :     i_a    r  *    i    ^    §_£    I    p       *     *--  -    b.     *  n 

^+— V— -*>— V     V     V — ^ — =-  —  ^— V— VP- A— H 

L                              -   Lr^                -TV  u 

No.  109. 

A.    M.    TOPL.ADY. 


Rock  of  Ages 


Thos.  Hastings. 

s  Fine. 


I 


1.  Eock   of       a  -  ges,    cleft    for     me,    Let   me    hide    my  -  self     in    Thee; 

2.  Not    the     la  -  bor      of     my   hands  Can    ful  -  fill     the  law's    de-mands; 

3.  While    I    draw   this    fleet- ing  breath.  When  my  eyes   shall  close    in    death; 


£e£ 


as 


&± 


$=â–  


£ 


& 


D.C.Be      of      sin     the    dou  -  bie  cure.  Cleanse  me   from    its    guilt  and  pow'r. 
D.C.A11     for     sin   could  not      a-tone,   Thou  must  save    and  Thou    a  -  lone. 
D.C.Rock  of       a  -  ges,  cleft    for    me,     Let    me    hide    my -self    in    Thee. 

D.C. 


J -Aj 5L 


it 


t— fr 


snHtilip 


£ 


* 


Let     the    wa  -  ter     and   the  blood,  From  Thy  wound-ed    side  which  flowed, 
Could  my   zeal     no      res -pite  know,  Could   my   tears   for  -  ev  -   er    flow, 
When  I     soar    to   worlds  un-known-  See  Thee    on    Thy  judg-ment  throne, 

-*-  • 


£-* 


^m 


tfcf: 


t    T 


£ 


«=* 


V=P 


â– A- 


T- 


No.  110. 

A,  M.  P. 


Just  Beyond  the  Sunset 


Adger  M.  Pace 


-£ 


is=ft 


:£=-* 


=* 


:* *=3 

P P' 


1.  Just  be  -yond                      the    gold  -  en  sun  -  set,  gold  -  en  sun  -  set, 

2.  Just  be  -yond                      the    gold  -  en  sun  -  set,  gold  -  en  sun  -  set, 

3.  Just  be  -yond                     the    gold  -  en  sun  -  set,  gold  -  en  sun  -  set, 

h  h      p            jp.  ^:     .*. 

y y 1 3 


t) 


& 


£ 


xt 


$: 


*fc 


itxzjz 


g 


I 


-O1- 


-^.         -*- 


And  a  â–   cross 
Af  -  ter  night 
On     that  morn 


-tr-tr 


the  rag  -  ing'  foam,  the  rag  -  ing  foam, 
has  passed  a  -  way,  has  passed  a  -  way, 
ing  bright  and    fair,      so  bright    and    fair, 

.«.    jfe.     :E    fr.    «t-     .k.     .».      .^.      .*.      .?_     -?L 


XL 


tr 


:^=^: 


a — g  r^»      *~ 


tr 


=3S=fc 


:=&: 


Stands  a  man 
I'll  be -hold 
I        shall    en 


Be 


:£—* 


:=J- 


PI 


■p— P 


v      P      U 

sion  bright  with  glo  -  ry, bright  with  glo  -  ry, 
that  love  -ly    man-sion,  love  -  ly    man-sion, 
ter    that   fair    man-sion, heav'n-ly  man-sion, 

h  p     n        -«-  —  -* 

I . y y . 3 


I 


fcfc=£ 


SE£ 


:=1- 


-^     —A 


tr-tr— p 


— ♦ M — ♦ — 

._.  — g — A — ;_ 


:=n: 


^ 

-â– - 

P 


It       is      my 
At     the    break 
And    my  Lord 


fc 


-__-tr__,*_Ji: 

:       -U ^~ 


y       w  U      r 

e    -  ter  -  nal    home,  e    -    ter  -  nal    home, 
ing      of      the    day,   that    bet  -  ter    day. 
will  greet  me  there,  will    greet    me  there. 

ft*  ^  P)  *         J^  ' 


^==t2I 


i  Chorus. 


£=*=:£ 


# 


e; 


Just    be  -  yond 


-*-    act     -#â–       K 
the    gold  -  en    sun  -  set, 


Just   be  -  yond  the    gold  -  en    sun  -  set,    gold-  en  sun-set, 


a* 


— * — *. 

£ 14- 


# 


Copyright.  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory," 


P=£=£ 


Just  Beyond  the  Sunset 

■— A ▲ — -a * • a — \rs • 


Just    be  -  yond  the    gold  -  en    shore, 


f= 


Just    be  -  yond 


the    gold  -  en    shore, the    gold  -    en  shore, 


ft»-     Sk-      -k-      -«-       *• 
—I 1 1 L-ft 0- 

V       V        V        * 


p=5=£= 


ft ft — 

9 


f 

sion    wait-ing    for     me, 
I've  a  man-sion    wait-ing    for     me,  wait-ing    for     me, 

^?=^— :r=tE— k— -bii-  b=b=rt— i— : 


fat=£rt 


:£=£ 


i^ife: 


:±: 


->- — *- 


v—v 


And  'tis    mine 


for  •   ev  -   er  -  more. 


And   'tis  mine     for  -  ev  -   er  -  more,  for  -    ev   -  er  -  more. 


:IE=pz 


ft 


>. 


Coda 


=-4UlPJI-J 


%* — • — # — 0-£<s> '— —         —ft — ft    a  —  P^ •—•! 

Just  beyond  the  gold  -  en  sun-set  time, 

Beyond  the  sun-set  time,  the  gold-  en  sun  -set  time, 


§5 


-^~— v.— -%—%—%— %.-   - 


^r=^q=^-^=^=P=P=P-g=g: 


* » 


^_^E3^^=^^?_=5:-f_=S 


-*— *— F- 


•J  1 


-^nTTV^rv 


Is  a  mansion  bright, 


5  * 

and  it  is  mine. 


t-r^ 


$=: 


A  hap-py  man-sion  bright  and  it   is  mine, for  -  ev-  er,  it     is  mine. 

M.   JL   ...  -ft|ft-   *         Q».   -k-    Aj    j*       ft    £   J?    J 


:fc=fc=fc=£- 


E£dt 


&=**=*=^^^^ 


No.  111. 

W.  B,  Walbert 


The  Love  of  Jesus 


-4H-J- 


James  D.  Walbert 


fcst 


544 

1.  Oh,  the    love    of    Je  -  sus, 

2.  High-er    than  the  moun-tain, 


:*=&=£: 


*      *      * *_m_ 


—4 4 — * — =1 5— 

How  it  thrills  my  soul, 
Deep-er  than  the    sea, 


\ 


-tg b jr- F— I* 5= T™ ■ 1 tZ~8 «« 


R  R 


i  rs 


h 


# 


*=£ 


-£- 


i.  j.  i      n 


Grow-ing  still  morepre-cious, 
Sparkling  like    a    foun-tain, 

=  Mel 


keep-isg  glad  and  whole: 
keep-ing  glad  and  free; 


r^tfe— 1£±$: 


-*s* 


* « tt» .* rSi 


J-* 


— n— --*\— Z 


^--h—h-^P 


-45- 


=b: 


— ^-* * ♦ -5 « « M — . 


53  H^  *D 
♦i « 1 1 '- w-  —  ~ •-- 1 


Love  that  bro't  the  dear  Sav-iour 
Thru  the    a  •  ges      e  -  ter  -  nal, 


to  dark  Cal  â–   va  -  ry, 
al  -  ways  just  the  same, 


*-fcJs 


tez3£3= 


35£e£e££ 


--,-£ *■ 1 r— 


R  H  r 


*    *    j 


m 


A 4 F r-Q^ A g ui A  —  9 « A  —  ■*-- • 

/.     /  "*"•    *1 

Love  that  nev  -  er  chang-es,  bound-less, full  and  free. 

Love  of  Christ, su  -per-nal,  praise  His   Ho-  ly  name. 

R  R    k 


i 


d»: 


=t3: 


4£ 

— »- 


:t: 
-tr-tr 


k— fc>k k ar— «£-- ' S~3 


Copyright,  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory 


Chorus. 


The  Love  of  Jesus 


-*_ M * M - of r. »    L'i  >>-■** — * — * — ,"— 


T  b  5  ^i  t  fr  8  b 


His  love,  ob,such  won-der-ful  love,  His  redeeming  great 

His  love   e  -  ter-nal,  yes,        His  love  is         su-  per   -  nal, 


—^  -PI — i *- — i -■ — i -- 

___=  EE___t__=|__i__-_— *— 
ST^P  .  P   P   p 


:=_____ 


t—  MS; — - — ^^-p* — a— t- F — H«-i-3— ?- 

tr-p— _r 


p 


0    P    u-F 

love,  sent  from  heav-  en    a-  bove; 

great  love  was        sent   to  us        from  heav'n  a-bove; 


P 
Free 


^-^^^S-S-_=_-__^:t__: 


4 — A — A — _ — * — bt — ff 


-f>— f)— f> f-j r~R*f  ■!— '  w-n 


p     P     P     P     P^1  p-^  P^j 


Per        p 

grace,  oh, such  marvelous  grace,  His   in- fi-nite  grace, 

Free  grace  and  glo-ry,  and      'tis  such  a  sweetsto-ry, 


__-__: — _;__£- £__£—£ |cj — p_p_pz_ t=r   r   r 

PPPP.P  p  ppp 

D.S.  Lote,(For-e?  -  cr)flowing,glo-ry(and)lovo,(on  us  His)  un-chang-e-a- ble  lovo,be-stow-ing, 

fl_E^^^________l__E_|__E__a___|gy 

purchased  for  all  the  lost  race,  Keeps  the  soul  so    hap- py, 

for  the  whole  lostrace.lt  keeps  the  trust-  ing  soul  so   hap- py, 

__.  -A-       A-         a- 


8_ 


___ 


=S_5_fes--fEE:^fc)£-f__— — 

:_zF==tiz^zp=pzP=tp=pz^Eg=|:===:- 


From  the  great  Cit-y    aboTe ,  from  the  throne  above. 

zz_-=to;±^4=i} 

/3___5=*|£:__3=«=2 


_).£. 


Higpl 


si      - 

free  and  whole,oh,praise  Him,  glo-ry, hal-le-lu-jah, 

free  and  whole,         praise        His  won-der-  fulname  for-  ev-er-  more, 

#_g-Jfr_4LJfe.-*- 

fczi_:J=Wi: 


gg-ft"lz-:_Eg____#_g 


-j_^-g±g-r-p-^p-»-p- 


-«-a- 


No.  112. 

W.  B.  Walbert 


Press  On,  Pilgrim  Band 


m 


m 


±*z 


-A — (*. 

-I 1 m- 

■  r> » *■ 


i=tf=d 


-fc- 


±===h==s=ts 


Earl  Conway 

4 


1.  As     you    jour  -  ney    here 

2.  There  is     glo  -    ry     just 


a=* 


l=i 


m 


be  -  low,    hap  -  py     pil  â–   grim  band, 
a  -    head,  for      the   tried  and  true, 


"&M? 


A  V    tfc-|4_ 


:p=p=b.=t.zz:tp: 


z=|sz=bs=z=t=S==t 


-A 

:t=: 


$: 


*-§*: 


-3— S-~- 


rf>=±— 


t=fcfc 


Walk  ev  -'ry    day  with  -  in  the  straight  and  nar  -  row  way,  with    Je-  sus; 
Press  ev  -  er    on,  my  broth- er,  with     a      hap  -  py   song,  and  praise  Him; 


4— 


— F— ? — X- 


r— t?— p— D~  t?— 9~ 


—  ±1I2 


-N 1 ■— — j -R 


*1 


~D~ 


13 


*|J4--A A A A 

,} ^H* » 1* * 


=A=to 


£-- *- 


-y- 


:^=zp±: 


-hj- 


£: 


e)        y 

Sing  hal  -  le  -  lu  •  jah    to  His    name  with  heart  and  voice, And  glad  -  ly 
There  is      a  bright  and  shin-  ing  crown  wait-ing      for    you,  Up      yon-der 


feterfc 


-*-  -*-    -*- 


+- 


=u^_l._l|l=dSZ=|£==fcl=|S=Z|l=|i= 


â– *-        -A- 

:ts=js=ts=n: 
bi2=zJ==t3=E: 


at: 


:± 


4>— ^ 


hee^=i=:=3 


-^— ^=^-^-r. 


=izi=l=4 


*=* 


— q: 


mag  -  ni  -  fy     and  praise  Him, make  Him  now  your  choice, 
in       that  Cit  -  y     just     be  -  yond  the     az  â–   ure    blue. 


& 


-*-     -P. 

-k k 


4r_J£__«. 


:p=!*=^fe=|s=?=tt=:t=^ 


t2=t2=t3=tj?=(?=t4==r= 


:t= 


Chorus. 

£4t$ — 5 ±z_ 


=D=t 


-'2=2: 


fc=s=M 


Press  on, 


$=£=$=2=4 


=fs=q=frz 


oh,  pil-grim  band,  to  that      sweet  summer  land,  Home  of  the 


Press  on, 

-A-      -*â–  


to  that 


A- 

F_«_r 


==p=:t2=:?=t2zz:tp=t=E=:p=bx:?=?=z?=t 


p     v     i>  \j 

Copyright.  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory, 


trtr 


*=*: 


Press  On,  Pilgrim  Band 


„  „3 — i — v—\-^— 
-^p« — d— — i — 

i — 3 — L^ A. 


:f 


-3=E3zzH; 


-    —    ^     I      TT    •*" 
ran-somed  soul,  ran-somed  soul, 


:sh-s- 


f-» — ♦ — * — * — ^ — ^ — r — h- 


zzzt 
*zz |c 


-jj — ±— 3 — *- 


-^— 5 


Praising 

Praising  Him  who  died  to  3ave     us, 


=EEE 

zzzhzz 


p- 

Iszzfc 


teliZZZJZZZftZZZZ^— 


=]: 


=N: 


'â– =t5=q=^5=^;=E3: 


--ft- 


:zzz=?zzzz=g: 


Je-sus,themight-y  King, making  your  piais-e3rine,loud-ly  ring, for  -  ev  -er; 


-A- 


::izz a^^zz£z==— Mifzr^zz^zz!!' 


IZpzzpzzfc: 


I-"-' 


g-tzzp: 


-t— F^- 

— Lr= 


^^=^zz==z:i^^=^— p^=iz=izz=^z^zzz==zpJ== 

f *! 2 < A A J A—1  J p 


Tell    of  His  matchless  love,  com-ing 

Tell  of  com-ing 


4-      f— \r 

from  heav'n  above, Glad 

Yes,  and 


-A-       -A- 

-h-     -\~ 


ifc |azzIs: 


-A-     -A- 

:|szziizz!sz: t 
ipzzp: 


ZBZZ|szziizzjsz:L^: 


i         in 

_^_*_^_«_k__ 4       *- 

:|szr|£zz|iz=t=z=pztiz — a 

:tzz^zztJzitz:»zipztpzzz:-zzz 


•j 


zzfczzz— 

zzE£=E 
ly 

glad    - 

•l_zz_ 


:z± 


:a: 


^zznzzpzzpzzzzzpzzfz 


Glad  -  ly 

..ft— J— JJ-j—i- 
^zz-z=5— Jzz-z 


smg, 


Bow  down  be-  fore  Him, 


ly    sing,  oh,  look  up 


tfzzzzzzzzzg: 


and  sing, 

tap  J-  t-    £ 


c k k 1 


shout 


&=$=£=£=. 


loud 


and  sing, 
-f)-- 1 I5-J- 


SfeJE3EE|E§E&E3EEg 


:czs: 


bs=:i: 


f 


rati 

Z£ 

T 


wot- ship,  a  •  dore  Him,  He    is    our    Sav-iour,King,Sav-iour, Lord  and  King. 


-A-     -A-      -A-  -A-      -A-      -A-      - 

zz_t:_r— #-4z_-t_-tr— 

'  ^^szztKZztszztszzszrEgzztzz 
zpzzr=:t3zztzztzzEzzzzzz 


!    ^bJ    ^  n  h 


±ts 


zfcr.1 


No.  113.         Watch  the  Light  Just  Ahead 

W.  C.  C.  '  Walter  C.  Carter 


1.  As 


24 € — =n:H ^zzzpzp 


— 4 


â– 0-- 


:z£ 


you  go      a  -  long  thru  life's  bus  -  y  throng,Watch  the  light 
2.  When  the  way    is   clear  there  is  naught  to    fear, 


3.  Broth-er,Stop  and  look,  lis  -  ten    to    the  book, 

-A A m w_ 


Watch  the  light 

_* A_ 

-' — _t 


-#- 


just  a -bead, just  a -head,  'Tis  a  warn- ing  sign  of  the  dan-  ger  line, 
If  your  heart  is  pure  and  you  would  be  sure, 
In     no    oth- er   trust,  but    in  Christ  yon  must, 

A A A rA A — A * =—  r 

toz=zz-.Eg=t=t:=:t=f=:f=ftz=t:=c:z=t:=?z:ff=5^=:r:= 

'P— — h— A A A A A — r-A A A A A — rA— A A 

1 y b* 1 5 b1 —  1 1 1 b1 — b" —  1 1 1 


'JUlJCJL 


m 


-&— h 


zfe 


«j       w|- 


=£ 


Watch  the  light 


Watch  the  light 


::fc=:35=fL| , E 

-a — J    1-1 — iH 1- 


just    a  -head,  a  -head;When  it  warns  you  stop 
Let      it  guide  your  steps 


It 


will  guide  you  straight 

> — 


J^_h.,^L 


A 


-#- 


i 


^  •     j.    ♦     «     «      -  1 

and  the  gate  barsdrop,Oh, "Be- ware,"  is  the  wordJe-sus  said,He  said,  Do  not 
to  the  One  whohelps,Our  Re-deem-er,  the  Christ,who  hath  said,  hath  said, "Fol-low 
to    the  pearl-y  gate,  And  our  home  where  no    sin    is    to  dread,  to  dread,  What  a 

111        r\ .     -N 

A_A— A_rA---?— f— A_-_,_.^_ll_4! A< d_ 

* 1 — - i 1 — K       b> — b P B — »■ 


m 


=t3=t 


:t--tzzt= 


1— 


-v — v- 


--9—g=^ 


-I n- 


V- 


:t-:    :-  — ^=t?=U  -  J 


1    r   i 

ven-ture  thru  till  the  light  bids  you, Oh,  my  friend  watch  the  light  just   a-head. 

me,"  a-long  and  "in  Me    be  strong  And  with  faith,  watch  the  light  just   a-head,  a-head. 

joy  'twill  be  thru  e  -  ter-  ni  -  ty,  Just  to  live    in  that  light  just   a-head. 

Ul_a_s_aL_aI   ■5l_a_k_a__a_  _*_a— a_  J_*L_-* 


Copyright,  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory." 


Watch  the  Light  Just  Ahead 


Chorus. 


Â¥==s& 


— If5 


-fc—fc- 


:'  â– â– â– â–   ^Sjz=  '  â–  

Watch  the  light  that  is  just     a-head,  Watch  the  light  and    by 

Watch  the  light  Watch  the  light 


jj_bl — ^fc._^" — * tfc. — k — k — *■ — 5 

-w-     *         i      i    .     S  '        I         ~ 


wp__»-. y^ — A — 1^ — A — -*— b* —  — ~F — ~    — 


fe 


-m — a- 


it     by   led,Wateh  the  light  ev  -'ry  night  and  day, you  will  find 

Watch  the  light  von    will  find 

>__ A_A__A_A A-rA A Vm a 


!^-HA £- & ^ 

r 


-1 — r—  t- 


it    will  pay; 

it    will  sure-  ly  pay; 


Fol-low  on, 


in    the  way    of  love, 


Glad-  ly    fol  -  low   on, 

IN 


0   l>   U    b    ! 

Till  you're  safe  with  the  saints  a -bove,Trav-el   on, 

Till  you're  rest-mg  safe  Broth-er,trav- el    on, 


*=-=^ 


-»     ■ — >- — ■- 

-Ht 1* Hi — *: 


Ucte&ci 


trtr 


2 


iJzz3z3=*zEE£ 


nev-  er  dread,  keep  jour  faith, watch  the  light  just  a  -head. 

there  is  naught  to  dread,  that  is  just    a-head. 


i^p 


* 


*=*= 


p-b 


£=£— I QEjE==Z~z3 


No.  114. 

Adger  M.  Pace 


The  Highway  Grand 


m U-A. 1 1 1 1 « —\ *| 1 1 1 -j u 


Woodrow  Sides 


fr 


i 


1.  I'm  walk-ing   the    high- way  that  leads  me  up     to    the    glo- ry  land  fair, 

2.  This  won-der  -  ful    high-way    to  glo  -  ry     is    the  great  highway  of  love, 

3.  I'll  trav  -  el  this    high-way    to  heav-en,  beau  -ti  -ful  home  of  the  soul, 


■s— -—z—s ^ & *— r^ s * — fc • ^ — s fc — r^- 


**==*=& 


mm^S=m 


m 


tp=p=g=£=3 
3 


& 


i 


sm 


And     Je  -  sus      is       lead  -ing  me      on  -  ward  each  pass  •  ing    day; 

And     Je  •  sus     has  called    it  the    high  -  way     of  Ho  -  li  -   ness; 

With    Je  •  sus      my     Sav-  iour,  Re  -  deem  -  er     and  King     di  -  vine; 

f — §k f- 


t^H» ft ft 1* P 1* 


*=*=£ 


iprnqEZzn: 


-fc/- 


^e^zz^z^^^^j^^z^^^z^^ 


^&a=5 


3]zz:i]=£ 


-&— & 


I 


The  light  of  His  glo  -  ry  is  o'er  me,  shin -ing  with  beau-  ty  so  rare, 
'Tis  lead-ing  me  on-ward  and  up-ward  in  -  to  that  Cit  -  y  a  -  bove, 
And  there  I    shall    live  in   His   pres-ence  while  the  long    a  -  ges  shall  roll, 


^HEp— Vzz$==?=5=-\:=z  p=p=p=:fcfc=£ 


S=S 


t&: 


£ 


e£e3e^=£=± 


IN         1 

:a)zzq=sf. 


jgzdArzr^j 


^ 1?. 

That's  why     I        am  sing  •  ing  and  shout-  ing      a  -    long  my  way. 

Where  I      shall      be  giv  -    en      a  life  -  crown    my  heart  to  bless. 

And  praise   Him    for  sav  -  ing  and  keep-  ing     this     soul  of  mine. 


ft 


§£«z 


-t: 


-W-        -*-        -A- 

:t__1r_t: 


-■-     -£■ 


s 


5=5: 


±=£ 


fc 


Chorus,    w 

"j2r-^ — N- 


fc 


&--J: 


Z± 


1 


V 


tt-r 


P=t- 


m~m- 


This  won-  der-  ful    High  -  way 

This  old    gos-  pel  High-way,bless-ed  Highway  rich  and  grand, 


grand, 


Efc 


5: 


ipzzzpzzrp: 


:pz=p=:p=p: 


:p=p=pzipz=p=] 


Copyright,  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher  in"  Gospel  Glory  " 


The  Highway  Grand 


^tei-E 


m m 2 > m «_tf* m 


-=!— s- 


^: 


UUu'UppUUpU^pU 

Will  lead   me    to    glo  -  ry  land, 

It    will    lead  me    on  and   up-wavd  to  the  glo-  ry  land, 
-â– -    -!*-    -I*- 


i§E 


5?^zz^z=g: 


—  i 1 — qp — * — i — I — i — i — ri — t|^ — i — m — I — , 


"tp— p~  y— p-  P 


Where    Je  -  sus      is     reign  -ing    with    glo   -  ry 


up  â–     on    His   throne; 


gE^^f^: 


^r^r^^^^^^-^ 


it 


at 

-o- 


I 


And    I    shall  keep  sing  ing  there, 

I     shall  then  His  hap  -  py  prais- es   keep  on  singing  there, 


£d2 


BE 


ie^y^b 


t2=?=t3ZIZpZr=t2=[P=t2=t2=Et2=P=:t3=t3=t2=3 


=d2 


ij  u  5  5  w  u  u 


With  all   the   re-deemed  ones  fair, 

With  the    an -gels    in  their  glo- ry  and    redeemed  ones  fair, 


7^5 r-l 1 M* P 1 -| P — r- — f-H ** 1— — ' — -|— ~i 


fcfc 


EE! 


p-p-^— p-Lp- 
£ 1 


p=^==^r=^z=i—^ 


-*\ 2c 


-  —    l  ij     ♦ — fj     '*     ♦ 


r—  ^ — fr± 


For  -  ev  •  er    and 


er    with     Je  -  sus     my    King,   my    own. 


I 


._»• 


mm 


ZmZ=ZZO—tt 


—v- 


?==p= 


No.  115. 


I'll  Rise  and  Fly  Away 


(In  Memory  of  Rev.  C.  C.  Holtzclaw.who  went  to  heaven.March  7.1947) 
E.  W.  0.  Edgar  W.  O'Dell 


j ^4^-T< H ♦ ~f H 1 1 1 H  -•* 0 1 1- 


^=fi=3b=s 


-41 — A — A — A- 


G*3 


1.  Go-  ingup  yon-der,ner-  er   to  wan-der,go  -Da  meet  my  Lord  and  King,my  Sav-ionr, 

2.  Some  of  these  morn-ings  and  with-ont  warn-ings. He  will  sure-ly  split  the  skies,l'll  see  Him, 


£-. 


*--*—*   WA     A- 

b  0  t>  fir 


-a— #■ 


Sing-ing  the  sto-  ry,shont-ing  His  glo-  ry,  prais-ing  Him   in    ev-'  'ry-thing,Oh  glo-  ry ; 
Com-ing  in  glo-  ry,won-der-fu!  sto-ry,and  the  saints  will  all    a-  rise,  to  meet  Hi»; 


ssspg^a^^^ 


TTX-tTP 


tr-tr-tr 


-^=- 


BE 


-0—0 — 0 K-0 — 0 — 0 — 0 — m. — 0--0 — • — 0 — 0 1 V 


0—  0 M-# — 0 — 0 — 0  — B — - 

-J 1 — * 1 1 1 1 1 — 

A A A is &' A A A : 


s=p 


p=a=fe 


Go  -  na  re-joice  with  heart  and  with  voice  and  walk  a-long  the  streets  of  gold, with  Je -sua, 
Heav-en-ly  sing-ing  then  will  be  ring-ing  when  I  meet  them  in  the  air,  up  yon-der, 

I*     ft     * 


H — ^— 5 — - — -3 — 3 — « — ♦ — ♦ — « l-r  0 — 0 — 0 — 0 

f A A-LA-  -A A A 


Chorus. 


What  a  glad  time  I'll  have  in  that  clime,His  hap-py  prais-es     to    ex-  tol. 

Glad-ly   re-joic-ing,praisetoHim  voic-ing,  go-ing  to  the  Cit  -  y    fair. Oh   iis-ten, 

-A-    -A-    -A-  -A-     A-    -A-      A- 

^"-t--"£-k-t-— t-t:^         ff_0_0-_0_#_k— ^c±}— ^ — 


$T0-Vrtn? 


— I * — t— V 1* — r — T* — +--*-913 

On  some    to    -  mor         -  row,      I'll       rise        and  fly  a- 

Some  e-ter-nal,     on    some  glad  to-mor-row,     oh        I'll        rise  and  fly  a- 

-A-  -A-  -A-  -A-  -A-  -A-    A     -A-    -A- 

B :t:t-_:t-_-t- — m — itv— tt_-t_-t-- 


-|a    |a    ^    te-TST-^+g 


a % ~ E a_ 


k    \k     Is     tt 


_fi «_. 0_« 


^z^=b=bz:==b=±r2:hz=M=b=b-=b=^=t2: 


Copyright,1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory." 


feE=g 


I'll  Rise  and  Fly  Away 


-M — *—  — Lsii- 


way,  To  that      fair       Cit 

way.flyawayupliighnithJesus,    TotheCit-y,       that      fair        Ho-lyCit-y, 

4    "|        J£  m'_lullm'_J.m" k '*'- * * • * 


-r 


v*1 

I 

y,      for    -  ev  -    er  there  to  stay;  Then 

and      for  -    ev-er  there  to  staj,with  the  saints  I'll  stay  for-ev- er;      I'll  be  hap-py, 

-*-  -*-  m '  «       v.  '*■  i£  ~±-  '£ 

—-  :f^"'f_"_:tz.  tl.- 5 — . ~  1 — j^t" 

= — ■—  •—  ■ — •— F — i~  ~5i A A A 2 


?ZZ=P=5zt3 


'■-P— 3—ri — 5: 


Be 


b    P)    h 
-/*  £  iJ- — fr- 


iz: 


1_. 

I'll         be         hap  -  py,         no        more         in    sin  to 

I'll         be  oh,  so   hap-py,        and  no         morein    sin   to 


g F-r *— f— «— F" f \—r £— T— -ST--  C- 


g^ 


â– Jr-44-M^  i   J  " 


roam;  Safe  thru        the 

roam, from  my  Sav -iourroam,But  I'll  be  Up   in  heav-en,        thru         the 

-f-_1 £_  ___  ■*-   "*-    *  "*■  '*" 


-is 


a  -         ges, 

endless  a-ges,     yes, 


my 


e  -  ter-nal  home. 


& 


in        my    e -ter-nal honie,my    e -ter -nal  hap-py  home. 

■+--  -F-    +-•    -h-    -F- 4       *     -■-    -«-     i.     I   J 

-j— p_p_ u— y — • — h — ■ — h-l~— •—•—•— #-h ■ h- 


-,=t2z^=b=t=-gzig=JL=jbbb^=r~-ZZ 


No.  116.     He  Will  Roll  the  Shadows  Away 

Mrs.  S.  W.                                                                                                  Mrs.  Shirlene  Walker 
-F>— 4> f>— 1 -K-r- .— 6— &- 


j-ft-l a — Fal J at 


♦ — tg,- 


* 


-g ah — al — - 


1.  Of  -    ten    times    in     this    life       we    grow    dis  -  cour  -  aged, And  our 

2.  There  are      man-  y    whose  hearts   are      sad    and    lone  -  ly,    Life    to 

3.  Yes,    this    life    here     be  -  low       is     filled  with     sor  -  row,  And    it 


-U 


fe 


^— al — 1 — al — i — 1 — ai— h5f- 
tl  ••-  s_ 

bur  -  den  are   heav  -  y      to    bear; 

them  seems  so  emp-  ty  and  drear; 

seems  that  we  can- not    go     on; 

-•-  -#-    -•-    -*-    -#- 

frf. — K Lt i. a a M- — 

»p-y — g — p — p — EJ — *— F,*f- 


:ff" — ,> ^ k — k — (k._ — 

:£=Et=t=£=t==t=t:= 

- — r-g— 


-I — a'— Fal 


p   .  et~v 

al — al~ 


=&==&: 
*=*= 


30 


Man-  y  friends  turn  a  -  gainst  us,  the 
But  if  they  would  but  trust  the  dear 
But    if      we   will  trust    Je  -  sus    and 


-A S- 


=^=£=S-' 


pthzfr 


4— & 


4 


-al al— Fai 1 a] 5~ 


,— =E5 


sj=3=l 


world  is  all  wrong, And  no  one  comes  our  bur-  dens  to  bear. 
Sav  -  iour  each  day,  All  the  shad-  ows  would  soon  dis  •  ap  -  pear, 
hold      to      His  hand, He      will    lead    us      to    heav  -  en    our      home. 


7D — P~ 

CHORUS 


jk. k._ 

-k — it- 

-F=tr 


:E*: 


-p — p- 


r 


*r 


i 


p 


=5=*— §=t==E^=:45=^=^==^^3 


P     V     t 


.0.      .0.       v- 

V    t    P 

There  is    One  who  knows  just  when  your  heart  is  break-ing, 

One  who  knows  your  heart  is    break-ing, 

1*-  ^  _ 

-f—  -1—  ■#■ 

~       "~F*— ^=  .  *=~ ~Pr~- 


')',     m  p— w ~ «*_ 


*~t 


ZZ3fc 
B- 

P" 


k — it — tt it tt k. — | 

p— P— $— $—?— P 


p  p— r~p 


:£— : 


£— 4 


*M^ 


b    p    p    p    y    *    y    '  p 

There     is      One    who  knows  just    when    jou  are  blue, 

He  knows  just  when  you     are     blue, 

:»:  T.  :£:     :A:     :A:     £: 


±r 


-t- 


Copyright,  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher  in"  Gospel  Glory  " 


He  Will  Roll  the  Shadows  Away 


m&. 


PT 


* g 3 


[i  V 


3    B 


B    i     R    R   S 


=F5=$=g 


p 


P,      p     -•-     ij      -»■ 

?    t>    P    p    B 

When  the    shad-ows    hov  -  er  near, And  there's  no     one   comes   to    cheer, 

Shad-ows  near,  No    one  cheer, 

â– A- 

_  -P- -•- ij 4; 

tr~  p F — 


^ 


3=£ 


â– ^lil^i^H 


P       P       @ 

Go     to    Him    and     He'll  help    you      ev  -  'ry     hour     of     the     day; 
Him  ev      -        'ry  hour     of     the     day; 


§S3EE=I=£ 


-P-;, __^P- _-• 

EEEt:==|:=:=fifc=3 

— p ■ "5 — p 


te=-- 


^^z=5=?==i^^=^=:Ef|i=i=£==iz==i==i 


I  7  "P"  u  u  s  *  â–   r> i 

It     is     Je  -  sus,  our  Re-deem-er,  bless-  ed  Sav-iour, 

Je         -               sus,  Sav-iour, bless-  ed     Sav-iour, 

-A  A- 


P~=:^ 


. 1 ^ — ik. 1 P P— . 

g:  -- Fp — * — n — p — p — p— I 


ptt 

=F^==^^^=^N^==^ 

_p# *fc— 2 — «- — ^— Fi — * — B — P — "—  -i *— 

_ he i * tm — L^ i i i . 


fcfc: 


-!*-*-p- 


P      P      P 

p    P    P    ' 

He's  the  tru-est  best  Friend      to  you,  In  the  time    of  great  need  He's  a 

Tru    -     est,dear-est,bestFricud  to  you,  In  the  time  of  need  He's  a 

r 


cm = #_Jt.-fl_|j_:£_R_ft.^ P,   p^,  fi-g 

ftt£ — = F™ P — * — i 1 — h* — ■ — * — * — *— r* * — ' *—  ■* — I 


U    P-P    P 


-i — c^ — b- 


p  p  v  u  p 

true  Friend  in-deed,And  I  know  He'llroll  the  shad 
Friend       in-deed,  Know  He'll  roll 


ows    a-  way. 

the  shad-ows  a  -  way. 


•■ h 


— -P_p — 

• — ■ 1— 


p  p 


Lp~ it 


r— r— r 


No.  117.        I  Am  Going  To  That  City 

Rev  Rupert  Cravens  Lee  M.  York 


^=3=^ 


-aJ al- 


■afr— il- 


1.  In      a    home   of     pure    de -light,  built    of    man  -  y    man-  sions bright, 

2.  In   that     Cit  -   y        of    the    soul,  my      e  -  ter  -  nal   shin  -  ing     goal, 

3.  Jas-  per    walls  and  streets  of   gold,  beau-  ty    that  can  ne'er    be       told, 


^J= 


«t=t 


f- 


:5=^=^=p=t—  £=£: 


i-r p" 1" r  * â–  


tr- ^— r~ p 


£Efe 


g^^^^^^^^S^F^^^^ 


SE3^3 


:^: 


Lai  — 


lU 


■0^— 0— f 


Par      be  -  yond    the      rest  -  less   surge  of      time,  the    surge    of      time; 
There  are    joys     no      mor  -  tal    man    has  known,  no      man  has    known; 
I        shall     see    with  -  in     that     Cit   -   y       fair,  that     Cit   -  y       fair; 


-_-  -^-  ~w.  r —  _9_  —  .v— 


3 


ft — ft- 


$=#=£ 


IS 


£ 


—at — gS P E 


1= 


F=fr 


1- 


1 


t? 1^-^ 


h 


Those  I've  loved  and  lost      a     while, greet-ing    me    with  ten  -  der  smile, 

And  when  trav-'ling  here     is    done,   at     the    set  -  ting  of       the    sun, 

But      the    best    of      all     to      me,    Je  -  sus'  face      I  there    shall    see, 

-A-      -A-      -A- 

E  r  1- 


* 


-tf— *tf 


^^^^iim^^ 


u   5  f  »5  r 


I  shall  meet  to  know  in  love  sub  -  lime,  in  love  sub  -  lime. 
I  shall  go  to  live  a  -round  the  throne,  a  -  round  the  throne. 
And     shall  live    with  loved' ones     o    -   ver  there,  yes,      o    -  ver   there. 


Br- 


^H 


i^=t: 


D 


.&â– *& 


#*= 


t=$=3%=%=^==& 


*=te 


Chorus.    |S     |S     k     ft     h 


ir^-iii 


ft-, rJ!-h      ft    4-tL 


r   ...    :-^&-g=§=%^ 


â– r 


-f 


I'll     be    go  -  ing     in    the  morn-ing, 

6o  -ing     in     the  morn-ing,  go  -  ing    in     the  morn- ing, 

-•-    -»-    -»-    -•-    -»-    -•-  v  -P- 

£g=^EEB=£EBEEgEEg=E-  '"    ;    ~ 


P=3=g=g— 6 b- 


Copyright,  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory." 


I  Am  Going  To  That  City 


~,— s —  r* — "    * — * — _ — l — 


0 

Je- sus  saves  me  and  I'm  read-y    to  go,  'Twill  be  glo  -  ry 

Saves  me,     I'm  read-y  to   go,  Glo- ry  then  to  greet  Him, 

-P-  JL  .p.    -*.  -#- 


*= 


-I 3?- 

h: — - 

-y 


izac 


x:: 


just  to  greet  Him,  And  to  leave  all  trib-  u  -  la-tion  be  -low; 

glo- ry  just  to  greet  Him,  Leave  all        life's  suff  'ring  be-low; 


1 — IP' P/  VS— P— b— 


.p.  .â– _  j.  .p.  .p. 


r=t£=^=£=k=£ 


__r_k_£- 


5 zic* — *    g    » «    «         u -j 


:B=T 


-f*_ 


-â– - 


■ — b a P — - 


y 


For  that  Cit  -  y      I    am  long-ing,  Oh,    so 

Cit  -  y     I    am  long-ing  wait-ing  and  I'm  long-ing, 


b Jt:-:'t^--__^t:_:|r:_ 

HA -A A 14 A- 


►£ B F* A 1* A 14 A-      , 


Em — a — ■ — m ■ ■ 3 Z 

En=tr=:giz=yz=B=d=rz=z=:: 


U     P 


man-y  there  are  wait-ing  for  me, 
Man         -  y 

R-t- £ 

^R — k- 


-A- 


Bless-ed  Sav 


^U    u 


are  wait-ing  for  me, 

â–     -#â–  


:t: 


y- 


•y- 


!T=t====Fti:t 


Je  -sus,    I    am  read-y, 

-P-   -P- 


±: 


P=P=g=b=p=Q= 


-P-* — « — a — a — * — 5— — r-P-S 1 


***F$T?H 


i» 


II 


I    am  read-y,  I'll  keep  work-ing,  ev-  er  looking  for  Thee. 

wait,  ing  and  I'm  read-y,  Work        -         ing      and  look-ing   for  Thee. 


I 


fc± 


t=jr=^fc=fcz£===p:= 


P=P=«=p=p 


=n^n— 5: 


iby H: 


I — c>- — h 


-14 14— 

:S=EP=5=P=i= 


No.  118.       Oh,  The  Glory  of  the  Story 

James  Rowe  Luther  Drummond 


1.  Years  I  wandered,  f  ree-  ly   squandered  all  my    sub-stance  day  by  day, 

2.  Life  grows  brighter, burdens  light-  er,   as    the  days  and  years   go    by, 

3.  Oh, the    glo  -  ry      of  the   sto  -  ry     of    my  Lord's  re-deem-ing  grace, 


-^  u  i — i — p~ t> —  — i — i — i — i — c^r^ — 3 


~l 


^— ij-^trd— ^ _  .._ . 

3d — i — ^— Fj — •— p — ^— F^- 


1 — 

Seeking  pleasure   for   my   leis  -  ure,  in    the  drear-  y   downward  way; 
Je  -  sus  near-  er,grow-ing  dear  -  er,  nev  -  er  fails    to     sat  -  is  -  fy; 
Howitspag-es  thru  the     a  -  ges     I    shall  tell    and  sing    a-bove; 


_|t — P_*. 


-P-  -p. 


0 p  -\-p _p 1 L| 1 \- J- — I U^_»_J 


U    P    I 


J— 


■iH J — L* e1 — • ♦ — L-» <»- 


si— F*— T3|=ziq=bd=E±i 
_* — * 1 — -h— ■ 


-3= 
-•- — 


Till  when  sigh  -  ing,  sin  -  ful  dy  -  ing,  I  was  told  of  love  di  -  vine, 
So  I'm  sing  -  ing,  com-fort  bring-  ing  to  the  troub-  led  and  the  sad, 
Joy    for     sor  -  row     all    may  bor  -  row,  per  -  feet  peace  and  rest    com-plete, 

-A-        -£:-        m  -*-        "±-        "A1 


Z3C 


£=Iee 


f- — w — ■• 


"P 


1 — \r~V 


Of     the      glo  -  ry      of      the  sto  -  ry   which  has  changed  this  life    of  mine. 

Prais-ing,     ev  -  er, Christ   my  Sav -iour,who      a-   lone  can  make  them  glad. 

Com-fort      ev  -   er,  fail  -  ing  nev    •  er,  from    its     pag  -  es  pure  and  sweet. 

A-        _ _       -*-       -*-  -*-       -jSs-     -*-       -*-       -*-        _  !  ! 


L 1 — i — p — ^ i — 


Chorus. 
Si 


~l- 


grj *— F » a 9—  F^ J— 

•j  «-     k— -    Uuu-  UUP 

Oh,  the  glo  -        ry  of  the    sto       -  ry, 

0    the  glo  -  ry,  of    the  sto 


— •- 

u 


ry, 


— 0- 


Of      my 


zp: 

=p: 


*— = 


fg 


:==pz=p— t: 

"p— P— P~ 


P§ 


Copyright,  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory.' 


Oh,  The  Glory  of  the  Story 


^idtfbrZf— g 


:s— F 


Saviour's  matchless  love, 


no   one  slight        -         ing,  all     de- 

No  one  slight-  ing, 


light 


iug,  with     a     hope   of    heav'n  a  -    bove; 


all     de  -  light-  ing 


-*-     -*-     -*-     -*- 

tol£Z=l£=ISZZIX=: ~fc 


-t? — p — t? — tr 


:ip— tr 


j£-__J3*: 


-A- 


t==tz 


-te 


_i£ lis* — K       it, k. k. — — as Ci? a a #- 

it,  none  a  -  bove  it, 


4>— -&- 


How  I    love 

How  I    love  it, 


—A 

1. 

— ♦ 


♦- 
Ev  -  er 


m 


-__,       J« -P-    _ 


.-l_| 


none  a  -  bove   it, 


— p— b— F 


—- N-^-l- 


:^z=^ 


I 

-— -& 


i — fc 


His 


in     my  heart  shall    be; 


•A-         »         -A-        -4- 

fc=is=zS=f=::p 


Oh,  the      glo 


ry 
Oh,    the    glo 


ry 


:t: 


=t5=t 


* — a— Eg: 


.-_* 


:zl5=z:=5— h 
— « ^- 


£== 


3H* ^~tP — 1? — P — tr- 

of     the    sto       •  ry,  Of      my    Sav  -iour's  love    for      me. 

of      the    sto  -  ry, 

-fc- j~ -Is- -4- -4- I 

*I~^      ~fs — te — h — ;P — k — P — r — If 


-4- 
lie: 

— t— 


:Ji=;. 


^i^ 


r 


No.  119. 

B.  F. 


I'll  Not  Deny  My  Saviour 


Byron  Faust 


-a/-  *      *     -â– -     -si:     :# 


1.  As    thru  this  world  and  its    sor  -row, 

2.  I        fall    be-fore  Him  con  -fess-ing, 


I    slow-  ly    wind    my    war. 
for-give,  oh,  Lord,  for  -  give, 


■P^—f 


-P—  rk- 


* — — — c *- 


:t=tt 


-a- 


m= 


I    want    the    bless  -  ed      fa  -  vor 
Ob,  take    me  now    and    use      me 


r-fr 


L*i 


'=z^z=-z£q=Ezi=z3 

t— * m tj— Fr£~H 


of       Je  -  sus    day    by    day; 
while  here     on  earth     I      live: 


k— rf^- 


S=crz=j 


-A A-— A * 2 #  — L  ™ A! A A 


— ♦ * l-O1- 


Be      it      to-day    or      to-mor-row,  I'm 

Thank  God, I  now  have  the    bless-  ing.  sa 


m  called  to     take    my  stand, 
il  -  va  -  tion  from     on  high, 


-A-       -A-        -A-  -^.-J 

fc_« — e — k — p_   k — ^l — ^_;t__f_"|:: — *— L"t-1 
5^=t-Ft=p==u==S==5=Fp==rt=^t3i=z:t:=:Et==tP===t:===!:==E|z= 


. 1 1 A -51 A '  2- il 4 * >-_&. A_J 


I'll    not    de  -  ny    my   Sav-iour, 
Tho'  all   the  world  a  -  buse   me, 

-A-        A-     -A-  -A        -A- 


I'm    hold-  ing     to    His    hand. 
Him,  I      will    not     de  -  ny. 


-4-— pi— E E 1— rU P*— *— fl*— -rr*= » $ fc— rar-- »-j 

"=E======Ep==t^t3==r==tf==§==f=r==Et^p.-j 


Chorus. 


§EEEfc= 


P 


l>     "     *     '     I     PJ-^-4^. 


pi — al — a — a) — ai— Atzpfc 


:#=. 


:=r— S- 


— =f: 


I'll  not    de  •  ny 


^ 


my  Sav-iour, 


V 


p  p 

He  came  from 


I'll  not    de  -  ny  my  Sav-iour,Lord  and  King, 


§ 


mat: 


m 


w=w 


— x — = — s — k— r-s — ^ — ' — t — ^ —      ■>■■; 
t2Z=t2=P=t=[:=:Fp=P=P=P=P=S: 


Copyright,  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory," 


I'll  Not  Deny  My  Saviour 

*  I  — '  I   '   ujT  y  b  u  ! 

heav-en  a-bove,  I'll  not  de- ny  Him 

He  came  from  hoav'n  a-bove,  heav'n  a-bove,  I'll  not  de-  ny  Him 


k k  —  k— k k-,-5^ 

U  U  p 

h  h  h  r> 


:--p:t=rp: 


»__» L £ L p 11 

p_p c tp_t?.  _pj_| — __d 


q^=b 


1 


sav  -ing  and  set-ting  me  free; 

sav  -ing, sweetly  sav-  ing  and  set-ting   me, yes,  set-ting  me  iree; 


-i —  ^     -p--    -■-    -R-    -B-    -a-    -a 

>Jz=pzzp^z^.=p-pz— =EP-P— P— g— fcJ— P 


3==; 


h    h    h    I 


p  h 


i=E5=sfe 


i— sr-pri— air—  dfcrP-fedz: 


==s 


IP 


I'll  not     de  -  ny 


His    fa-  vor, 
I'll  not     de  -  ny  His    fa-  vor  while  I  siDg, 


V     [)     P 
And  His  re- 


â– fefiZS' 


i~E5E 


3— g- 


:p=p: 


l& A__pA JS. 

tzztzfozzp: 


_a:_|s A. 

:p:=p.=p.: 


-3— S- 


_h__^_^-i— 


p   '  ^ '  r    i    tp^  L^   U  U    I  I 

deem-ing,  great  love,  I'll  not  de-ny  His 

And  His  redeeming  love,  wondrous  love,  I'll  not   de  -  ny  His 

i     j  ,m.   .m.   .m.   ,m.   .(*. 


p   U   U   I 

p  D  p  r> 


p— p— p- 


pres-ence  now  liv  -  ing  in    me. 

pres-ence,  Ho  -  !y  pres-encenow  liv  -  ing, sweetly  liv  -ing    in   me. 


-A 

fa 


>:£: 


-A- 

-t~    -s- 


P==p— .pzz:pzz:p=l:rrp— pmp^iEzzi^z^-e^Etzznizzz:: 


No.  120.        Traveling  on  With  Jesus 


Adger  M.  Pace 


A  X N h fc & 


Houston  L.  Thomas 

1.  Won-  der- fnl    glo  -  ry    I'm  hav-  ing    to  -  day,walk-ing  with    Je-sus  my 

2.  Love  -  li  -est    flow-ers  are  bloom-ing  for    me,     as    I      go  trav  -  el-ing 

3.  Glad  -  ly    I'll  walk  with  Him  till     I  reach  home,yon-der    in    heav-en  some 

-*^>—$— %—[)—%— 1>—%—%-  p~ F-4P— P— P— P— P— p— 


££= 


^tz-g: 


$=# 


I 


â–  1- 


«      *      i»     gw- 

King,  and  Sav-  iour,  And  as  I  trav  -  el  this  beau  -  ti  -  ful  way, 
on,-  with  Je  -  8U8,  More  of  His  glo  -  ry  I  clear-  ly  can  see, 
day,      oh,  praise  Him, There    I     shall   nev  -  er    more  sor  -  row      or    roam, 

,___£ pi__  _& Da *  ._* a 

:rb-#— •—%«— «-fc=g=zf=:|:— "=zj:={^=fezig 

P-— A sr— — ^5 h* * * A A A A A A A 

Ft?  ■■  ?  : v  P- .  fr,  P.  -    g~~g— tr-^t: 


A 


feM^I1^    â–  


,-jf — ^ — jj — ^_  j^. — 


-i-* 


":3z=g; 


<      2      J 

-  r-W-a-^ — M — h — *— 


>    * 

hap-  pi  -  est  prais  -  es      I     sing    un  -  to  Him;0     -  ver  the  moun-tains  and 
fac  -  ing    the  heav-en  -  ly  dawn,  up    yon-der;It        is      so    won-der -ful 
nev  -  er  grow    a  -  ged  nor  gray,  no,  nev  -  er;  Won't  it    be    won-der-  ful 


:£=£- 


:g=:3=§: 


N^^=M^E?|3=f=J 


.*__.. 


:t: 


■5— 


Ifop-^—^ — j     a   Eg^c — *;~ fg — *   3     a — - — — 


P  "P     P 

val  •  leys    so    dim,  hap  -    py,  yes,    all    the    day    long,    oh,  praise  Him, 
hear-  ing    Him  say, trust  -  ing  •  ly,  "Fol  •  low    me      on        to     glo  -  ry," 

Iiv    -ing     up  there  with    the      re  •  deemed  ones  for    aye,    in  heav-en? 


J) 


£ 


41 


!T  p  "b  'P   ,  -v 

Noth-ing  to  fear  with  Him,  singing  a  beau-ti  -ful  song,  a  glad  and  hap-py  song. 
Un  •  to  the  per  -feet  day, where  the  glad  saints  have  all  gone, where  all  the  saints  bate  gone. 
Glo  •  ry  and  love  to  share,with  the  dear  Saviour  to  stay,with  Him  up  thereto  stay. 


E±EE:1:£E 


*t 


fc=#=tt=$=$=* 


Coi.rriifht.  1948.  by  J.roes  D.  Vcughan,  Mueic  Publisher.  lo"/"Msjestlc  Melodies." 


Traveling  on  With  Jesus 


Chorus 


Chorus. k      h      h  ^  -_,_ 


P ca^BB^BBia^Ezgq — i — j— 


=*=5— s 


-#fc 


Trav  •  el  -  ing     on,  trav  •  el-ing 

I'm  trav  -  el  -ing    on,  on  with  Je-  sub, trav  -el  -ing    on, 

—        a — a — A — * * — it-b»-r=— A— A — i 


tu 


=* 


on,  Morning    un-til    the  set     of   sun; 

on,    He  sees   us  From  morning  un-til   the  set    of   sun, si',  of  set, He  sees  us; 


.J.   3    h 


-^ A A_A_    S| A^--A A A A-      ff_2L_Al_V—2|— 5 , 

sP~h— P— g Fa— »-  ±zfcz»-  p— r~  r-FP— ^— L-—  h— h— ^H 


â– p~P" 


fcfEj :jj!=±=Ji-ai-S— fe=z=— — Sz:#jfcfc±=5g— 3 

\az_ — i  v.       „,;l#^  b»._  i — i c™^^_ _^  J? jqz_j! ™ J 

Trav       -  el-ing  on,  trav         -  el-ing   on, 

Trav-el -ingon,  on  to  glo-ry,  trav- e!- ing   on,  on, sweet  sto-ry, 


.  ,    A     A    A— A- a.  _-^p»       — a__> — it" _A — A-  _a_ *L_ 


-&-%-v-? 


iTiTP 


Go  •  ing    up  home  to  rest  when  the  great  vic-t'ryjs  won, the  v'm  -to  -ry    is  won. 

K-brt — F — B — F — fi — ^ — n — ' l * — * — *— *  hM    •  H 

0_0 gZ^Zt,---- — . 


P 


No.  121. 

R.  L.  J. 


I'm  Going  Home 


Robert  L,  Johnson 


ffi)'  4=  '      *      ■  -M — I 1 — H^A~A— A K-A^-A-  -A— A— A1— A- A— A— A- — I— A 1— A— 5^-1 

^_=rs_u_tf  __  .B_«_g_BrLB_tf  _a_„_g^s_L «-*-L* *-g3r»  • 

1.  There  is  a  home  a-wait-ing  the  faithful  and  the  true  Be-yond  this  reil  of  sor-row,  a-  bo?e  the  az-ure  blue;. 

2.  To  that  good  land  np  yonder  with  Jesus  as  my  Guide,!' 1  tray-el  on  and  up-ward  till  there  I  shall  a-bide^ 
â–   3.  My  fricnd,why  stand  ye  waHing?the  time  is  passing  by,You'll  need  my  blessed  Saviour  before  you  come  to  die; 

5r'g4A-J A A_A_A_A_f_C_P_ : k— P-A-U±_!4k_A_A_A_.A_jS_pS-_A_S_A— »i-T 

^--A-A-A-A-A  -A-A-1  sa— r;— h— h— *- ' ■ ' *— I * 


"HA--A-A-A-A-A  -A-A-L  &— n-~  h— h 


fe> 


-h 


0| 1 }-*— 1 a 


:±: 


3=^—4 


-T^=b^=±: 


So 
And 

Just 


"*!- 


.sg.             .AS-  -3)-               •                 • 

man  -  y    friends  and    loved  ones  have  gone       to 

there  with     all      the    mil  -  lions  I'll  shout  and 

come     a  -    long    and    join    me  and      to  that 


-A J--- A- — I 

-m B j-r — * 


live  up 
sing  for 
home-  land 


g_A C .A A A A. 

fe=bf=t=?=t=|:— t: 

— & L& A —A A A A- 


*_ 


8 


-A ^A j-r 

P  P  P 


there, 
aye, 
go, 


^i— j-A— 


:£=; 


Fine. 


It  makes  me 
Oh.  glo  -  ry. 
And    vou     will 


7&- 


M. 


,*- 


want 
hal  - 
not 


!&?g-A CA Z|A ^. 


to 
la 

re  • 

_*_ 


join 
lu  - 
gret 

JB- 


=3= 

A'  — 

them 
jah, 
it 


=E~F^z=zfe=-  ifcztszrz qn- 


-A |-A 

-  ia .  i 


;;• 


and    glo  -    ry  with 

I'm      go  -  ins  there 

when     vou    get  there 

.«.         ,f>.  .9. 


them  share, 
to      stay. 
I     know, 


Copyright,  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory." 


I'm  Going  Home 


A  -  way  from   sin]  [and    sad-  ness,    to    joy  >>  and  peace   and     glad- ne38, 


1 


iaz 


-v — * 


igi-fP 

apt 

— d — 

F^^^: 

"!">:],.  _; —  i 

h^1- 

— A A A A A A (-        at— 

♦  —9—  S*^«    J 

I'm 

go 

Go- 

1 

l>     j     j     i     l>     ^     y 

ing 

I'm     go  -  ing,            yes,     go  -  ing, 
ing.                      yes,             I'm 

Is    *  wN        h    r>    n 

^       A       J.        1  •  3V     -J-       *- 

1      P 
borne, 

I'm 
go  -  ing 

IS 

# 

J     y    â–   ps3 

go-ing     home; 
home; 

^&— 

â– p= 

-• •-- 

â–   -#  1 



L 

Ly — 1 — 

^   J=j J 

-£? 


F 


â– j 


— 5=n- 


I'm      go            -  ing  there, 

I'm     go-ing,            yes,     go-ing,  I'm    go -ing  there, 

Go-ing,  yes,            I.'m  go-ing                 there, 

:  ♦  ♦  4.  * «  «l  1 4__*L_jL 


fe=i^=-£=zz===p 


:?— 1=: 


Htq 


-J: 


:B= 


P 


y     U 


y    y 


♦f - 


God's  love  to  share, 

God's  won-drons  and  match-less,        great  love    to  share, 

Won-drous,  match    -    less  love    to  share, 


_  1 


_#> v -j_ 


JL      JL 


— v     ~\^ B-^' 


rfc: 


D.S. 


-M—^-N (J * ii 

♦ — ! — M — « M — « 


-r-A- 


:-HV 


=fc 


With    all      the    saint-  ed      mil -lions,  with-    in      that      Cit 


r- 

y      fair, 


el=t=i 


£=t: 

A A- 


A A- 

-A A A- 

U       L>       l> 


!        P       l> 


No.  122.      You  Arc  Somebody's  Radio 

B.J.  Bryant  Johnson 


«* 


1.  As    you  tray  -el    thru  life 

2.  Does  your  life    re-flect  Christ, 

3.  Are  you   tell-  ing   the    lost 


^£-4^ g — ■ p — a — & 


$—$—$-$' 


rzj 


j^zz:^-— -=== ^ 


-4 — '-%* — *—  *— » 

dai  -ly, you're  broad- 
in  your   dai  -  ly 
of  the  cleansing 

A A A -i 

:P=z't= t=t— p=q 

-  *— —  j& A- A 14— J 


:3: 


:?: 


U       v  P      f 

cast-  ing,    here  be  -  low,  Has    the  world  heard  you 

liv   -  ing?    at  His    call,  Has  your   soul  been  washed 

foun- tain,    in  His    side?  Do  you    show    the   way 


speak    of        Je    -    sas      yet?   speak      of 
in         the    cleans  -  ing    flood?      in        the 
that      the      Sav  -  iour    -trod?    that     the 


[i 
Je  -     sus 
cleans  -  ing 
Sav  -  iour 


-â– JH 

P 

yet? 

flood? 

trod? 


bx-t:zg==g==f=:zi=r5==S==S=:^==?z:-8=i 


Do  you  tell  of  that  life 
Do  you  speak  of  His  love, 
Are      you      liv   -    ing,      my    friend, 


I 


1=3 


s — (-  a ■ ■ «- 


It- 


-$—$' 


M 


3* 


t-  r 


U . .  W^V  -  V: ,  V  ■  *  P -  •  9  b  y 
that  is  ev  -  er  -  last  -  ing?  this  we  know. For  the  souls  who  are 
how  His  life  was  giv  -  en?  for  us  all?  Thru  His  mar  -  vel  -  ous 
ou      sal-    va  -  tion'smountain?high    and  wide?  Are    you  read  â–   y       my 


zfcz 
:£=rp: 


„. A A A A. 

CoDyrtehr.  1 948.  by  James  O.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory." 


)± 


You  Arc  Somebody's  Radio 


faW- — L — : : ir A" * A-  —  1Bt— (■  A) — * 

-'  ■•■■ 3Pv    B     rrM  &  c 

ere  their  sun  ha3    set,  ere    their  stin  has   set. 


1 


saved 
grace 
friend, 


and    re-deem-ing  blood, His  re-deem-ing  blood. 
now,  to  meet  your  God?now    to  meet  your  God 


Chorus. 


::£ 


i      J       p       J       U       * 

Oh,    you    are    some- bod   -y's     ra    -    di   -  o,    their      ra    •    di  -    o, 

A A -■- A _A a • a!        -*-        a] I ' i 

^ — n — — e — h* — * — * — — rA  -  1 


U -ft h r—l^ 1 P 1 j- 

^ A ^ 1— i p-| 1 aj- 


la^H^zz-^zqEZ-i 


-4 

, _i 1 AJ Lk_ 

b       5       U      s?       I 

Anjl  broad-cast  -  ing    wher  -  e'er   you      go,    wher  -  e'er     you       go; 

rs 


a! 


— -J>— ^ 

2: 


-rf> — b — h- 


fc*=±-bfc 


^=K-  «=±3 


=5= 


gggjEgSE^gjE 


Ev  •  'ry    broad-cast    you      be  -  gin,  some  -  one    tunes  your    pro  -  gram 

:p:"! 

4— 
.  E-zBzz=ts=titzr:i— ri=r?i= 


•*-      .fc.       .fc. 


BEE 


in,    Oh,  you    are  some-  bod  -  y's    ra 

...      .|l«    -.-.-P.      ...    ^ 


-A *! ^— rA A. 


_x 


No.  123. 

Adger  M.  Pace 


Happy  Glory  Land 


James  \V,  Poole 


sc^-^-its—ifs-bj — 3— ^ — H--F-1 — -^-  -* — -*— '*—* — ^ — * — = — F~!"~ 
efiz:4-^ — i~H — * — 3 — d — * — 3: ~* — «j-  -h= — j — j — a-  \-^~ 


1.  Just   be-yond  the   sun-  set    giow-ing,   is       a      land    of    won-drous  hue,. 

2.  I        am  long-ing,some  glad  morn-ing,  to      ar-    rive     in    that  good  land,. 


i—A A — , A _A b» e> A r-A=~* 


i 


:^-^±-Jz=^— *r 


-- i 1 — r— i 


* e? — Fa -i -P —  Fw 

a 1 — 1  —  «l 1— — i 


:H=EFf 


i 


And   the  flow  -ers  there  are    growing-,  seud-  ing     out    their  per-  fume  too; 
With   a  crown  of  bright  a  -  dorn-  ing,  join  that   hap  -  py  saint  -  ed    band; 


M- — A _i — — ; j A 1_ 

) — j — 1— H| — I — « — ■- 

All    the   love-  ly  scenes  of 
And    to  walk  with  them  in 


.4— £,-£- 

beau-ty    far    be- 
len-dor,  on    the 
rs 


— Ai L! « 4 ~ — !— H 


yond  mor-tals    to 
streets  of  the  Cit  • 


I 


Wait  for    all    if    true 
Shar-ing    in    the  love 

■  *'■-» — # — hi 1 »— 


du  -  ty,  when  the 
ten-  der,     of    the 

A — A — A A- 

±f=t=:pz=r2= 


-a a 1 1 ~ — — I — -I 

V  *        -9-         O 

Sav-iour  shall  call    us  there. 
Sav-iour,who  reigns  up  there. 


-A. 

-» 6) 

t—9 


_.__A_^_ 


r 


Chorus. 


=» 


**=*=*== 


:M=r=- 


— Fai — *- 


Hap  -  py  land,  glo  -  ry  land,  Where  the  saints 

Hap  -  py  land,  glo  -  ry  land,  Where  the  saints         and    the 

k       i   â–   h      w       '  iii 

$l-rd± Jl.-_tL-d: s> ♦    tL 


g: 

Copyright  1948  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher,  in  "gospel  glory." 


"g-—"-  r~» j* p § F* — A — * — p — ^- 


£ 


-* — r- 


Happy  Glory  Land 


OP  h  —  * — Fa — a — a — S r d — * — 

M C a, L  J â– , , I  -, ^_^ 


-- s-++ — A — A — -I 

and  an  -  gels  stand,  Liv-ing    in  the         Saviour's  smile, 

an  -  gels  stand,  Liv  -  ing  there  in    the  Saviour's  smile, 


-1— rJ- 


*'     -i      j...._f;..._.|_..^      ___.!_J_j_-2 «PS-r»    i    1— , 

V/ill    be    glo    -        ry  all    the  while;  Not   a    care 

Will    be    glo  -       ry    all    the  while;  Not    a    care 

i       i      j      J>    JV      ! 


I       I 


J 


-P — P— rhc— ~ru — t? — B" 


trrtr-tr--tr 


rS: 


-A A- 

-i — r 


. i j i 

— j — ^al— ■=:g— -: 

will    be  there,  Glo-ry  love  will  be  ours   to  share, 

will    be  there,  Glo  -  ry  love  will  be  ours  to  share, 


—  _l — 1_  Jr~Z f^ — h-r~! — | — j — -, 

^* g ■— g-F r— » — i 


jL-i_ 


— ^  r     r     r     h     y 


.^.   e  =  _  «L  jL 


_f 0 0 H »— U 


fell ^ P» jj * h jj- » — pj j ^! 13 

j)  —         pa  -■ ■  -g — ■— 1 $ £■ ■ b J 


To     this     hope, 
To     this     hope  let 


%?=*=$ 


oh,  let 

us        ev  -    er    cling, 

± *L__J__j! 


■ — 

us    cling, 


I 


I 


.,42 _ L_, 1 H 


:» ■==F-I       ~~ ~z^z:zzz:zjz: 

-a g — pA A a— 


: l^: 


And    we'll  sing  to  Christ  our 

And    we'll   sing  to    Christ  our    King. 


i 
King. 


4 


— • »- 


r- 


No.  124. 

W.  D.  R, 


That  Land  of  Day 


W,  D.  Rowland 


1.  Christ  the  Saviour  pardoned  me. cleansed  my  heart  and  set  me  free, Nov*  Ihrn  love  He 

2,  Since  I  trust  -ed    in    my  Lord  and  re-  lied    up-  on  His  word, I've  been  walking 


jv — f\ — 


:sbqi=1az=li=zizzis=i=|s=tlizz  ?zz  H=B=p=t2=t=r!i;zz!izA— |cz 

u>    V  i       p    -v .  .y    >/ 


v     v     p     v     u     >»     i      y 


-ft-frfi l-rf — P — fr-lF— ft 

w — _j_ — eiJj^-  -^ — ^— 4 — * 


--P- 


SEE 


-p« — 


keeps  me  in  the  up-ward  way  to  glo -ry;And  if     I    will  trust  His  grace, 

dai  -    ly  in  the  nar-row  way  to  gio -ry;l'll  keep  hold-ing    to  His  hard, 

^  1"  X  .*-     P  -♦-     h  -♦    ->-  :?: 

y    â–   u  y  u    b 


* 


9 <5P— J 


I    shall  look  up  -  on  His  face  When  I  cross  the  riv  -  er,  to  that  land  of  day. 
Till    I  reach  the  gold-en  strand, Where  I'll  live  for-ev  -  er,   in  that  land  of  day. 


*..    >.   _*.   jki   jki 


y=k=p=p— 9—9—^ 


Chorus.  tv----rv '"k    k 

I     â– >* .       P        P        P        P        k 


A— rA — A — A — «.- — * — A—p1 ' ' : — "1 


t>  .  >   y-  •  ■  y  ' ' .".  i/  /     /     >     > 

I  will  fol-low  Je-sus,  Tho'  the  way 

I  wH  fol-low  Je-sus,  Je-sus, blessed  Je-sus,  Tho' the  way  be 


*--r*t'tJ&& 


_ * 1A !A —  iA >A >A rl u_p_H— h- 1 r-H- (- £  -  -I 


_â–  M a 

the  vale  of 


]>    \)    u 

be  dark  and  drear,  Thru 

lone-ly,dark  and drear,be  dark  and  drear, rilfollow,Thru  the  vale   of  sor-row, 


..- 1 1 1 A— rA — A — A A — A — -  rl 1 1 1 ! 1 1 

CoDyright.  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan.  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospe!  Glory," 


That  Land  of  Day 


^^33 


dSgpfcgfcE 

-•--P-»    -^F^l- 


P  y  i/,  y  v  ';  v  i/\-v    y    u    P 

sorrow,  And  no     e  -      vil  will  I  fear: 

thru  the  vale  of  sorrow,        And  no  tho't  of  e-vil  will   I     ev-  er  fear;  He '11  lead  me 


tJ=t?===--=t  «=?:S:"i*==: =Fuz42-b±-?=  p~  EEEjE 


p  p  y  y  y  y 


P  r>  h  h  N 

^— ■— ,— ■-T-P— j- 


^z^z±=rf: 


— * A A — A A A SS LA ZS * ~ F<- 

— h— n— h— n-  ^—4—- r,_,_«— ■—■_p — p_£ tm — ■ — <* — ■_ 

P     P     P     P     P     P    _  P  _  V .  â–   1/     y  â–     V      V"  '/      v     -v.    -V 

When  the  night  is  fall-ing,  And  I     can 

when  the  night  is  fall-ing,  fall-ing. oiclit  is  fall-ing,  And    1     can-not 

k k k k- 


>-y- 


-h — n — n — n — n — >= F» — ■ — •— ■ — ■ — ■ — ^5 FP — t — 1 


g— 5— i— -■--F»-— j»— »— y— y— ±=g Fg  —-„-—-,--.- 

r,  p     y    [5    y y 


p     p    p    P 


not  see    my   way,  His 

Bee    my  way,    1      can- not   see   my    way,  I     know  that  His  dear  hand  will 

-£-_ £_t_t:Jt— :t._:t-_t:i_:tr_l_S -♦_♦-_♦_♦! 

t-l 1 1 1 H h- 1 1 1 a ^»--F" ■ ■ ■- 

L~p — p — _>._  _,_r  ^ — ^ — p — t?_.j? — ^_^ — p_c? — e — ^_  ^_ 
■ — **>.  w        n        w        n        i-" -^  iv       n       p\ 


-ah 


:£?— 


A • 9 A A 1 

p  —  t? — 5 — p—  y — -y — 

dear    hand    will    guide     me,  Till     I 

me,  guide    me,    sure   -  ly    guide    me, 


l~'i 


®i^i=i!==E^=='^=^= : ;  ' 


-p: 


K 


Ttj — y— £ — y— * — — -• — •— t — * — ?: 

reach  that    land    ofi    day. 

Till       I     reach    that  bless  -  ed      land    of      day,    that    land    of      day. 


mm 


■*•       -a-       -P-       ■#-       -•-       -•-  . 

Jfc * t fc t tr £ £, 


h 


...y y_ 


-y — y — ? 


-A- 


No.  125. 

A,  M.  P. 


If  Jesus  Holds  My  Hand 

[  I  Will  Make  It  All  Right]  Adger  M.  Pace 


ifi^ 


V     1         S 


!^*Efe>=fc*£z£f=: 


P    P  -•-    1 


ezs: 
1 


a 


1.  Tho'  the  way  be  rough  that    I  have  to  climb, 

2.  As    I  trudge  a-long  thru  the  val-leys drear, 

3.  When  I  reach  the  top  ^  of  the  mountain  steep, 


m 


si 


IN     IS 


:^±zpr-n=p: 


^3—  »-P'5l 

S lm— 9.— «— i 


^teft^zfcgci^ 


O  -ver  mountains  steep, 
With  a  heart  bent  low, 
And  I  view  that  land 


0  y  u  u  w 


:tf=T 


thru  the  hills    of  time; 

with   no  one    to  cheer, 

o'er  the  wa-ters  deep; 

-»-     .       .  *-    -»    -•- 


** 


_* ^_  -sg : — 


_|E ■ m — 


k 


m=m 


There  is  one  glad  tho't, 
I  am  blest  to  know, 
I     will  fear  no  harm, 


1  V  t  U    I)    P 


what-so-e'er  my  plight, 
thru  the  dark-est  nieht, 
when  1  take  my  flight, 


:E==t=t=i:=t=t=1 

â– ^-r-r-D-tr-r 


■£»=* 


gE^-^+fV-^ 


i  5 

all  right. 

I  will  make  it  all    right. 


If  Jesus  holds  my  hand,  I  will  make  it  all  right, 

If  Je-sus  holds  mj  hand,  I 

■ 1 — | — l — r~t— ^— Tnr-tr-f -k-^-rt"A  a        ~~    1 


^=FS» 


p-tf-p-L 


Chorus. 

f!  H  hh  j^- 


^   =31     g 


^iJ-^--fir-^-----^-^ 


1 


If  Je-sus  holds  my  hand ,  I  will  make  it  all  right, 

If  Je-sus  holds  my  hand,  I  will  make  it  all  right, 

ji    .A.    .A-   -A.    -A.    .A.  _A_-A-.A_  .A.-A--A. 


ggg ig=z:Fgz:pizp=p=p-P=P-^ g. 


Copyright,  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher  in  "Gospel  Gory" 


If  Jesus  Holds  My  Hand 

O-ver  mountains  bleak,  thru  the  stormy  dark  night; 

O-ver  mountains  bleak,  thru  the  stormy  dark  night; 

••-  -»■  -»■  -0     e-  ■•■  -»-  k      .      .     -»-  -•-    0    -9    -0-  -0-  -#- 

jgr_         -~r~ f  I'-h-^-f-"-^^"'^  Vrr      l — r-1 — r-f~i 

^-*-S»— *— ii-PTj- 

1  1  0  rj  u    L;    U 

All  the  way  up  home,  to  the  Cit  -  y  bright, 

All  the  way  up  home,  to  the  Cit  -  y  bright, 


-r-— r=--=rr  — 3--P- g— ferzl^: '^-fri 

tlb  At ,.,_        :~ Zl — a ii—ZZta a a ▲ a AZJ 


— =1- 


Z^ZlfzZZ'zZ^ 

ir-tHf 


f 


1 


:=t 


zzzz±:£^z*zzE}:gEzjtzrzz: rzzftj 

zrfzjzjzjzgzfub.a -zz:— zniJ 


_    -H 1- 

„'  i» — » — A — h — A — »—•—♦—•—*—•■ 


r^jz; 
-•- 


p  -»- 

I  U 

If  Jesus  holds  my  hand,                                   I  will  make  it  all  right,        all  right. 

If  Je-sus  holds  my  hand,                             I  will  make  it  all  right. 

-•-    -0-     0-    -0-    -0-    -0—0—0-  .       .    -•-      I                   J  h 

S-s— a— — 5 Fs— f- — ■-— —^»— AzrCZ "— *— '-z1 £--*— a — — 


—- L-tf-b- 


„zr=£izB=n=?r2zxigiA_A_ zz*-j 


Coda. 


To  the  glo 


Zfc 


^=^=J=JzJfei 


:i— :azz«r 


-*-»_A-J 


-*|_a ;—*—»-  .. 


te 


Tgi~g~^"lt~g~*~r^ 


^  b  y  p  u  u  ' 

ry  land,  where  there  com-eth  no  night, 

To  the  glo-  ryland,  where  there  com-eth  no  night, 

F±z  S=t^^=S======^=«:^is=P=l=l 


If  Je-sus  holds  my  hand 


k-P-j-^-"-^-*-} 


I  will  make  it  all  right. 
If  Jesus  holds  my  hand  I  will  make  it  all  rightj  will  make  it  all  right. 

■A-  -A-  -A-  -*-       -»-  -A-  -A-  -A. .»-  .*-  _-A  B    4- 

Fir— 1%— A— A^-F— *— P-+T-H*— Id— p-r- t^T-lfc    4    t'  ~l 1 


No.  126. 

W.B  Walbert 


:±=i 


Beautiful  Home 


J.  O.  Townsend 


^p-f? — ft — p — h— -] — b— y=y-p^-«— «f--»— •-i 

— H — ^~~^ — 6 — * — ^~i — *— F* — «— * — * — *■-  H 


*pE ^ — — „— »-  ^—.—^^ 

1.  0  -  ver    the  deep  and   roll  -  ing  sea, there   is     a    home  prepared  for    me, 

2.  Je  -  sus    is    wait- ing   for     us  there,  in  that  bright  home  so    love  -ly,  fair, 

3.  There  we  shall  nev-  er  know   a    sigh,  nev  -  er     a  -  gain  shall  sav  good-  by, 


&-JMl 


f=^T=3i 


»r* ir-r 

Bean  -  ti    -  ful  home 

Beau  •  ti 

f- -£ 


* 


ful,  beau 
-â– - 


r~ ir 


ti- 

-«- 


ful 

-â– - 

-t-_ 


t^=s="=^: 


of  the    hap-  py   and 
home  of   the    hap-  py,   the 

■*•  *■  ■*-  *_■:■_?- 


|SS=g51 


blest; 

home   of     the    hap  •  py 


Love  -  lv 

It        will 

and   blest;Sing-  ing 


and  bright  be-  yond  compare, 
be  glo  -  ry,  oh,  so  sweet, 
and  shout-ing    all  day   long, 


m. 


3: 


jczzfc 


JZ# — ^_:C_ZJ-C# # # 0 # 0 ■ 0_  L 

w— *— a — *— F* — ^— A— #— A — s  — F, 

»T       9         9  »-v  i 


And     it      is   built    of    jew-  el3  rare. Beau-  ti 
when  we    to  -  geth-er  there  shall  meet, 
prais-ing    the  Lord  in    hap  -  py  song, 

__r— I—*-. 


ful  home 


:H: 


rf— i— fczcS-z *— r— B— S L 


Beau-ti  -ful,beau-ti  -  ful 
.*.    _».    .p.   ,r.    —    .,_ 


where   the    wea  -  ry     find    rest. 
home  where  the    wea  -  ry     find    won  -  der  •  ful     glo  *  ry     and  rest. 

JB.        .ft.        JL        V        #-        -k-         J        J        |        J       -J -J       J 


Copyright,  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory." 


Beautiful  Home 


Chords. 


x-a±fcifcz=iz±:-^.    '  ■■  ■'■?'■  -Mia 


Beau  -  ti  -    ful    home, 


won  •  der  -  fnl 


Beau  -  ti   -  ful,    beau  -  ti  •  ful    home, 


P        r =fc^j^r--      :  .; 


j£ hvtVJ1  J*  P  4  ■■$<   k    rVi 

TZg — | £ R_ip.L#_# — 0 # m e J -U— 1 


-â–  a a- 


s>  b  u 

home,  Ha-ven  of  rest  for    all  the  blest ,wait-ing    up 

won-der-  ful,  mar-vel-ous  home,  'tis 

WM— Hi— h — t- — t- — t — F — H— Hi— h-Ph — M— ^ — fcJ —  I — g — g — b — 


fa 


- — _. -m A A A m * * F* * * * m «5 A" 


there;  Beau- ti -ful  home, 

wait  -ing  God's chil-dren  up  there;  Beau-  ti  -  ful,beau-ti  -  ful  home» 

#■    #■    -*-    gk-    -k-    -k-    -•- 


^=g=p=z^=b=t2=t=:===== 


_ S mZ * * A A A- 


45 — -fi- 


* >3~ 


glo    •  ri  -    ous  home,  Par  •  a  •  dise 

glo  -  -ri" -    ous,  heav  -  en  -    ly    home, 


-k-      -k-      -k-      -k- 

:r=t=E=.t: 


^iAjtf 


j A * A- 

FS=f-ir 


p-p 


± — A — A — * — B—  -&F-. 


5 


£:=£ 


sweet,  so  love-  ly  and  fair. 

Won-der-  ful  par  -  a  -dise  sweet  so  love-  ly  and    it     is     80    love-  ly    and  fair. 


— i 1 P — P 


— 0 — m^ 


jjTg  til  5  r 

iir. 

t     is     bo    love-  ly    and  fair 

AllAAJLL 


— # — •—  -m — * 


«=P=P=#=«=P=£ 


pza^p 


No.  127.  His  Love  Shines  Within 

W.  B.  Walbert                                                                                                   Oren  Adams 
fh^-^i — —  Mr — ft — *— — ! — ft— \-~- — * — a — v—\ — -1 — Fa-=- — a a — 1~ 


z=£= 


1.  I'm  walk-ing  with  Christ  from  day  un  -to    day,  And  sing  -ing   His  praise 

2.  No  long-er      in     sin    and  dark-ness   I    roam, By     faith    I      can    see 
'3.     And  when  I    shall  reach  that  Cit  -y      of    gold,  I        then  shall  live      on 


-A-b»- 


ft— rA ft— r 


®;:  rfl  ) — Fl* — C — •— Fl ' — Ff-r — P — t — Fl 1 F»* — • 

wp  4  ft— h* — ft — ft— b^ — t — F; — d — i — F^ — * — F*- — ft 


-tr~r-ur 


§>=^ 


r-gi — *• 


-*r— * *— L 


3= 


ft — f-i£= — 


a    -  long  the  bright  way;Tbe  light    of      His    love    is      shin  -  ing    on      me, 
the  lights  of  sweet  home;  And  soon     I      shall  reach  that  won  -  der  -  ful  place, 
and  nev  -  er  grow  old;    No    sor  -  row  nor    pain    can      en  -  ter      up    there, 

>- — * — r— rA— km — rtr. a A — rA—i 


— P-tf— b— t-- 


r   b  -  '■• 


r 


*=:! 


:p: 


Chorus. 


h — ft — ™ — F^-^ — * — FJ — — — - — I 


My  heart     is       a  -    glow, I'm    hap  -py     and        free. 
Re  -  deemed  and  made  pure,  by     mar  -  vel  -  ous        grace. 
In        heav-en,  that  home   so    won-drous  -  ly         fair. 

~_ ft ft —  d A_f.ftJL — a 9 — r-j — r- 

--— -t— Eb=— ?= =E=zF#S"-*r— F 


The  bless-  ed 


mm 


sun  -  light  from  heav  -  en  shines  with 

Light  from  heav  -  en  shines  with  -  in,  shines  with  -in, 

ft      _A ft ft A = ,-* ft » ft 


P      C      U      V 

Since  Christ  my 


=fc: 


U 


*=£=£= 


— p: 


u 


-Q-fr   »      1       ,    h       Vf)                   -,                   r~fs- 

ife    ;4-#J     ♦     -ti   t  ^  0s- 

§ 

a] 

=) 

w 

>* — 

^-    p      *    N     *     4     3    3"    ^ 

! 

— ft 

•J     V             D^              *       ^       * 

Lord  saved  and  cleansed  my  heart  from  sin, 
Saved  and  cleansed  my  heart  from  sin , 

_ ft ft A A ft ft— pf— 

@dz=q t t t t t t— &» 

ev  - 

'ry 

ft 

aI 

sin, 

P 
— « — 

He 

— • — 

is      my 

*^P- ■ ft ft ft —ft ft ft hf— 

■£ 

-i 

— 1— 

5 1 

Copyright,  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan.  Music  Publisher  in"  Gospel  Glory  " 


-I — -i -j- 


UsEE^E^ 


His  Love  Shines  Within 

_p> j— , — h — f — -P — 

_  — i — i — -_i — w — ♦ — 

-3  -ftm — tH 1 ' 


:3=-£- 


±=±=$* 


Sav-  iour,King,  I     will    sing, All    glo  -  ry  and 

own  Sav-  iour,King,  His     hap  -  py  praise  I     will    sing, 


P      ^ 

fadLdbfcEE 


h     P     P    iP    J    *    -f*- 


-sh— S- 


=t: 


^fe?=?_Eg^| 


:3z 


$;'â– â– '  1/ 

bon  -  or     to     His  name,  pre  •ciousname; 


t=ttP — I — t^ — 

-— — — — — c +-TI&— &- 

— — t=i=:g*_£=: 


1? — P — P — b— L— — ■ P — P — 


Gent-ly  leads 
He    gent  -  ly  leads 

IS  J 


IS       JS 


b-^r 


3££i*=i 


Ml- 


— l — «_&* 


-3=--- 


IZIEJZZi.— *  —  *ZZI 1=3 


all  the  way,  That  fair  land    of    per-fect 

me    all  the  way,  To  that  fair  land  of    per-fect 

i        IN      IS  I         fN       IS 


-3= S- 


Z   P   P 


•i 4__* 


:3=M: 


r^- 


r- 


;*=£EE& 


■D— P" 


:g=: 


$£=£ 


£-:$=:£: 


-ft — i- 


w     P     I       P     P    â„¢ 

day,  And  what  -  so 


SB* 


3— fi: 


^—^: 


1 


er     be  -tide      me,    He     will 


day,  hap  -  py    dav, 

IS        I  IN        fS 

a1      j      d 


m 


Tl^T- 


A A * A— 4="_ 


^p=p— p— p=Lb.: 


-k-     -k-     -k- 

;tr__-tr__t-_ 
:fc— ^— t: 
:fz==pzz=pz 


-k- 


:k=: 


jb=g~  *— g— p—  fe- ■ =Fgzz^=p: 


H 1 — WB-^— *i- 


=4 


rufei- 


I    p~T 


stay  close  be-side  me.My  Sav-iour,  Re-deem-  er,  Lord  and  King, Lord  and  King. 


§e 


jC. 


rs 

A— A- 


:P^P=t=^=M 


:=A=f 


&E 


-b— p 


-jfir*-- 


-r 


No.  128.  Marvelous  Love 

J.  E.  M,  LE.  Marsh 

^-ffT-1^— fe—^F  3—  ■— 3— ■— 3— if1—  3— h  -H— -H-ahs-^-Bh-Fa — * — 3—= 
5  *â–   ."Si 


P 


1.  Mar-vel-ous  was  the  love  that  Jesus  had  for  sinners, When  He  was  dy-ing    on  the 

2.  Mar-vel-ous  was  the  love  that  bro't  Him  down  from  glo-  ry,  Just  to  a  -tone  for   all  our 

3.  There  is  no  love  that  can  compare  with  that  of  Je-sus,  When  He  laid  down  His  life  that 

j&tCa-*—* — A-+A — * — A— A — A — I ' 1 — \-A — c=— A * A—  \ 


iizteft— J^tfcnz :t3z=U=t2r 


*  t^^rr^       :      -   -^-f-fM^ 


=d=«P 


cross  of  Cal-va-ry,  of  Oal-va-ry ; With  a  thorn  crown  up-  on  Hishead,thesearo  the 
sins  and  set  us  free,to  set  us  free;  And  if  we'll  to  His  will  be  true, please  llim  in 
we  thru  Him  might  live.that  wemhrhfc  live;Making  for    us    a  home  on  high, where  we  shall 

:*.:    .A.    .A.     â– a.    -.m-    -A.  .A.     .A.  .A. 

V       V       w ' 


-A — A — I 1 A—*—*- 


V 


^feterfS 


-1 — al— f— •-.; 


:-ts: 


-#-  >  -»-  '■  ••- 

y    7    1/  _  v »  1 

ten-der  words  Hesaid,"Fa-ther,for  -give  them, "now  and  set  them  free,  oh, set  them  free, 
ev  -  'ry  thing  we  do,  On  some  glad  morning  we  His  face  shall  see,  His face  shall  see. 
live  and  nev-  er  die,    Wear  a  bririit  crown  that  He  to    us  will  give,  to  us  will  give. 

<â– *-      -A-       n  n  "A-  h       N       h       ^       1 


^  b  u 

Mar-vel-ous  love  that 


our  Sav-iour  was  showing, 


p    b  S  M 

When  He  was  dy-ing 


Wondrous  love 


Je-sus  showed, 


When  He  died 

.A      A- 

A A A- g r-l ' 1 

t h L^ — £__* 

I         I         0 


g%lzfc=r-q=:^^=g 


,fcm=; 


b 


"an 


f 


■«i- 


0 


5.  ^  p-  C  p  p 

on  Cal-va-ry's  tree,  It  was  because  He  loved  us   so,that  to  the  cross  our  Lord  did  go, 

on  the  tree,  Loved     us         so,  cross    did      go, 

•A-  -A- 

tt-^ — g  -HA— A—A— g 1-A A A— g LA A A 


3= 


:tzz==tt: 


t:: 


Copyright  1948  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher,  in  "gospel  glory." 


Marvelous  Love 


_  *    r*__£.  n  _4v 


__y.  _____  J _T^        _N I 

A-  ty-— F_ — ■ — # — y — ■ — ■ 

There  to     re-  deem  us  from    all  our  sins  and  set    us  free; 

From  our         sins  and    set    us  free, and  set    us  free; 

w-n-- F[-  — ' — »— ■— ■ — n—n-Fa— »—■—■—*— J 

— w      p    p     *    ■"    l;    u     j    u 


0  â„¢    P 


-4— J- 


izt^: 


k      P      B 


=~fcfe 


p      P     y     i      I 


There  is  none  oth-  er         such  grace  and  com-pas-sion,      there  is  none  oth-er 

none  oth-er  such  great  love  in  the  earth 


_r 


— 1_ — _ -k. 


®   ft*   ■      — fa--*— a—- — — E 

f   p  b  s  ■  r       -•-  ■? 


P    P 


A      A 

P    P    P 


j  0  ^  p ;  p  • 


in  earth  or   a- bove,        None  that  could  suffer   on  the  tree, giving  His  life  that  we  go  free, 
or    a-bove,  On       the       tree,  we       go     free, 


SPft  VX 


-4* — Ift — *~^ F1^ ■ &— ^ j-j_ * _| 


S)£=f=ggg=f-t*  *      I— g— ^— I — g-F*— *-S*-fr«— *— H 


Won-der-  ful,  mar-vel-  ous    is     the  dear  Saviour's  love. 


our  Saviour's  love. 


__^L^-f  ,f  fe  ^L4^^^^^,j!j£Jlb^ 

±£g=0=g_;E^_=^_=p__^__g_zp__^— ^-E[=Z == 


No.  129. 

Millard  A.  Glenn 


I  Am  Saved 


d*x=&:=&=:&=$=n&: 


A  A- 

^  ^  .  3 *- 

1.  I'm     so    glad    to      tell 

2.  I        was    just    a      stran 

3.  When  the    glo  -  ry    gates 


—d ■ al P — at — F-- 

-I * — i — _£ — 5— c- 

you  now  my  broth  -er, 
-ger  to  my  Sav-iour, 
some  day   I'm  near  -  ing,    I 


Mrs,  Jesse  B.  Hardin 

— *==*= 


Like 
But 
sweet  -  ly    saved, 1 


my 

thru 

will 


bless  -  ed     Lord  there    is       no      oth  -  er, 
His       e    -   ter  -   nal    grace   and      fa  -   vor, 
join    the    saints,  my      Sav-  iour    cheer-  ing, 


1 


fe- 


-r 


--j- 


-£ !- 


-A A A A. 

-t—=L—  s==fe— 

"P p p ** 


F=fe=^=^=^=±: 


=*= 


£±3=3=?, 


am  saved; 


>—'-*' 


-*i- 


am 


J" 


sweet  -  ly  saved; 


Liv  -  ing  on  the  moun-tain 
Now  I'm  on  the  glo  -  ry 
Then    I      want    to      tell     how 


9Ep— 


-9 — % — \r 


— * — & — 4 — « — 14- 
_4> 1 


-j^i 


top  of  bless  -  ing, 
road  to  heav  -  en, 
much     I        love    Him, 


am      saved, 


saved,    oh,      glo   -  ry, 


_ a A * rZ « 

g^-A— —— i> A A 1-; : ^-1- 


A^J 


Tell-iflg  of  the  joy  I'm  now  pos  -sess-ing, 
Whereashin-ing  crown  I  shall  be  giv  -  en, 
Tell  it   out  with  joy,  there's  none  a  -boveHim.  I 

r_^_^_f-_fc_4_AL_A_~-  A -_A_r!l * 


^=pz=fc£^: 


: I ---, 


am  saved. 

sweet-  lv  saved. 


Copyright,  1948,  by  Jame6  D.  Vaughan  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory." 


1  Am  Saved 


Chorus. 


— ♦-  »£— «i— *— *— — *— *-c — a — E7^— 1— J-?*— *-  ^-J-1 


Glo- ry     be   to  God, I'll  sing  and  shout  it, 


gfc 


I        amsared,  oh,  hal-le-Iu-jah, 
am       saved, 

A A 


And     I     want  to     tell    the  world    a   -  bout   it, 

-k-      -*-     -»».-      A 

-m-      -F-      -h~     tb-      -P-      -F- 


B5* *- 


^ 


I 


HHj-f r" 1 1 • ■ — ~Z, ^ • 


— jr 

-F- 


h     is 


(® — ri — 
•J 

saved; 


-— gb:fc^=;=;zz:iz:tz^=ii— ;=J!zz 


When    I    get      to  heav'n.ob,  won-droussto  -ry, 


saved, and   oh,    so     hap-py; 


:g— * 


3Mr 


^ 


— ^ 1 — -5 — % —  g Fif — a ft — £ A A 


I  am  saved,  I     will  sing     it    out  with 

1  am         saved, be  -yond    the  riv  -    er, 


EftE  \t  i — 


-• (tMs--- 


:— tf 


d2=f=^=^^:^=Fr==i== 


*±# 


grace  and   glo  -  ry, 


— ft— 


%       I' 


0     V 

am    saved. 
am  saved.and  saved  for 


•I      = 


JR.      3.      JR. 


ft    ft    ft    b    to 


h    h 


No.  130. 

A.  M.  P. 


Have  You  Balanced  Your  Account 

[With  God?]  Adger  M.  Pace 


1.  Oh, my  brother.are  you  saved  from  a  life  by  sin  de-praved?Areyou  walking  where  the 

2.  Would  yonr  soul  gc  home  with  Him  when  yon  pass  thru  shadows  dim?And  yourbod-y  's  laid  be* 

3.  Could  you  answer,"Here  am  I"  on  that  morning  by  and  by?Sayedandsan-ti  -fied  thru 

.k.   k.        >. 


p- p  P  P  P  ' p 


jc-|c-|s=|E 


r~u_p 


•*— ; ! *— t- 


ft* 


-T 


k — k — k — k — k — k- 

tP=£=£=P=r=£=£ 


:— f:— *— f 


P    P 


3| 9 


poEEgE 

saints  have  trod?the  saints  have  trod? 
neaththe  sod?be-neaththesod? 
Je  -  sns'  blood?thrn  Je-sus'  blood? 

p   p  p  i<   '      y     p 


If  the  Lord  should  come  to-day,    tell    me 
When  He  calls  your  name  on  high,  what    will 
If  you  can, with  Him  you'll  Ine    and      a 


--W- 


~V~V 


P      I 


1/    y    u    y    I 
broth-er,now  I  pray, 

then    be  your  re-ply?Have  you  balanced  your  account  with  God?accofint  with  God? 
crown  to  you  He'll  give, 


spr^ 


^=& 


Chorus. 

Kg.  A A A A lA— A. 

1—+) — p — P — P — rf^-T' 


cr 


js_r; 


:it 


1 


Do  you  know  that   you    are    saved? 

Do  you  know    to  -  day,         that  you    are    saved,  my  broth  -  er? 


1a- — "£ — "j! — ."£: — TA1 


SJ===E=^^EE^ 


-&- 


• jA 

P 


:^=^=^=45: 


.-j 


"i"— 


U  P  P  P  i  I 

Know  the     joy    that    you    have       craved, 

Know  the    peace  and    joy  that  you    have        craved, 

-k_  _k_  _k_  _k_  -k.  .k.  _k-  >.  .fL.       .kJL     .p.. 

^ — k — — k~ 

Copyright,  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory." 


:==[:=zz:t==t=zzz:z=t:==:xr=t=t=rt=:t=:3 

E fc k fc It Ufc k; +- k— f; J 


Have  You  Balanced  Your  Account 

[With  God?] 


— 1# # — m — m — • — ft* —  &-z: 3* 


:^~i 


Are   your  sins    all    cov-ered   by    the  blood? 

the  cleans-lng  blood  of    Je-su3? 


—A A — r-A 1 A m A A — r_, A 2 A a m *— HS" 3 


b    b 


h 


Eto^=r==zz===z=a=z^z=i=^==ci|: 
i — h, — t, — |p — tJ — r~  f— f— ,•— c- 


-g — s — 


Are  you    iiv   -  ing    on     the    mount? 

Are   you     Iiv  -  ing    now         high  on     the    mount   of    bless-  ing? 


wm 


t— t— t— t 

:p=g— b— E 


t~- 


-t A A  "  £ j 


:£=* 


-I" (â– - 

b      I) 


— *— tj  — a — ^—g—^—i 


Drink 

Drink-ing       at     the     fount, 

-*-      -K-      >- -S-      >- 


ing       at     the     glo  -    ry 
the  glo  -    ry 


? — k- 


-k k- 

:&=p: 


-k :Fk- 

4:  fe 


fount, 
fount, 

-(8-    .M.   ju 

-k'       »■ — k-= — #• — 


:t 


] 


— b — b bj- 

Have  you    bal  -  anced  your     ac-  count  with     God? 


=3 


h T t# 4. h a ^ 

b     b     b     t 


ac-  count  with  God? 

i  j»  i1  i  .j. 


a-- 


No.  131. 

James  Rowe 

-• — a — 9—  .42; 


Sing  Hosannas 


*=&=£ 


James  D.  W  albert 


1.  Oh,  sing  ho-san-nas  to  the  Lord,who  leads  us    on    onr  way,Let  songs  of 

2.  Oh,  sing  ho-  san-nas   to  His  name  and  nev-  er  from  Him  roam, He    lift  -  ed 

3.  Oh,  sing  ho-san-nas  and  re-joice  in     His    re -deem-ing  love, Then  we  shall 


-»—  -1— 


-A A A__A A A A_Ca A: 

:t=t=t=t=t=t=|:=Et:==t: 

-Ifc & \& it A & & — Ltfc ft 


A- 


glad-ness  be    ont-poured  to  Him  from  day  to  day;His  love  is 

us    from  sin  arid  shame,and  now  He  leads  us  kme;The  an -gels  all 

lift      to  Him  the  voice   in  realms  of    bliss    a  -  !jove;The  temp 


won-  der  -  ful    in- 
His  name     a 
ter  still  our  souls 


deed, His  lov-  ing  kind-ness  great.He  free-  ly  fills  our  ev 
dore  and  ev  -  er  sing  His  praisc,So  praise  His  mer-  cy  ev 
sails,  our  bur-dens  oft  are   ereat,  But  He  whose  mor  -  cj  nev 

'    _  *      1_X 

:*— M-zt 

:n— -h—9- 


'ry  need    and  guides  us 

er-more  thru-out  our 

'  er    fails  will  lead   us 


—A A_|_A__f_i 

14 — 14 — ifc_i r — — 


Chorus. 


11  v^nunua. 


£=3: 


1     X 

to     the  gate.  Ho-san-nas  sing 
earth -ly  days, 
thru  the  gate. 


un 


t 

the 


King, 


m 


Glad  -  ly  sing 

_^ — ft — f»_ 
fe: 

'--t=t3: 


1      X 
And  make  the 


1 
hills 


and 


val 


U 
leys 


— v 


Make  the    hills 


ring, 


val 


leys 

4- 


rmg, 


-S—  - 


3 — s- 


ZXZ 


m 


Copyright,  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory. 


Sing  Hosannas 


fotejfcztazrf 


e 


When  to  His  word 


1    *    p 


— * a — fr« =-  Jtj- a m ■ 

j  u  u  ;  *= *â–  

we  sweet  -ly  cling, 


To  His  word 


sweet  -  ly  cling, His  name  oh, 


—i * — — L — L" — v- ssj: — 


let    us    wor-ship  and  a-dore.Him    a  -  dore;And  let    ho  -  san -nas    in    the 

^^i — ft — »     >  — — ■  » — * — •— h — -brzi-zzitizz: 

1 — t2-_.p — £ — t — w— t^ * — £ — £ — y— l"* — a — & — * — 


*-$ 


in 

i — * — d — *- 


u     \> 


high  -est  ev  •  er   rise  and  swell,  For  Him  who  lives  and  reigns  a  -  bove  and    do  -  eth 


-A A A- 

:t=t=t: 

â– A A 1*- 

P    L>    U    L>     U 


all  things  well;Then  in  His.  pre-cious  Ho  -  ly    love  for  -  ev  -  er,  we    shall  dwell, 
-w-    ^  i 


And  glad-Iy    sing  His    hap-  py   praise  on   heav-en's  beau  -  ti 


—  i- 

*i 

^ 

— 

..!!_ 

-k- 

— k — 

At. 
~\ 

t" 

<br 

-0- 
D 

5= 

— A 

a 

____ 

-  y— 

-» — 

"I? 

.#.     -£-     -fc- 

:t=zF==t:: 
-• — » #- 


No.  132.  Since  the  Saviour  Set  Me  Free 

Charles  H.  Huff  Lawrence  Roper 


V  .*.    .*.    -#.    -^.  .«(..    .«,.    -«-  »«l      ^        ^        ^        ^  ^   ^        ^        ^        ^ 

1.  Wonderful  songs  of  love  are  ringing  in    my  soul,      ring-ing    in  my  soul, 

2.  Wonderful  sat -is- fy-ing  peace  is   in    my  soul,      peace  is    in    my  soul, 


P  b  ^  I    !    I    i    '>>  v    P    P    h 


t?^tr~  t?=E— {:: 


.*.      -*.       .4,-     _♦-      -#.      .«,-      -4i- 

in    my    hap  -  py  soul,Heav-  en  -  ly  joy  like might-y    bil -lowso'er  meroll. 
in    my  new-born  soul,  And    I      am  bead-ed  now  for   my   e  -  ter-nal  goal, 

3  I         I         i      -f-     -♦- 

firza — *__*— fr— is— a— fc=fc=E . —  zEpzzE=b=E=t:-J 

V    ip    b    u  :l     l>    P    L>  ' 


fc.      ^  -*-     .#-     .*.     .0- 


Since  the  Sav-iourset   me  free, He  set  me  free;Glo  -ry    to  God,  1  now  can 

0  -  ver  the  stars  and  moon  I'll 

SEEfefg 1=~  ^Fh— 9— P— £— : h— h— n-Fk— k— Is— is— 1 


S — <— ^~  *— *— * -v  -*-  ^-^— ^ — c^— ^-^-^r-4-3 


talk  with  Him  each  day, 
live  with  Him  someday, 


talk  with  Him  each  day,     ev-'ry  pass-ing  day, 
live  with  Him  some  day,  some  e  -  ter-nal  day, 


-J-.J-.-JL  -^Jl_|L-J  ®-£-4tr4 


•  /  .J.     .*.     -♦-  -♦'.      ^       ^ 

Sing  -ing  and  shouting  as     I      go    a  -  long  my  way, Since  the  Saviour  set   me 
For     I    am  read-y   now   to    go  with  Him  to  stay, 


P                         111        1#-      -♦• 
_j A A— rji A A A—  H A A A A A A— rA A F , 

z==Fh=zh=zD=_-b=t:=n;.=h=Fti=:|:=:t:=| 


KZj 

m — > 
tz: 


Copyright,  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan  Music  Publisher,  in  "Gospel  Glory." 


Since  the  Saviour  Set  Me  Free 


Fine.  Chorus. 


HNE,    IJHORUS.  i  k 


free,    He  bet    me  free.  Beau-ti  -  ful  songs        are        rmg-mg   in    my  soul, 

Songs  to -day, are  ring-ing  in    my  soul, 

lffiEi^=^£--^r=:t=z==:=:--i^==i==pc=s=E«2=:t3==p=t:iJ 


â– f 


For    I    am  saved      and      made  com-plete-ly  whole,Won-der-ful  joy     like 
Saved  I   am  and  made  com-plete-ly  whole,  Joy  like  nnVLiy 

:?:  :f:  *    ♦ 

:— u.-i— t— ^ 


BfflS 


j.  .    iJS h     h h I h %r-\ - l--r-i 


bil  -  lows  o'er  me   roll,  giv  -ing  me    the   uc-   to  -  ry,    the  vie  -  to  -  ry; 


3:— ,*- 


^Hfc^zif 


^^ 


I    will  keep  sing    -  ing 

Sing-ing,sing-ing 

^EEEEEEEg=gE|Ep«^:: 

h==Etc=tsizfc^=Bb=zpzzt2=:t3=^ 


as    I    go    a-  long,tell-ing  the  world    this 


whole  wide  world  this 


1^2:5=^=1  E*zE*=^=i£=— EEzl-31. 

*     -5-   -*:  hJ-    -«•     >? 


4U* 


=#=3=£g=? 


mes-sage  glad  in    song,Read-y    am      I  to 

mes-sage  glad  in    song,  Read  -  y   now    to 


D.S 

3= 


sing  with  heaven's  throag, 


fc=fc=3EZ=te==fc:=:=:zz: 1 r^ — p — p — t"_c 


1/     P     y      1 


No.  133.         On  That  Happy  Glory  Day 

Millard  A.  Glenn  B.  F.  White  and  Hollis  Taylor 


— . 


TV 


7     -^- 


y.  0  u  * 

1.  Oh.my  hopes  grow  fon-der  of    a  home  up    yon-der,in  the  sky, 

And  my  heart  is  glad, 

2.  On  that  bright  to-mor-row,  free  from  pain  and  sor-row,bless  the  Lord, 

Hap-  pvglo  -ry  dav, 

ft    fi    h  *â–   :?:  t:  +-  -â–º- 

*    ^     |/     1/     P.  "    â–   v 


-W-J-- 1>-3 


With  mybless-ed   Saviour, some  glad  won-der-ful  day, some  won-der  -ful  day; 
I        will  have  a    mansion   in  that  Cit  -  y      of  gold,  that  Cit  -  y      of   gold; 


^^^Afti~==^i~^^^ 


m m «- 


=£rfe3=== 


kJ  b  p  t>  ^ 

And   I  mean  to  go  there,  when  this  life    is      o  -  ver,  by  and  by, 

And  no  more  be  sad, 
And  with  voices  blend-ed,  with  the  saints  as-cend-ed,  in    ac-cord, 

While  the  harpers  play, 

&  ft  r>  -  i  - 1 


Is^f 


=sRf=P=y=F 


A & A— rA A A A A—m 


^Wif- — N & — -ri * — 1-« 1 v — 9 *l *f • — r-T^i : *j — A 


-H — *--m- 


With  my  friends  and  loved  ones  there  for  -  ev  -    er      to     stay, there    to    stay. 
I        will  sing  God's  prais-es*  there  and  nev  -  er    grow  old,  ne'er  grow  old. 

i=sz=:==:gzz."ZzEpz=:zizzf  zz±:=rzB=z:i: 
f ^ kw — « — 9 — m — u — u — h- 


Chorus. 


11 


fc t>. 

. â– _ ~T!l_jjL 

"             _— zzzizzizz _ ci — <ziz:g 1 — ^  *      ■: — 4— 

-♦• 

On    that    hap  •  py  glo  -  ry    day, 
On    that   hap  -  py    glo  -  ry    day, 

i.  a         ft       ft       s       ft       fi       ft      ^ 


*B5 


0-^-b-tJ— r 


EM 


-yp 


Copyright,  1948,  by  James  D.  Vaughan,  Music  Publisher  in"  Gospel  Glory  " 


On  That  Happy  Glory  Day 


-ft 


ffE?: 


;-*!- 


When  I      get      to     glo  -   ry      land, 
When  I     get     to     glo  -   ry    land, 

3    J  i     f)  i  i    i    i1 


rp -* g — 


■ — 8 — R--H* — '■ *— £ 


nTrtr* 


Pf 


TF=$=* 


I    will    join  with    all  the  9aints,sing-  ing,  hap  -  py    prais  -  es      to    the 

Sing  -  ing, 


?z3: 
-9- 


-ts â–  J- 


^.__6-r^rrzr: 


^_b. 


J/rtTj?    l      *       f m       m       i       ar      p       ;p — ^p~i — | ~~j 

?-T-F-t1-H-i-s-si-"---Vn"'-ci' 

great  Sav-iour,King;While  the    a  -  ges   pass   a  -  way, 

Sav-iour,King;  While  they  pas9   a  -  way, 


m       ~w~      . — 


£— tr=tc 


-A A A 

— :^=t= 


P     §     P       '    b 


m&E^Ei^ 


-j 


s 


i 


0    tf    U    L>    u 

With  that  might-y    cho-  rus  grand, with  that  cho-  rus  grand, Un  -  to  Christ,my 

— — . . * * A 4 * 3 § 


Lord.Prais  -    es     for  •    ev  •    er      I'll  sing,    for  •    ev  •   er      I'll    sing. 


-i 1 &« 


k. 


J>  i  i  i1  i 


XJ&Sl 


INDEX 


No. 

A   Heaven    to   Gain 20 

Almost   Persuaded    61 

Amazing-   Grace    .  .  .  . , .103 

America 93 

Arlington     85 

Asleep  in  Jesus 97 

Be  Still  and  Know 43 

Beautiful  Home    126 

Bethany    107 

Blest  Be  the  Tie 99 

Come  My  Friends  and  Go In  F.  Cover 

Enough  For  Me 87 

Fill   Me   Now 69 

Follow  Thou  Me 106 

Give  Me   Oil   in  My   Lamp.  .-.>" 105 

Glory,  Hallelujah,   I   Am   Saved 88 

Glory   to   His   Name 57 

God  Be  With  You 31 

God  is    Present    Everywhere 73 

God  Plans   the  Best  for  Me 35 

Going  to  the  City  Fair 40 

Goodby   29 

Gospel    Glory    1 

Happ3r  Glory  Land    123 

Have  you    Balanced    Your    Account?....  130 

Have  You  Been  Faithful  to  Jesus? 13 

He  Made  a  New  Creature  of  Me 6S 

He  Will  Meet  Me  at  the  Gate 24 

He  Will   Roll    the   Shadows   Away 116 

Help  Us  in  the  Fight .  54 

He's  a  Friend   of   Mine 108 

He's  Coming   Back  Again    98 

His  Love   Shines  Within 127 

Holy  Ghost  with   Light   Divine 83 

How  Sweet   the  Name   of  Jesus 75 

I  Am   Going  to   That  City 117 

I   Am  Saved    '. 129 

I   Feel    Like    Traveling   On 39 

I   Have  No  More  Hills  to  Climb 50 

I   Hear  Thy  Welcome  Voice 51 

I  Need    the    Prayers 55 

I   Shall    Be    at    Home    with    Jesus 47 

I   Shall    Reacli    Home 77 

I   Want  to   Go    Home 92 

I   Want  to   Join   in    Singing   There 72 

I   Want  to    Live    There Pref .    Page 

I   Will  Not  be  Left  to  Travel  Alone 30 

If  Jesus  Holds  My  Hand 125 

I'll  Away  to  Rest 76 

I'll  Fly  Away     52 

I'll  Fly  Away   Some   Morning 62 

I'll  Live  with    Him   Yonder 48 

I'll  Not  Deny  my   Saviour. 119 

I'll  Pray  my  Way   to   Heaven 100 

I'll  Reach  My  Long  Sought  Home 2S 

I'll  Rise   and   Fly   Away 115 

I'll  Soon  Be  Going 56 

I'm  Glory    Bound    74 

I'm  Going  Home    121 

I'm  Holding  to  His  Hand 46 

I'm  So  Happy 19 

In   Glory    27 

It   is  Sweet  to  Walk  with  Jesus 58 

I've  Left  Old   Egypt 102 

Jesus  is  His  Name 49 

Tesus  Is  More  than  a  Friend.  .  .    In   B,  Cover 

Jesus  Paid  It  All    65 

Jesus,  Saviour,   Pilot  Me 89 

Just  As    I    Am 95 

Just  Beyond  the   Sunset 110 


No. 

Lead  Me   Shepherd    41 

Lean  on  the  Everlas.ing-  Arms 18 

Let  the   Light  Shine  on  Me 42 

Let  Us    Keep    on    Praying 6 

Light  from  the  Middle  Cross. 37 

Look  to   the    Saviour   and   Live.  . 9 

Lord,  I'm  Coming  Home S3 

Lord,  Is    It    I? /.  S 

Marvelous    Love     ;-,  128 

My  Faith  Looks  Up  to  Thee 79 

My  Lord   is   Watching-  Over  Me 44 

My  Saviour  Will  be  Near 70 

My   Saviour   Will   Lead   Me 86 

Oh,  Don't    Go    Away 12 

Oh,  the  Glory  of  the  Story 118 

On  That   Happy  Glory  Day    133 

On  The  Hills  of  Glory  Land   • 3 

Only  Trust   Him 63 

Over   the   Tide SO 

Pass   Me   Not    81 

Pray,    Pray,    Pray 59 

Press  On,  Pilgrim  Band 112 


Rest   in    Peace 
Rock   of    Ages. 


71 

109 


Since   the   Saviour    Set   Me    Free 132 

Sing  Hallelujah     23 

Sing-  Hosannas    131 

Sing  Out    the    Story    90 

Stay   in   the   Middle  of   the   Road 78 

Tell  It   Everywhere   You  Go    45 

Tell  It  Out   4 

That  Far  Away  Clime    16 

That  Land    of    Day        124 

That  Wonderful   Day    96 

The  City    Four-Square    2 

The  Glory   Land 64 

The  Highway   Grand    .  .  .*. 114 

The  Inner    Voice    34 

The  Love     of    Jesus Ill 

The  Sweetest    Music    25 

The  Tree  of  Life. 94 

There  is  a>  Fountain.   91 

Traveling  On  with  Jesus   120 

Traveling  the  Royal  Road    66 

Wake.  Up,   Christians    32 

Watch  the  Light  Just  Ahead 113 

We    Are    Going-   Home    to    Heaven 11 

We'll  Sing  the  Glory  Song-   84 

We'll  Still    Sing    On     .  _ 26 

What  A  Friend  We  Have  in  Jesus   33 

What  a    Ha-ppy  Time    60 

What  a  Joy  to  Know   82 

What  Wonderful    Glory 10 

When  Christ    Shall    Come    7 

When  Jesus    Abides   With   Me    .  .  .  .' 15 

When  "the   Saviour   Calls   Me   Home    ....  17 

When  We  Hear  the  Welcome  Bells    ...  38 

Whe,n  We  Meet   Up   There    '.  104 

When  We  Reach  Our  Home  in  Glory.  ...  36 

Where  He    Leads    Me     101 

Where  the   Flowers   Bloom  Forever    ...  22 

Whiter   than  Snow 67 

Wiry  Don't  You  Let  Jesus  Come   In?    .  .  8 

Wonderful   Joy   is   in   My   Soul    21 

Wonderful   Story   14 

You  are  Somebody's  Radio 122 


Jesus  is  More  Than  A  Friend 


W.H.J. 


W.  Howard  Johnson 


1.  Je  -  sua  left  heav-en,that  beau-  ti  -  ful  place.  And    to    this  world  did 

2.  Je  -  sns  was  nailed  to    the    old    rug  -ged  cross, On      no    one  could  He 

3.  Then  He  was  bur-ied,    a  -  rose  from  the  grave, Back  home  He  then    did 


i 


—M 

de- 
de- 
as  - 


u  u  u 


H =H 1  m [— I 1 1 * m — — h^- — I 

• — £h •—r-Jr-  H *— H ^ 5 ■ ■ 

scend;  Suf  -fered  and     died     for      the     sins      of      the      race, 

pend;  Yet,  He     had      pit    -    y      and    suf  -   fered  the      loss, 

cend;  Now  .He       is      plead- ing      the  whole    world   to      save, 

JdfTf?  t|    a^-H — I— Enf — r—t—  t=g^=L-— £-\ 

_2iz:iti^t=:-=t|i=zz:fci=:^=|s=:=:pc:=a=zt5z=5Z=zpzz=t:=:J 


U 
Chorus 


-• — ^ — 5F — 5 — rj. — ^— ^j— h c" — 1 — 1 ^ 


-f '  ]''~1F3 


Je  -  sus    i9    more  than    a  Friend 


Je  -  9us     i9     more   than 


rr. * = * P * «-  -, — ^=\ — : r  * * * * 1 


,i?o-« 


Friend, 


More  than  this  world  may     con -tend; 


He 


__ — « — i_jj — i rA A A _ 4_ 


died  on  the  tree  for  you  and  for  me,  Je-sus    i9  more  than    a   Friend. 

-0-    -ih_    -+—    ♦- 
* — * — -* a— | * — *~r* — • * — r — I 1 — r ' 

rH  I  /  l-  f  -»=E±g— g    L    l  I  i— *— -«-Ji— » — !•- Lg 

j-gJ/-Jfc._Jfc^Jfc— Ifc— ifc-lU— ^ — u LU— U — U — U — U     U    nE=^- 

Copyright.  1948.  by  James  D.  Vaughan.  Music  Publisher  in  "Gospel  Clorv" 


Millions  of  Vaughan  Song  Books  have 
been  sold  and  are  being  sold  through- 
out America  and  many  other  nations. 


TITLES  OF  BOOKS 

Gospel  Glory  (1948) 
Majestic  Melodies  (1948)  Heaven's  Gift  (1947) 

Perfect  Hearts  (1947)  Silver  Trumpet  (1946) 

Golden  Hours  (1946)  Honored  Guest  (1945) 

Blissful  Showers  (1945)  Paradise  Garden  (1944) 

Boundless  Love  (1944)  Dawning  Light  (1943) 

Sacred  Thoughts  (1943)  Gospel  Leader  (1942) 

Crowning  Glory  (1942)  Singing  Star  (1941) 

Joy  DiVine  (1941)  Crowning  Harmony  (1940) 

Heaven's  Hallelujahs  (1939)      Beautiful  Praise  (1940) 
Happy  Praises  (1938)  Gospel  Choruses  (1939) 

New  Temple  Bells  (1938)  Hallelujah  Voices  (1937) 

Harmony  Heaven  (1935)  New  Gospel  Voices  (1933) 

Millennial  Praise  (1927)  Highest  Hosannas  (1928) 

Heavenly  Praises  (1925)  Pleasures  Of  Heaven  (1926) 

The  above  popular  books  are  admirably  adapted  to  the 
needs  of  the  Sunday  School  and  all  kinds  of  religious  work. 
They  are  furnished  in  shaped  notes  at  uniform  prices.  The 
price  of  each  book  is  35c  a  copy,  or  $3.60  a  dozen,  post- 
paid anywhere  in  U.S.A.    Please  order  books  by  name. 

VAUGHAN'S  SELECT  RADIO  SPECIALS 
is  what  the  name  implies.  Out  of  the  thousands  of  fine  songs 
published  by  James  D.  Vaughan  in  the  last  ten  years,  the 
songs  in  "Vaughan's  Select  Radio  Specials"  are  the  cream 
of  them  all.  Every  singing  aggregation  needs  quartets,  trios, 
duets  and  solos  of  selected  gospel  songs.  The  kind  which 
carry  a  message  of  love,  hope  and  happiness,  with  melodies 
and  harmony  suited  to  make  them  "Happy  Hitters." 
Price  50c  a  copy;  $5.00  a  dozen,  postpaid  anywhere  in  U.S.A. 
GREAT  GOSPEL  SONGS  AND  HTMNS 

Great  Gospel  Songs  and  Hymns  is  one  of  the  most  com- 
plete church  and  revival  books  ever  published.  It  contains 
more  than  300  carefully  selected  songs  for  all  departments  of 
the  church.  Scores  of  the  favorite,  nationally  known  church 
songs,  many  of  the  best  songs  from  all  southern  publishers 
and  the  greatest  number  of  special  songs  ever  found  in  one 
book.    Write  for  complete  index. 

Shaped  notes  only.  Prices:  Limp  Binding,  45c  a  copy; 
$4.50  a  dozen;  $16.00  per  50;  $30.00  per  100. 

Cloth  Board,  75c  a  copy;  $7.00  a  dozen;  $27.50  per  50; 
$50.00  per  100,  postpaid  anywhere  in  U.S.A. 
Address  all  orders  to 

JAMES  D.  VAUGHAN 

MUSIC  PUBLISHER 

Lawrenceburg,  Tenn.